Yamaha CVP-407 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Pianos digitales
Tipo
El manual del propietario
CVP-409 / 407
OWNER’S MANUAL
EN
For information on assembling the keyboard stand, refer to the instructions at the
end of this manual.
Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage specified on the name plate on the bottom panel. In some areas
a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the main keyboard unit near the power cord. Make sure that the
voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To change
the setting use a "minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the pointer on the panel.
SPECIAL MESSAGE SECTION
PRODUCT SAFETY MARKINGS:
Yamaha electronic
products may have either labels similar to the graphics
shown below or molded/stamped facsimiles of these
graphics on the enclosure. The explanation of these
graphics appears on this page. Please observe all cautions
indicated on this page and those indicated in the safety
instruction section.
See bottom of Keyboard enclosure for graphic symbol markings.
The exclamation point within the
equilateral triangle is intended to alert
the user to the presence of important
operating and maintenance (servic-
ing) instructions in the literature
accompanying the product.
The lightning flash with arrowhead
symbol, within the equilateral trian-
gle, is intended to alert the user to the
presence of uninsulated “dangerous
voltage” within the product’s enclo-
sure that may be of sufficient magni-
tude to constitute a risk of electrical
shock.
IMPORTANT NOTICE:
All Yamaha electronic products
are tested and approved by an independent safety testing
laboratory in order that you may be sure that when it is
properly installed and used in its normal and customary
manner, all foreseeable risks have been eliminated. DO
NOT modify this unit or commission others to do so
unless specifically authorized by Yamaha. Product perfor-
mance and/or safety standards may be diminished.
Claims filed under the expressed warranty may be denied
if the unit is/has been modified. Implied warranties may
also be affected.
SPECIFICATIONS SUBJECT TO CHANGE:
The
information contained in this manual is believed to be
correct at the time of printing. However, Yamaha reserves
the right to change or modify any of the specifications
without notice or obligation to update existing units.
ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES:
Yamaha strives to pro-
duce products that are both user safe and environmentally
friendly. We sincerely believe that our products and the
production methods used to produce them, meet these
goals. In keeping with both the letter and the spirit of the
law, we want you to be aware of the following:
Battery Notice:
This product MAY contain a small non-
rechargable battery which (if applicable) is soldered in
place. The average life span of this type of battery is
approximately five years. When replacement becomes
necessary, contact a qualified service representative to
perform the replacement.
Warning:
Do not attempt to recharge, disassemble, or
incinerate this type of battery. Keep all batteries away
from children. Dispose of used batteries promptly and as
regulated by applicable laws. Note: In some areas, the
servicer is required by law to return the defective parts.
However, you do have the option of having the servicer
dispose of these parts for you.
Disposal Notice:
Should this product become damaged
beyond repair, or for some reason its useful life is consid-
ered to be at an end, please observe all local, state, and
federal regulations that relate to the disposal of products
that contain lead, batteries, plastics, etc.
NOTICE:
Service charges incurred due to lack of knowl-
edge relating to how a function or effect works (when the
unit is operating as designed) are not covered by the man-
ufacturer’s warranty, and are therefore the owners respon-
sibility. Please study this manual carefully and consult
your dealer before requesting service.
NAME PLATE LOCATION:
The graphic below indi-
cates the location of the name plate. The model number,
serial number, power requirements, etc., are located on
this plate. You should record the model number, serial
number, and the date of purchase in the spaces provided
below and retain this manual as a permanent record of
your purchase.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK.
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK).
NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Model
Serial No.
Purchase Date
CVP-409GP
(grand piano type)
CVP-409/407
92-469
1
(bottom)
3
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
PRECAUTIONS
PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING
* Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference.
WARNING
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even death from electrical
shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:
Only use the voltage specified as correct for the instrument. The required
voltage is printed on the name plate of the instrument.
Check the electric plug periodically and remove any dirt or dust which may have
accumulated on it.
Use only the supplied power cord/plug.
Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as heaters or radiators, and
do not excessively bend or otherwise damage the cord, place heavy objects on
it, or place it in a position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything
over it.
Do not open the instrument or attempt to disassemble the internal parts or
modify them in any way. The instrument contains no user-serviceable parts. If it
should appear to be malfunctioning, discontinue use immediately and have it
inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Do not expose the instrument to rain, use it near water or in damp or wet
conditions, or place containers on it containing liquids which might spill into
any openings. If any liquid such as water seeps into the instrument, turn off the
power immediately and unplug the power cord from the AC outlet. Then have
the instrument inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands.
Do not put burning items, such as candles, on the unit.
A burning item may fall over and cause a fire.
If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if there is a sudden
loss of sound during use of the instrument, or if any unusual smells or smoke
should appear to be caused by it, immediately turn off the power switch,
disconnect the electric plug from the outlet, and have the instrument inspected
by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
CAUTION
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or others, or damage
to the instrument or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:
When removing the electric plug from the instrument or an outlet, always hold
the plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by the cord can damage it.
Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the instrument is not to be used
for extended periods of time, or during electrical storms.
Do not connect the instrument to an electrical outlet using a multiple-connector.
Doing so can result in lower sound quality, or possibly cause overheating in the
outlet.
Read carefully the attached documentation explaining the assembly process.
Failure to assemble the instrument in the proper sequence might result in
damage to the instrument or even injury.
Do not expose the instrument to excessive dust or vibrations, or extreme cold or
heat (such as in direct sunlight, near a heater, or in a car during the day) to
prevent the possibility of panel disfiguration or damage to the internal
components.
Do not use the instrument in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo equipment,
mobile phone, or other electric devices. Otherwise, the instrument, TV, or radio
may generate noise.
Do not place the instrument in an unstable position where it might accidentally
fall over.
Before moving the instrument, remove all connected cables.
When setting up the product, make sure that the AC outlet you are using is
easily accessible. If some trouble or malfunction occurs, immediately turn off
the power switch and disconnect the plug from the outlet. Even when the power
switch is turned off, electricity is still flowing to the product at the minimum
level. When you are not using the product for a long time, make sure to unplug
the power cord from the wall AC outlet.
Power supply/Power cord
Do not open
Water warning
Fire warning
If you notice any abnormality
Power supply/Power cord
Assembly
Location
(1)B-13
1/2
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
4
Before connecting the instrument to other electronic components, turn off the
power for all components. Before turning the power on or off for all
components, set all volume levels to minimum. Also, be sure to set the volumes
of all components at their minimum levels and gradually raise the volume
controls while playing the instrument to set the desired listening level.
In the case of a model with a polished finish, gently remove dust and dirt with a
soft cloth. Do not wipe too hard since small particles of dirt can scratch the
instrument's finish.
When cleaning the instrument, use a soft, dry or slightly damp cloth. Do not use
paint thinners, solvents, cleaning fluids, or chemical-impregnated wiping
cloths.
During extreme changes in temperature or humidity, condensation may occur
and water may collect on the surface of the instrument. If water is left, the
wooden parts may absorb the water and be damaged. Make sure to wipe any
water off immediately with a soft cloth.
•Take care that the key cover does not pinch your fingers, and do not insert a
finger or hand in any gaps on the key cover or instrument.
Never insert or drop paper, metallic, or other objects into the gaps on the key
cover, panel or keyboard. If this happens, turn off the power immediately and
unplug the power cord from the AC outlet. Then have the instrument inspected
by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Do not place vinyl, plastic or rubber objects on the instrument, since this might
discolor the panel or keyboard.
In the case of a model with a polished finish, bumping the surface of the
instrument with metal, porcelain, or other hard objects can cause the finish to
crack or peel. Use caution.
Do not rest your weight on, or place heavy objects on the instrument, and do not
use excessive force on the buttons, switches or connectors.
Do not use the instrument/device or headphones for a long period of time at a
high or uncomfortable volume level, since this can cause permanent hearing
loss. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, consult a
physician.
Do not place the bench in an unstable position where it might accidentally fall
over.
Do not play carelessly with or stand on the bench. Using it as a tool or step-
ladder or for any other purpose might result in accident or injury.
Only one person should sit on the bench at a time, in order to prevent the
possibility of accident or injury.
(CVP-409 including grand piano type) Do not attempt to adjust the bench height
while sitting on the bench, since this can cause excessive force to be imposed
on the adjustment mechanism, possibly resulting in damage to the mechanism
or even injury.
If the bench screws become loose due to extensive long-term use, tighten them
periodically using the included tool.
Saving and backing up your data
The data of the types listed below are lost when you turn off the power to the
instrument. Save the data to the USER tab display (page 26), USB storage
device (USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc).
Recorded/Edited Songs (page 42, 143, 158)
Created/Edited Styles (page 117)
Edited Voices (page 99)
Memorized One Touch Settings (page 51)
Edited MIDI settings (page 196)
Moreover, the above-mentioned data can be saved all at once. Refer to page 76.
Data in the USER tab display (page 26) may be lost due to malfunction or
incorrect operation. Save important data to a USB storage device (USB flash
memory/floppy disk, etc).
Always turn the power off when the instrument is not in use.
Connections
Maintenance
Handling caution
When you change settings in a display page and then exit from that page,
System Setup data (listed in the Parameter Chart of the separate Data List
booklet) is automatically stored. However, this edited data is lost if you turn off
the power without properly exiting from the relevant display.
Using the bench (If included)
Saving data
Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the instrument, or data that is lost or destroyed.
(1)B-13
2/2
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
5
Thank you for purchasing this Yamaha Clavinova!
We recommend that you read this manual carefully so that you can fully take advantage of the advanced and
convenient functions of the instrument.
We also recommend that you keep this manual in a safe and handy place for future reference.
About this Owner’s Manual and Data List
This manual consists of the following sections.
Owner’s Manual
Introduction (page 10).......................... Please read this section first.
Quick Guide (page 23)......................... This section explains how to use the basic functions.
Basic Operation (page 63).................... This section explains how to use the basic operations including display-
based controls.
Reference (page 78) ............................. This section explains how to make detailed settings for the instrument’s
various functions.
Appendix (page 205)............................ This section contains additional information such as Troubleshooting and
Specifications.
Data List
Voice List, MIDI Data Format, etc.
•The models CVP-409/407 will be referred to as the CVP/Clavinova in this Owner’s Manual.
•The illustrations and LCD screens as shown in this owner’s manual are for instructional purposes only, and may appear somewhat different
from those on your instrument.
•The example Operation Guide displays shown in this Manual are in English.
Copying of the commercially available musical data including but not limited to MIDI data and/or audio data is strictly prohibited except
for your personal use.
•This device is capable of using various types/formats of music data by optimizing them to the proper format music data for use with the
device in advance. As a result, this device may not play them back precisely as their producers or composers originally intended.
Some of the preset songs have been edited for length or arrangement, and may not be exactly the same as the original.
•The photos of the harpsichord, bandoneon, hackbrett, music box, dulcimer and cimbalom, shown in the displays of the Clavinova, are
courtesy of the Gakkigaku Shiryokan (Collection for Organolgy), Kunitachi College of Music.
•The following instruments, shown in the displays of the Clavinova, are on display at the Hamamatsu Museum of Musical Instruments:
balafon, gender, kalimba, kanoon, santur, gamelan gong, harp, hand bell, bagpipe, banjo, carillon, mandolin, oud, pan flute, pungi, rabab,
shanai, sitar, steel drum, and tambra.
•This product is manufactured under license of U.S. Patents No.5231671, No.5301259, No.5428708, and No.5567901 from IVL Audio
Inc.
•The bitmap fonts used in this instrument have been provided by and are the property of Ricoh Co., Ltd.
•This product utilizes NF, an embedded Internet browser from ACCESS Co., Ltd. NF is used with the patented LZW, licensed
from Unisys Co., Ltd. NF may not be separated from this product, nor may it be sold, lent or transferred in any way. Also, NF
may not be reverse-engineered, reverse-compiled, reverse-assembled or copied.
This software includes a module developed by the Independent JPEG Group.
Trademarks:
All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders.
This product incorporates and bundles computer programs and contents in which Yamaha owns copyrights or
with respect to which it has license to use others' copyrights. Such copyrighted materials include, without lim-
itation, all computer software, style files, MIDI files, WAVE data, musical scores and sound recordings. Any
unauthorized use of such programs and contents outside of personal use is not permitted under relevant laws.
Any violation of copyright has legal consequences. DON'T MAKE, DISTRIBUTE OR USE ILLEGAL COPIES.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
6
Accessories
Guide to Yamaha Online Member Product User Registration
“50 greats for the Piano” Music Book
Owner’s Manual
Data List
The following items may be included or optional, depending on your locale:
Bench
Tuning
Unlike an acoustic piano, the instrument does not need to be tuned. It always stays perfectly in tune.
Transporting
If you move to another location, you can transport the instrument along with other belongings. You can move the
unit as it is (assembled) or you can disassemble the unit down to the condition it was in when you first took it out
of the box. Transport the keyboard horizontally. Do not lean it up against a wall or stand it up on its side.
Do not subject the instrument to excessive vibration or shock.
When transporting the assembled instrument, make sure all screws are properly tightened and have not been
loosened by moving the instrument.
After transporting the instrument, do the following to ensure optimum performance of the iAFC function
(page 82).
Place the Clavinova so that its rear panel is at least 10 cm away from the wall. (This is not necessary for the
CVP-409 grand piano type.)
(When using the SPATIAL EFFECT) Perform the automatic adjustment of the iAFC function (page 83).
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
7
Various display pages and menus appear on the LCD display of this instrument, indicating the functions and opera-
tions. Throughout this manual, arrows are used in the instructions, indicating in shorthand the process of calling up
these functions. The example shorthand below describes a four step operation:
1) press the [FUNCTION] button, 2) press the [D] button to select the Controller page, 3) press the TAB [
®
] button to
select the Keyboard/Panel page, and 4) press the [A] button to select the Initial Touch parameter.
[FUNCTION]
[D] CONTROLLER
TAB [
®
] KEYBOARD/PANEL
[A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH
Table of Contents
Introduction
Enhanced Realism and Natural
Expressiveness ................................................. 10
Panel Controls ................................................. 12
Playing the Keyboard ...................................... 14
Setting Up ....................................................... 16
Music Rest ................................................... 16
Sheet Music Braces ...................................... 16
Lid (CVP-409 grand piano type) ................... 16
Using Headphones ....................................... 17
Changing the Display Language .................. 18
Display Settings ........................................... 18
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and
Floppy Disks .................................................... 21
Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash
Memory/Floppy Disk, etc) .............................. 22
Quick Guide .......................23
Playing the Demos .......................................... 23
Operations in the Basic Displays ..................... 25
Operation of the Main Display ............................. 25
Operation of the File Selection Display ................. 26
Operation of the Function Display ........................ 27
Playing Voices ................................................. 28
Playing the Piano Voice ........................................ 28
Playing Various Voices .......................................... 32
Practicing with the Songs ............................... 35
Playing Back Songs Before Practicing .................... 35
Displaying Music Notation (Score) ....................... 38
One-handed Practice with the Guide Lamps ......... 39
Practicing with the Repeat Playback Function ....... 41
Recording Your Performance ................................ 42
Playing Backing Parts with the performance
assistant Technology ....................................... 43
Playing Accompaniment with the Auto
Accompaniment Feature (Style Playback) ...... 44
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto
Accompaniment Feature ...................................... 45
Calling Up Ideal Setups for Each Song
—Music Finder ................................................ 52
Calling up the panel settings to match the Style
(Repertoire) .......................................................... 53
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke)
or Your Own Performance .............................. 54
Connecting a Microphone ................................... 54
Singing with the Lyrics Display ............................. 55
Convenient Functions for Karaoke ........................ 56
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your
Own Performance ................................................ 58
Recording Your Performance as Audio
(USB Audio Recorder) ..................................... 60
Recording Your Performance as Audio .................. 60
Playing Back the Recorded Performance ............... 62
Basic Operation
Basic Operation ................................63
Selecting Message Language .......................... 63
The Messages Shown in the Display .............. 63
Instant Selection of the Displays
—Direct Access ................................................ 64
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection
Display) ............................................................ 65
Main Display ........................................................ 65
File Selection Display Configuration and Basic
Operation ............................................................. 66
File/Folder Operations in the File Selection Display
... 68
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings
... 74
Restoring the Factory-programmed System .......... 74
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings
Independently by Item ......................................... 75
Saving and Recalling Your Original Settings as a
Single File ............................................................. 75
Data Backup .................................................... 76
Backup procedure ................................................ 77
Reference
Using, Creating and Editing Voices ..78
Voice Characteristics ....................................... 78
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously ........ 79
Keyboard Parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left) .................. 79
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously
(Right 1 and 2 Parts) ............................................ 80
Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right
Hands (Right 1 and Left Parts) .............................. 81
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound
(iAFC) ............................................................... 82
Adjusting the iAFC Depth ..................................... 82
Calibrating the iAFC Settings ................................ 83
Restoring the Default Calibration Setting
[iAFC Default] ....................................................... 84
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
8
Changing Pitch ................................................ 84
Transpose ............................................................. 84
Fine-tuning the Pitch of the Entire Instrument ...... 84
Scale Tuning ........................................................ 84
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the
Keyboard ......................................................... 86
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance
(MIXING CONSOLE) ....................................... 88
Basic Procedure .................................................... 88
Voice Creating (Sound Creator) ..................... 99
Basic Procedure .................................................... 99
Creating Your Original Organ Flutes Voices ........ 103
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto
Accompaniment Styles ...................107
Style Characteristics ...................................... 107
Selecting a Chord Fingering Type ................ 107
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels of a
Style ............................................................... 108
Style Playback-related Settings ..................... 109
Split Point Settings ....................................... 111
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance of the
Style (MIXING CONSOLE) ............................ 112
Convenient Music Finder feature ................. 112
Searching the Records ........................................ 112
Creating a Set of Favorite Records ...................... 114
Editing Records .................................................. 114
Saving the Record .............................................. 115
Style Creator ................................................. 117
Style Structure .................................................... 117
Creating a Style .................................................. 118
Editing the Created Style .................................... 123
Registering and Recalling Custom
Panel Setups
—Registration Memory ..................131
Registering and Saving Custom Panel
Setups ............................................................ 131
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups ......... 132
Deleting an Unneeded Panel Setup/Naming a
Panel Setup ........................................................ 133
Disabling Recall of Specific Items
(Freeze Function) ............................................... 133
Calling Up Registration Memory Numbers in Order
—Registration Sequence .................................... 134
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
...136
Compatible Song Types ................................ 136
Operations for Song Playback ...................... 137
Adjusting the Volume Balance and Voice
Combination, etc. (MIXING CONSOLE) ....... 140
Using the Practice Function (Guide) ............ 141
Selecting the Guide Function Type ..................... 141
Recording Your Performance ....................... 143
Recording Methods ............................................ 143
Editing a Recorded Song .................................... 158
Using a Microphone .......................167
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters .............. 167
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony
Sound ............................................................ 170
Talk Setting ................................................... 174
Connecting the Clavinova Directly
to the Internet ...............................176
Connecting the Instrument to the Internet
.. 176
Accessing the Special Website ...................... 177
Operations in the Special Website ............... 177
Scrolling the Display ........................................... 177
Following Links ................................................... 178
Entering Characters ............................................ 178
Return to the Previous Web Page ........................ 178
Refreshing a Web Page/Canceling Loading of a
Web Page ........................................................... 179
Purchasing and Downloading Data .................... 180
Registering Bookmarks of Your Favorite Pages .... 180
About the Internet Settings Display .................... 183
Changing the Home Page .................................. 186
Initializing Internet Settings ................................ 187
Glossary of Internet Terms ........................... 188
Using Your Instrument with Other
Devices ............................................189
Using Headphones (1
[PHONES] jacks) ...... 189
Connecting a Microphone or Guitar
(2
[MIC./LINE IN] jack) ................................ 189
Connecting Audio & Video Devices
(345
) .. 189
Using External Audio Devices for playback and
Recording (3
[AUX OUT] Jacks, [AUX OUT
(LEVEL FIXED)] Jacks) .......................................... 189
Playing External Audio Devices with the Built-in
Speakers (4
[AUX IN] Jacks) ............................... 190
Showing the Instrument’s Display Contents on an
External Monitor
(5
[VIDEO OUT] Terminal, [RGB OUT] Terminal
) .. 190
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller
(6
[AUX PEDAL] jack) ................................... 191
Assigning Specific Functions to Each Foot Pedal
... 191
Connecting External MIDI Devices
(7
[MIDI] Terminals) .................................... 194
Connecting a Computer, USB Device,
or Internet (789)
) ................................... 194
Connecting a Computer
(7
[MIDI] and 8
[USB TO HOST] Terminals) ..... 194
Connecting to a USB-type LAN Adaptor and USB
Storage Device
(9
via the [USB TO DEVICE] Terminal) ............... 195
Connect to the Internet ()
[LAN] Port) .............. 196
What is MIDI? ................................................ 196
What You Can Do With MIDI ....................... 199
MIDI Settings ................................................ 200
Basic Operation .................................................. 200
Pre-Programmed MIDI Templates ....................... 201
MIDI System Settings ......................................... 202
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
9
Using
Your
Instrument
with
Other
Devices
Introduction
Quick Guide
Basic Operation
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto
Accompaniment Styles
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
Using a Microphone
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the
Internet
Using Your Instrument with Other
Devices
Appendix
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Reference
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
MIDI Transmit Settings ....................................... 202
MIDI Receive Settings......................................... 203
Setting the Bass Note for Style Playback via MIDI
Receive ............................................................... 203
Setting the Chord Type for Style Playback via MIDI
Receive ............................................................... 204
Appendix
Troubleshooting ............................................ 205
CVP-409 grand piano type: Keyboard Stand
Assembly ....................................................... 210
CVP-409/407: Keyboard Stand Assembly ..... 213
Installing the Floppy Disk Drive (Optional) .. 216
Specifications ................................................ 217
Index .............................................................. 219
Panel Button Chart ....................................... 222
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
10
Introduction
Enhanced Realism and Natural Expressiveness
Authentic Acoustic Piano-like Touch
NW (Natural Wood) with Synthetic ivory keytops (CVP-409 including grand
piano type)
This is the first Clavinova featuring a keyboard that has the feel of real ivory. The special
Natural Wood keyboard of the CVP-409 uses real-wood white keys. The key surface is
soft and slightly porous, giving the keys added grip and a natural friction that lets you play
easily. The authentic touch and feel of the keys goes far beyond existing electronic key-
boards, it makes you feel as if you’re playing a real grand piano. This specially crafted key-
board lets you use techniques only possible on grand pianos, such as playing the same
note successively and having the sounds blend smoothly even without use of the damper
pedal, or playing the same key quickly and having perfect articulation without the sound
cutting off unnaturally.
NW (Natural Wood) Keyboard (CVP-407)
The special Natural Wood keyboard of the CVP-407 uses real-wood white keys, to repro-
duce as closely as possible the experience of playing an actual acoustic grand piano. The
authentic touch and feel of the keys goes far beyond existing electronic keyboards, realis-
tically recreating the hardness of the keys, the balance between the weight of the key and
hammer, and the characteristic weight gradations of the keys – heavy in the low end, light
in the high register – to make you feel as if you’re playing a real grand piano. Moreover,
this specially crafted keyboard lets you use techniques only possible on grand pianos,
such as playing the same note successively and having the sounds blend smoothly even
without use of the damper pedal, or playing the same key quickly and having perfect
articulation without the sound cutting off unnaturally.
Turn on the iAFC (Instrumental Active Field Control) effect, and hear the sound expand
around you—as if you’re playing on stage in a concert hall. Use the Spatial Effect to rec-
reate and emphasize the natural sounds of true acoustic instruments. The overall sound
is deeper and more resonant, especially when using the damper pedal (Dynamic
Damper Effect).
The Acoustic Ambience of a Grand Piano
—with the iAFC Feature
SPATIAL Effect (greater depth) DYNAMIC DAMPER EffectSPATIAL Effect (less depth)
The Spatial Effect, which recreates the natural sounds of true acoustic instruments, is not
applied to the default setting. For more details about iAFC, see page 82.
Audio Recording
Recording Your Performance as Audio......................................page 60
You can record your performance as audio data to a USB flash memory. Con-
nect a microphone or guitar to the instrument and enjoy recording a guitar
and keyboard performance together, or record your singing along with Song
playback (in karaoke fashion).
11
Introduction
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
Perform Along with a Full Band
—Song Playback.........................................................................page 35
Play along with previously recorded Song data, and fill out your solo perfor-
mance with the sounds and arrangement of an entire band or orchestra.
Ease in Playing Backing Parts with Songs,
—performance assistant technology.........................................page 43
The new performance assistant technology features make it exceptionally
easy to play professional-sounding backing parts along with Song playback.
Playing Melodies along with Auto Accompaniment,
—Style Playback .........................................................................page 44
Use the Style playback features to automatically produce full backing parts and
accompaniment, while you play melodies on top. It’s like having an expert ensemble
playing behind you. Select an accompaniment Style—such as pop, jazz, Latin, etc.—
and let the instrument be your backing band!
Playing the Instrument
Playing Piano Voices ................................................................ page 28
With just the press of a button, you can reconfigure the entire instrument for
optimum piano performance, no matter what settings you’ve made from the
panel. Now you can enjoy performing and practicing with authentic grand
piano sounds and response—instantly.
Playing Other Instrument Voices ..............................................page 32
The instrument gives you not only various realistic piano Voices, but also features an
exceptionally wide variety of authentic instruments, both acoustic and electronic.
Practicing
Displaying and Playing along with the Music Score ................page 59
While playing back a Song, you can have the music score (notation) automati-
cally shown on the display—an exceptionally convenient tool for learning and
practicing pieces.
Guide Lamps...............................................................................page 39
The key guide lamps are also helpful in learning and practicing, since they
indicate the notes you should play, when you should play them, and how long
you should hold them down.
Recording Your Performance.................................................... page 42
The instrument lets you easily record your own performance and save it to inter-
nal memory or a USB storage device. This, too, is an excellent practice tool, let-
ting you listen back to your playing and spot your strong and weak points.
Expand Your Song Collection
Internet Direct Connection......................................................page 176
The instrument also connects directly to the Internet, letting you download Song data
from special websites, and save them to internal memory or a USB storage device.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
12
Introduction
Panel Controls
1 [POWER] switch .............................................................. P. 14
2 [USB TO DEVICE] Terminal.............................................. P. 22
3 [MASTER VOLUME] dial.................................................. P. 15
4 [DEMO] button................................................................ P. 23
METRONOME
5 [ON/OFF] button ............................................................. P. 30
TRANSPOSE
6 [–] [+] buttons.................................................................. P. 56
TEMPO
7 [TAP TEMPO] button........................................................ P. 47
8 [–] [+] buttons.................................................................. P. 31
STYLE CONTROL
9 STYLE category selection buttons..................................... P. 45
0 [ACMP ON/OFF] button .................................................. P. 46
A [AUTO FILL IN] button .................................................... P. 48
B INTRO [I]/[II]/[III] buttons ................................................ P. 47
C MAIN VARIATION [A]/[B]/[C]/[D] buttons ....................... P. 48
D [BREAK] button................................................................ P. 48
E ENDING/rit. [I]/[II]/[III] buttons ........................................ P. 48
F [SYNC STOP] button........................................................ P. 48
G [SYNC START] button ...................................................... P. 47
H [START/STOP] button....................................................... P. 47
I [MUSIC FINDER] button.................................................. P. 52
J [LCD CONTRAST] knob .................................................. P. 18
K [A]–[J] buttons.................................................................. P. 25
L [DIRECT ACCESS] button................................................. P. 64
M [MIXING CONSOLE] button............................................ P. 88
N [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button ................................. P. 109, 143
O [1
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons ................................................ P. 25
P TAB [
][
®
] buttons......................................................... P. 26
Q [EXIT] button.................................................................... P. 26
R [DATA ENTRY] dial .......................................................... P. 67
S [ENTER] button ................................................................ P. 67
T [USB] button .................................................................... P. 67
U [USER] button .................................................................. P. 67
PART ON/OFF
V [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button ................................................. P. 79
W [SPLIT (LEFT)] button........................................................ P. 79
X [FUNCTION] button ........................................................ P. 27
Y [INTERNET] button ........................................................ P. 176
SONG CONTROL
Z [SONG SELECT] button.................................................... P. 35
[ [REC] button .................................................................... P. 42
\ [STOP] button .................................................................. P. 35
] [PLAY/PAUSE] button ....................................................... P. 35
^ [REW]/[FF] buttons......................................................... P. 138
a [EXTRA TRACKS] button................................................. P. 144
b [TRACK 2 (L)] button ........................................................ P. 41
c [TRACK 1 (R)] button........................................................ P. 39
d [SCORE] button................................................................ P. 38
e [LYRICS/TEXT] button....................................................... P. 55
f [GUIDE] button................................................................ P. 39
g [REPEAT] button ............................................................... P. 41
PIANO Setting
h [PIANO RESET] button ..................................................... P. 29
REGISTRATION MEMORY
i REGIST BANK [+] [–] buttons ......................................... P. 132
j [MEMORY] button .........................................................P. 131
k [1]–[8] buttons ............................................................... P. 131
13
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
Introduction
VOICE CONTROL
l VOICE category selection buttons .................................... P. 32
m [VOICE EFFECT] button ................................................... P. 86
ONE TOUCH SETTING
n [1]–[4] buttons................................................................. P. 50
o [OTS LINK] button ........................................................... P. 51
p Drum Kit icons................ Data List (Drum/key Assignment List)
Pedals
q Left pedal......................................................................... P. 30
r Sostenuto pedal ............................................................... P. 30
s Damper pedal.................................................................. P. 30
t Keyboard guide lamps ..................................................... P. 39
u Mic signal/over lamps...................................................... P. 54
For quick reference, also see the alphabetically
sorted “Panel Button Chart” on page 222.
For information on the jacks and connectors located
on the bottom left of the instrument, see page 189.
The [USB TO DEVICE] terminal is also located on the
bottom left of the instrument.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
14
Introduction
Playing the Keyboard
1
Connecting the power cable
First insert the plug of the power cable into the AC connector on the instru-
ment, then plug the other end of the cable into the proper AC outlet on the
wall.
2
Opening the key cover
Using the hand grip on the front, lift open the key cover.
3
Turning the power on
Press the [POWER] switch located on the right of the keyboard to turn the
power on. The display located in the center of the front panel and the power
indicator located below the left end of the keyboard lights up.
CAUTION
Hold the cover with both
hands when opening or clos-
ing it. Do not release it until it
is fully opened or closed. Be
careful to avoid catching fin-
gers (yours or others, espe-
cially children’s) between the
cover and the unit.
CAUTION
Do not place objects such as a
piece of metal or paper on
top of the key cover. Small
objects placed on the key
cover may fall inside the unit
when the cover is opened and
may be nearly impossible to
remove. This could cause elec-
tric shock, short circuit, fire or
other serious damage to the
instrument.
(The shape of the plug and outlet dif-
fer depending on locale.)
CAUTION
Be careful to avoid catching your fingers
when opening the cover.
The power indicator
lights up.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
15
Introduction
4 Playing the keyboard
Play the keyboard to produce sound.
Adjusting the volume
While playing the keyboard, adjust the volume level by using the [MASTER
VOLUME] located at the left of the panel.
5 Turning the power off
Press the [POWER] switch to turn the power off.
The screen and the power indicator turn off.
6 Closing the key cover
Grip the metal rim at the top of the panel, and close the key cover.
CAUTION
Be careful to avoid catching your fingers
when closing the cover.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
16
Introduction
Setting Up
Music Rest
To Raise the Music Rest:
CVP-409 grand piano type
1 Pull the music rest up and toward
yourself as far as it will go.
2 Flip down the two metal supports at
the left and the right on the rear of the
music rest.
3 Lower the music rest so that it rests on
the metal supports.
CVP-409/407
Pull the music rest toward yourself as far as it will go.
When raised, the music rest is fixed at a certain
angle and cannot be adjusted.
To Lower the Music Rest:
CVP-409 grand piano type
1 Pull the music rest toward yourself as
far as it will go.
2 Raise the two metal supports until
they are flat against the rear surface of
the music rest.
3 Gently lower the music rest backward
until it is all the way down.
CVP-409/407
Lift the music rest slightly, then turn it
back slowly.
Sheet Music Braces
These braces are for holding the pages of music books in place.
To Open To Close
Lid (CVP-409 grand piano type)
One long stay and one short stay are provided on the lid. Use one of them to open
the lid to the desired angle.
To open the lid:
1 Raise the music rest as described in
“Music Rest” above.
2 Raise and hold the right side of the lid
(viewed from the keyboard end of the
instrument).
3 Raise the lid stay and carefully lower the
lid so that the end of the stay fits into the
recess in the lid.
CAUTION
When raising or lowering the
music rest, do not release
y
our hands from the music
rest until it is all the way up or
down.
CAUTION
Before lowering the music
rest, close the sheet music
braces (see below).
The music rest will not close
unless the sheet music braces
are also closed.
To turn on the iAFC (page 82),
open the lid with the longer
stay using the inner recess.
When the lid is closed or open
with the shorter stay, the iAFC
will not be turned on.
CVP-409 grand
piano type
CVP-409/407
CAUTION
Be careful to avoid
catching your fingers.
Close the sheet
music braces
CVP-409/407
CVP-409 grand
piano type
3
2
1
Using Headphones
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
17
Introduction
For the longer stay, use the inner recess, and for the shorter stay, use the outer
recess to support the lid.
To close the lid:
1 Hold the lid stay and carefully raise the
lid.
2 Hold the lid in its raised position and
lower the lid stay.
3 Carefully lower the lid.
Using Headphones
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the
[PHONES] jacks located on the bottom left
of the instrument.
Two sets of standard stereo headphones
can be connected. (If you are using only
one pair of headphones, you can plug
them into either of these jacks.)
Using the Headphone Hanger
A headphone hanger is included in the instrument
package so that you can hang the headphones on the
instrument. Install the headphone hanger using
included two screws (4 x 10mm) as shown in the figure.
Longer stay Shorter stay
1
3
2
CAUTION
•Make sure that the end of
the stay fits securely in the
lid recess. If the stay is not
properly seated in the
recess, the lid may fall, caus-
ing damage or injury.
Be careful that you or oth-
ers do not bump the stay
while the lid is raised. The
stay may be bumped out of
the lid recess causing the lid
to fall.
Be careful to avoid catching
fingers (yours or others,
especially children’s) when
raising or lowering the lid.
MIN MAX
INPUT
MIC.
MIC. LINE PHONES
VOLUME
LINE IN
CAUTION
Do not listen with the head-
phones at high volume for
long periods of time. Doing
so may cause hearing loss.
CAUTION
Do not hang anything other
than the headphones on the
hanger. Otherwise, the instru-
ment or the hanger may be
damaged.
Outputting sound from the speaker while headphones are con-
nected
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] CONFIG 2
2 Press the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] (SPEAKER) button to select “ON.”
Outputting sound only from the headphones
From the display called up in step 1 above, press the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
]
(SPEAKER) button to select “OFF.”
When “OFF” is selected, the speakers will not sound and you can only hear
the instrument sound via the headphones.
Changing the Display Language
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
18
Introduction
Changing the Display Language
This determines the language used in the display for messages, file names, and
character input.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] OWNER
2 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] button to select a language.
To return to the original display,
press the [EXIT] button.
Display Settings
Adjusting the Contrast of the Display
You can adjust the contrast of the display by turning the [LCD CONTRAST] knob
located to the left of the display.
Display Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
19
Introduction
Adjusting the Brightness of the Display
Adjust the brightness of the display.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] CONFIG 2
2 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
] button to adjust the brightness of the display.
Selecting a Picture for the Main Display Back-
ground
This function lets you select your favorite picture to be used as background for the
Main display (page 25).
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] OWNER
2 Press the [J] (MAIN PICTURE) button to call up the Picture Selection
Display.
3 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a picture.
J
33
2
Display Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
20
Introduction
After selecting, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button then press the [EXIT] button to
return to the Main display. The newly selected picture is shown as the background
of the Main display.
Entering the Owner Name in the Opening Display
You can have your name appear in the opening display (the display that first
appears when the power is turned on).
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] OWNER
2
Press the [I] (OWNER NAME) button and call up the Owner Name display.
Refer to page 73 for character-entry details.
The explanation about picture
compatibility at right applies
also to the background of the
Song Lyrics display.
Importing a favorite picture for the Main display background
Even though a variety of pictures are available on the Preset drive, you can
load your own favorite picture data from USB storage device (USB flash
memory/floppy disk, etc) to the instrument for use as background.
Make sure to use images no larger than 640 x 480 pixels.
If you select a picture file on the USB storage device (USB flash memory/
floppy disk, etc), the background may take some time to appear. If you want
to reduce this time, save the background from the USB drive to the USER
drive of the Picture Selection display.
If you select a picture file on the USB drive, the selected background will
not be displayed when the power is turned on again unless the same media
containing the data has been inserted into the drive.
Displaying the version number
To check the version number of this instrument, press the [7
π†
]/[8
π†
]
(VERSION) buttons in the display in step 1 above. Press the [EXIT] button to
return to the original display.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
21
Introduction
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and Floppy Disks
(The floppy disk drive is optional. For instructions
on installing the floppy disk drive, see page 216.)
The floppy disk drive lets you save original data you’ve cre-
ated on the instrument to floppy disk, and allows you to
load data from floppy disk to the instrument.
Be sure to handle floppy disks and treat the disk drive with
care. Follow the important precautions below.
Floppy Disk Compatibility
3.5" 2DD and 2HD type floppy disks can be used.
Formatting a Floppy Disk
If you find that you are unable to use new, blank disks or
old disks that have been used with other devices, you
may need to format them. For details on how to format a
disk, see page 68. Keep in mind that all data on the disk
will be lost after formatting. Make sure to check before-
hand whether or not the disk contains important data.
n
Floppy disks formatted on this device may or may not be useable
as is on other devices.
Inserting/Removing Floppy Disks
Inserting a Floppy Disk into the Disk Drive:
Hold the disk so that the label of the disk is facing
upward and the sliding shutter is facing forward, towards
the disk slot. Carefully insert the disk into the slot, slowly
pushing it all the way in until it clicks into place and the
eject button pops out.
n
Never insert anything but floppy disks into the disk drive. Other
objects may cause damage to the disk drive or floppy disks.
Removing a Floppy Disk
After checking that the instrument is not accessing* the
floppy disk (checking that the use lamp on the floppy
disk drive is off), firmly press the eject button at the
upper right of the disk slot all the way in.
When the floppy disk is ejected, pull it out of the drive. If
the floppy disk cannot be removed because it is stuck,
do not try to force it, but instead try pressing the eject
button again, or try re-inserting the disk and attempt to
eject it again.
* Access of the disk indicates an active operation, such as
recording, playback, or deletion of data.
If a floppy disk is inserted while the power is on, the disk is
automatically accessed, since the instrument checks whether
the disk has data.
Be sure to remove the floppy disk from the disk drive
before turning off the power. A floppy disk left in the
drive for extended periods can easily pick up dust and
dirt that can cause data-read and -write errors.
Cleaning the Disk Drive Read/Write Head
Clean the read/write head regularly. This instrument
employs a precision magnetic read/write head which,
after an extended period of use, will pick up a layer of
magnetic particles from the disks used that will eventu-
ally cause read and write errors.
•To maintain the disk drive in optimum working order
Yamaha recommends that you use a commercially-avail-
able dry-type head cleaning disk to clean the head about
once a month. Ask your Yamaha dealer about the avail-
ability of proper headcleaning disks.
About Floppy Disks
Handle floppy disks with care, and fol-
low these precautions:
Do not place heavy objects on a disk or bend or apply
pressure to the disk in any way. Always keep floppy disks
in their protective cases when they are not in use.
Do not expose the disk to direct sunlight, extremely high
or low temperatures, or excessive humidity, dust or liq-
uids.
Do not open the sliding shutter and touch the exposed
surface of the floppy disk inside.
Do not expose the disk to magnetic fields, such as those
produced by televisions, speakers, motors, etc., since
magnetic fields can partially or completely erase data on
the disk, rendering it unreadable.
Never use a floppy disk with a deformed shutter or hous-
ing.
Do not attach anything other than the provided labels to
a floppy disk. Also make sure that labels are attached in
the proper location.
To Protect Your Data (Write-protect Tab):
•To prevent accidental erasure of important data, slide the
disk’s write-protect tab to the “protect” position (tab
open). When saving data, make sure that the disk’s write-
protect tab is set to the “overwrite” position (tab closed).
CAUTION
Do not remove the floppy disk or turn off the instrument
itself while the disk is being accessed.
Doing so may result not only in loss of data on the disk
but also damage to the floppy disk drive.
Write-protect tab open
(protect position)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
22
Introduction
Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash Memory/Floppy Disk, etc)
This instrument features a built-in [USB TO DEVICE] termi-
nal. When connecting a USB device to the terminal, be
sure to handle the USB device with care. Follow the
important precautions below.
n
For more information about the handling of USB devices, refer to
the owner’s manual of the USB device.
Compatible USB devices
USB storage devices (flash memory, floppy disk drive,
hard disk drive, etc.)
USB hub
USB-LAN adaptor
The instrument does not necessarily support all commer-
cially available USB devices. Yamaha cannot guarantee
operation of USB devices that you purchase. Before pur-
chasing a USB device for use with this instrument,
please visit the following web page:
http://music.yamaha.com/download/
n
Other USB devices such as a computer keyboard or
mouse cannot be used.
Connecting USB device
When connecting a USB device to the [USB TO
DEVICE] terminal, make sure that the connector on the
device is appropriate and that it is connected in the
proper direction.
If you intend to connect two or three devices at the same
time to a terminal, you should use a USB hub device.
The USB hub must be self-powered (with its own power
source) and the power must be on. Only one USB hub
can be used. If an error message appears while using the
USB hub, disconnect the hub from the instrument, then
turn on the power of the instrument and re-connect the
USB hub.
•Though the instrument supports the USB 1.1 standard,
you can connect and use a USB 2.0 storage device with
the instrument. However, note that the transfer speed is
that of USB 1.1.
Using USB Storage Devices
By connecting the instrument to a USB storage device, you
can save data you’ve created to the connected device, as
well as read data from the connected device.
n
Although CD-R/RW drives can be used to read data to
the instrument, they cannot be used for saving data.
The number of USB storage device to be
used
Up to two USB storage devices can be connected to the
[USB TO DEVICE] terminal. (If necessary, use a USB hub.
The number of USB storage devices that can be used
simultaneously with musical instruments even when a USB
hub is used is a maximum of two.) This instrument can rec-
ognize up to four drives in one USB storage device.
Formatting USB storage media
When a USB storage device is connected or media is
inserted, a message may appear prompting you to format
the device/media. If so, execute the Format operation
(page 68).
Protecting your data (write-protect)
To prevent important data from being inadvertently erased,
apply the write-protect provided with each storage device
or media. If you are saving data to the USB storage device,
make sure to disable write-protect.
Connecting/removing USB storage
device
Before removing the media from the device, make sure
that the instrument is not accessing data (such as in the
Save, Copy and Delete operations).
CAUTION
When connecting a USB device to the [USB TO DEVICE]
terminal on the top panel, remove it before closing the
key cover. If the key cover is closed with the USB device
connected, the USB device may be damaged.
CAUTION
The format operation overwrites any previously existing
data. Make sure that the media you are formatting does
not contain important data. Proceed with caution, espe-
cially when connecting multiple USB storage media.
CAUTION
Avoid frequently turning the power on/off to the USB
storage device, or connecting/disconnecting the device
too often. Doing so may result in the operation of the
instrument “freezing” or hanging up. While the instru-
ment is accessing data (such as during Save, Copy, Delete,
Load and Format operations) or is mounting the USB
storage device (shortly after the connection), do NOT
unplug the USB connector, do NOT remove the media
from the device, and do NOT turn the power off to either
device. Doing so may corrupt the data on either or both
devices.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
23
Quick Guide
Quick Guide
Playing the Demos
The Demos are more than just songs—they also provide helpful, easy-to-understand introductions to the
features, functions and operations of the instrument. In a way, the Demos are an interactive “mini-man-
ual”—complete with sound demonstrations and text showing what it can do for you.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J]UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] OWNER
2 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons
to select the desired language.
Demos will play back continuously until
stopped.
When the Demo stops, the display returns
to the MAIN display (page 65).
1 Select the desired Language.
2 Press the [DEMO] button to start the Demos.
3 Press the [EXIT] button to stop the Demo playback.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
24
Showing Specific Demo Topics
To return back to the previous display,
press the [J] button.
When the Demo has more than
one screen.
Press a [
π†
] button corresponding
to the screen number.
1 Press the [7ππ
ππ
]/[8ππ
ππ
] buttons in the Demo display to call up the specific Demo menu.
2 Press one of the [A]–[I] buttons to show a specific Demo.
3 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from Demo.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
25
Operations in the Basic Displays
To start with, you should know a little about the basic displays that appear in the Quick Guide. There are
three basic displays:
Main display See below.
File selection display page 26
Function display page 27
Operation of the Main Display
The Main display shows the basic settings and important information for the instrument (It is the same display that
appears when the instrument is turned on.).You can also call up display pages related to the displayed function from
the Main display.
n About information in the Main display
See page 65.
1 [A]–[J] buttons
The [A]–[J] buttons correspond to the settings
indicated next to the buttons.
For example, press the [F] button, and the
Voice (RIGHT 1) selection display will appear
in the display.
2 [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons
The [1
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons correspond to
the parameters which are indicated above the
buttons.
For example, pressing the [1
π
] button will
increase the Song (page 35) volume.
3 [DIRECT ACCESS] and [EXIT] buttons
Here’s a convenient way to return to the Main
display from any other display: Simply press the
[DIRECT ACCESS] button, then the [EXIT] button.
1 1
3
3
2
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
26
Operation of the File Selection Display
In the File Selection display, you can select the Voice (page 28)/Song (page 35)/Style (page 44), etc.
In the example here, we’ll call up and use the Song Selection display.
About PRESET/USER/USB
PRESET .............. Internal memory to which the preprogrammed data are installed as preset data.
USER ................. Internal memory that allows both reading and writing of data.
USB ...................USB storage device, such as USB flash memory/floppy disk drive, etc., which is connected
to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.
n Hereafter in this manual, any USB storage device such as USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc. will be referred to as “USB
storage device.
Several Songs may be together in a
folder. In this case, the folder(s) will
appear in the display (see the illustration
at right). Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons
to select a folder.
Press the [8
π
] (UP) button to call up
the next highest level folder.
When the drive contains more than ten Songs, the display is divided up into several pages. The page indica-
tions are shown at the bottom of the display. Press one of the [1
π
]–[6
π
] buttons to select a page.
You can also select a Song by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.
3,
5
1
2
4
3,
5
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display.
2 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the desired drive (PRESET/USER/USB).
3 Select a folder (if necessary).
4 Select a page (if the display has several pages).
5 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song.
6 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
27
Operation of the Function Display
In the Function display, you can make detailed settings.
In the example here, we’ll call up and use the keyboard touch sensitivity setting display.
Categories of detailed settings are
shown.
When the selected category is further
divided into sub-categories, the tab(s)
will be shown in the display.
When the setting is further divided into
additional settings, a list will be shown
in the display.
1 Press the [FUNCTION] button.
2 Press the [D] button to select the category CONTROLLER.
3 Press the TAB [
®
] button to select the KEYBOARD/PANEL tab.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
28
For details on the touch sensitivity settings, see page 29.
Playing Voices
The instrument features a variety of Voices, including exceptionally realistic piano Voices.
Playing the Piano Voice
Here, we’ll call up and play the piano voice. You can play the piano voice using the pedals or metronome.
4 Press the [A] button to select the “1 INITIAL TOUCH.”
4
5
5 Press the [1
ππ
ππ
]/[2
ππ
ππ
] button to select touch sensitivity for the keyboard.
Throughout this manual, arrows are used in the instructions, indicating in shorthand the process of calling up certain
displays and functions.
For example, the instructions above can be indicated in shorthand as: [FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [
®
]
KEYBOARD/PANEL [A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH.
[PIANO RESET] button
(page 29)
METRONOME
[ON/OFF] button
(page 30)
VOICE category selection buttons (page 32)
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
29
One-touch Piano Play
This convenient, easy-to-use feature completely and automatically reconfigures the entire instrument for optimum
piano performance. No matter what settings you’ve made from the panel, you can instantly call up the piano settings
by a single button press.
Piano Lock Function
The convenient Piano Lock function lets you “lock” the piano so that you don’t inadvertently change the settings by
pressing another button on the panel. Once locked, the instrument stays in the piano mode, even if other buttons are
pressed—preventing you from accidentally starting a Song (page 35) during your piano performance.
1 Press and hold down the [PIANO RESET] button on the lower right of the panel for three seconds
or longer, until a message appears prompting you to enable Piano Lock.
2 Press the [F] (OK) button to enable Piano Lock.
3 To turn Piano Lock off, press and hold down the [PIANO RESET] button again for three seconds or
longer.
Press the piano-shaped [PIANO RESET] button on the lower right of the panel.
Setting the touch sensitivity of the keyboard
You can adjust the touch response of the instrument (how the sound responds to the way you play the keys). The touch
sensitivity type becomes the common setting for all Voices.
1 Call up the operation display:
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [
®
] KEYBOARD/
PANEL [A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH
2 Press the [1
π†
]/[2
π†
] buttons to specify the touch response.
HARD 2 ..... Requires strong playing to produce high volume. Best
for players with a heavy touch.
HARD 1 ..... Requires moderately strong playing for high volume.
NORMAL... Standard touch response.
SOFT 1....... Produces high volume with moderate playing strength.
SOFT 2....... Produces relatively high volume even with light play-
ing strength. Best for players with a light touch.
•This setting does not change the weight of the keyboard.
•When you do not want to apply touch sensitivity, set Touch to OFF for
the corresponding parts by pressing the [5
]–[7
] buttons. When
Touch is set to OFF, you can specify the fixed volume level by press-
ing the [4
π†
] button.
•The touch sensitivity settings may have no effect with certain voices.
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
30
Using the Pedals
The instrument features three pedals.
Damper Pedal (Right)
The damper pedal performs the same function as the damper pedal on an
actual acoustic piano, letting you sustain the sound of the voices even
after releasing the keys.
Some Voices may sound continuously or have a long decay after the notes
have been released while the damper pedal is held.
Certain Voices in the “PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT,” “GM&XG” and “GM2”
groups may not be affected by use of the damper pedal.
Sostenuto Pedal (Center)
If you play a note or chord on the keyboard and press the sostenuto pedal
while holding the note(s), the notes will sustain as long as the pedal is
held. All subsequent notes will not sustain.
Certain Voices, such as [STRINGS] or [BRASS], sustain continuously when
the sostenuto pedal is pressed.
Certain Voices in the “PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT”, “GM&XG” and “GM2”
groups may not be affected by use of the sostenuto pedal.
Left Pedal
When the Piano voice is selected, pressing this pedal reduces the volume
and slightly changes the timbre of the notes you play.
The settings assigned to this pedal may differ depending on the selected Voice.
n The depth of the left pedal effect can be adjusted (page 101).
Foot Controller/Footswitch
An optional Yamaha foot controller (FC7) or footswitch (FC4 or FC5) can be connected to the AUX PEDAL jack and
used to control various functions assigned (page 191).
Using the Metronome
The metronome provides a click sound, giving you an accurate tempo guide when you practice, or letting you hear and
check how a specific tempo sounds.
Damper Pedal
Sostenuto Pedal
Left Pedal
When you press the damper pedal
here, the notes you play before you
release the pedal have a longer sustain.
n
When you press the sostenuto
pedal here while holding the
note(s), the notes will sustain as
long as you hold the pedal.
n
Making Settings for the Pedals
You can assign one of the various functions to the three pedals or an optional foot controller/footswitch, doing things
like controlling the Super Articulation voices (page 78) or starting and stopping the Style (
page 191).
1 Press the METRONOME [ON/OFF] button to start the metronome.
2 To stop the metronome, press the METRONOME [ON/OFF] button again.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
31
Adjusting the Tempo or Setting the Time Signature of the Metronome Sound
Adjusting the Metronome Tempo
1 Press the TEMPO [–]/[+] button to call up the pop-up tempo setting display.
2 Press the TEMPO [–]/[+] buttons to set the tempo.
Pressing and holding either button lets you continuously increase or decrease the value.
You can also use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to adjust the value. To reset the tempo, press the TEMPO [–]/[+] but-
tons simultaneously.
n About the Tempo display
The number in the display indicates how many quarter-note beats there are in one minute. The range is between 5 and
500. The higher the value, the faster the tempo.
3 Press the [EXIT] button to close the Tempo display.
Determine the Metronome Time Signature and Other Settings
1 Call up the operation display:
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
] CONFIG 1 [B] 2 METRONOME
2
Set the parameters by pressing the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
VOLUME Determines the level of the metronome sound.
SOUND
Determines which sound is used for the metronome.
Bell Off............... Conventional metronome
sound, with no bell.
Bell On............... Conventional metronome
sound, with bell.
English Voice ...... Count in English
German Voice .... Count in German
Japanese Voice ... Count in Japanese
French Voice....... Count in French
Spanish Voice ..... Count in Spanish
TIME
SIGNATURE
Determines the time signature of the metronome
sound.
Set the Popup Display Time
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] CONFIG 2
2 Select the [B] (2 POPUP DISPLAY TIME) button, and use the [7
π†
]/[8
π†
] buttons to set the time.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
32
Playing Various Voices
The instrument features a variety of Voices such as strings or wind instruments, including exceptionally realistic piano
Voices.
Playing Preset Voices
The preset Voices are categorized and contained in appropriate folders. VOICE category selection buttons on the panel
correspond to the categories of the preset Voices. For example, press the [PIANO] button to display various piano
Voices.
n About the various Voices
Refer to the Voice List in the separate Data List booklet.
Make sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)] buttons are off.
The Voice selected here is the RIGHT 1 part. For the Voice part, see page 79.
1 Use the [A]/[B]/[F]/[G] (RIGHT1) buttons in the Main display to select the RIGHT 1
part.
Determining how the Voice selection display is opened (when one of the VOICE category selection
buttons is pressed).
You can select how the Voice selection display is opened (when one of the VOICE category selection buttons is
pressed).
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] CONFIG 2
2 Select the [B] (2 VOICE CATEGORY BUTTON OPTIONS) button, and use the [1
π†
]/[2
π†
] buttons to change
how the Voice selection display is opened.
OPEN&SELECT:
Opens the Voice selection display with the top (first) voice of the voice category automatically selected (when
one of the Voice category selection buttons is pressed). With the default settings, the OPEN&SELECT function
is turned on.
OPEN ONLY:
Opens the Voice selection display with the currently selected voice (when one of the VOICE category selection
2 Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to select a Voice category and call
up the Voice selection display.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
33
You can call up the information for the selected Voice by pressing the [7
π
] (INFORMATION) button.
n The Voice type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Voice name. For details on the characteris-
tics, see page 78.
n You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.
n Restoring the Piano settings
Press the piano-shaped [PIANO RESET] button.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Voice.
4 Play the keyboard.
Recalling your favorite Voices easily
The instrument has a huge amount of high-quality Voices, covering an exceptionally broad range of instrument sounds—
making it perfect for virtually every musical application. However, the sheer number of Voices may seem overwhelming
at first. To easily recall your favorite Voice, there are two methods:
Save your favorite Voice to the USER display in the Voice Selection display and recall it by using the
[USER] button
1 Copy your favorite Voices from the Preset drive to the User drive.
Refer to page 70 for details on the copy operation.
2 Call up the selection display.
[USER] [F] VOICE (RIGHT1)
3 Select the desired Voice.
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the Voice.
Register your favorite Voice to Registration Memory and recall it with the REGISTRATION MEMORY
[1]–[8] buttons
Refer to page 131 for details on Registration Memory operations.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
34
Playing the Voice Demos
To listen to the various Voices and hear how they sound especially in context, listen to the demo songs for each Voice.
1 In the Voice Selection display (page 33 step 3), press the [8
] (DEMO) button to start
the Demo for the selected Voice.
2 To stop the Demo, press the [8
] (DEMO) button again.
Selecting percussion sounds
When one of the Drum Kit Voices in the [PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT] group is selected, you can play various drums
and percussion instrument sounds on the keyboard. Details are given in the Drum Kit List of the separate Data List.
To check which “Standard Kit 1” percussion sounds are assigned to each key, look at the icons printed above the keys.
Selecting sound effects
You can play individual sound effects, such as bird chirps and ocean sounds from the keyboard. The sound effects are
categorized as “GM&XG”/“GM2.
1 Use the [A]/[B]/[F]/[G] (RIGHT 1) buttons to select the RIGHT 1 part.
2 Press the [8
π
] (UP) button to call up the Voice categories.
3 Press the [2
π
] button to display page 2.
4 Press the [E]/[F] button to select “GM&XG”/“GM2.
5 Press the [2
π
] button to display page 2.
6 Press the [F] button to select “SoundEffect.
7 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired sound effect.
8 Play the keyboard.
Selecting GM/XG/GM2 Voices
n For details on the Voice allocation format, see page 199.
You can select the GM/XG/GM2 Voices directly via the panel operation.
Perform steps 1–4 described above, select the desired category, then select the desired voice.
Playing different Voices simultaneously
The instrument can play different Voices simultaneously (page 79).
Layering two different Voices
This is useful for creating rich and thick sounds.
Setting separate Voices for the left and right sections of the keyboard
You can play different Voices with the left and right hands. For example, you can set up the keyboard to play the
bass Voice with your left hand and the piano Voice with your right hand.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
35
Practicing with the Songs
n Song
On the instrument, performance data is called a “Song.
Playing Back Songs Before Practicing
The instrument includes not only the preset demo Songs, but also many preset Songs. This section covers basic infor-
mation on playing back the preset Songs or Songs in a CD-ROM.
The preset Songs are categorized and contained in appropriate folders.
You can also select the file by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.
n You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song category.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Song.
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
36
Playing Songs saved to USER (page 43)
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.
2 Press the TAB [
][
®
] button to select the USER tab.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Song.
n Select the file to which the data is saved.
You can also select the specified file to which the data is saved by pressing the [USER] button.
[USER] [A] SONG [A]–[J]
Playing Songs saved to a USB storage device (page 43)
For information on using USB storage devices, see page 22.
1 Connect the USB storage device to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.
2 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.
3 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the USB tab (“USB1”/“USB2”), corresponding to the USB storage device
you inserted in Step 1.
The indication “USB1”/“USB2” will be displayed depending on the number of the connected devices.
4 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song.
n Select the file to which the data is saved.
You can also select the specified file to which the data is saved by pressing the [USB] button.
[USB] [A] SONG [A]–[J]
Playing Songs in sequence
You can play all Songs in a folder continuously.
1 Select a Song in the desired folder.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING
3 Press the [H] (REPEAT MODE) button to select “ALL.
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
All Songs in the folder play back continuously, in order.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop continuous playback.
6 To turn off the Song sequence playback, press the [H] button to select “OFF” in the display in step 2.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
37
Boost the volume of the part to be practiced
On the instrument, a single Song can contain separate data for up to sixteen MIDI channels. Specify the channel for
practicing and increase the playback volume for the channel.
1 Select a Song. The method for selecting a Song is the same as “Playing Back Songs Before Practicing (page 35 step
1–5).
2 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CONSOLE display.
3 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the VOL/VOICE tab.
4 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button until “MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH1–8)” is shown at the top of the dis-
play.
5 Press the [E]/[J] button to select “VOLUME.
6 To raise the level of the desired channel(s), press the appropriate buttons [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
].
If the desired channel is not shown in the MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH1–8) display, press the [MIXING CON-
SOLE] button to call up the MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH9–16) display.
If you don’t know which channel’s volume to raise:
Look at the illustrations of the instruments indicated below “VOICE.
Look at the channel indicators, which light as the Song plays back. Watching these as you listen can show you
which channel you wish to boost.
3
2,
4
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
38
Displaying Music Notation (Score)
You can view the music notation of the selected Song. We suggest that you read through the music notation before
starting to practice.
•The instrument can display the music notation of commercially-available music data or your recorded Songs.
•The displayed notation is generated by the instrument based on the Song data. As a result, it may not be exactly the same as com-
mercially available sheet music of the same song—especially when displaying notation of complicated passages or many short
notes.
•The notation functions cannot be used to create Song data by inputting notes. For information on creating Song data, see
page 143.
n Look through the entire score before playing back the Song
Press the TAB [
®
] button to select subsequent pages.
The “ball” bounces along through the score, indicating the current position.
Changing the Notation Display
You can change the notation display as desired to suit your personal
preferences.
1 Press the [SCORE] button to display the music nota-
tion.
2 Changing the following settings as desired.
Changing the size of the music notation
Press the [7
π†
] button to change the size of the
music notation.
Displaying only right-hand part/left-hand part
notation
Press the [1
π†
]/[2
π†
] button to disable display of
the left-hand part/right-hand part.
Customizing the notation display
Display the note name at the left of the note
1 Press the [5
ππ
ππ
] (NOTE) button to display the note name.
2 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (SET UP) button to call up the detailed setting display.
3 Press the [6
] (NOTE NAME) button to select “Fixed Do.
4 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to apply the setting.
•Turn on the note colors
Press the [6
π†
] button to turn the COLOR on.
n About the note colors
These colors are fixed for each note and cannot be changed.
C: red, D: yellow, E: green, F: orange, G: blue, A: purple, and B: gray
Increase the number of measures in the display
You can increase the number of measures that will be displayed by decreasing the other items to be dis-
played (part, lyrics, chords, etc.).
Use the [1
π†
]–[4
π†
] buttons to turn off the items you want not to be displayed.
n
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the [SCORE] button to display the music notation.
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
39
Set the detailed parameters of the view type as desired.
1 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (SETUP) button to call up the detailed setting display.
2 Press the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the view type.
3 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to apply the setting.
n Save the notation view settings
The notation view settings can be saved as part of a Song (page 162).
One-handed Practice with the Guide Lamps
The key guide lamps indicate the notes you should play, when you should play them, and how long you should hold
them down. You can also practice at your own pace—since the accompaniment waits for you to play the notes cor-
rectly. Here, mute the right- or left-hand part and try practicing the part using the guide lamps.
Practicing the Right-hand Part (TRACK 1) Using the Guide Lamps
LEFT CH/RIGHT CH
Determines which MIDI channel in the Song data is used for the left-hand/right-hand part. This set-
ting returns to AUTO when a different Song is selected.
AUTO
The MIDI channels in the Song data for the right- and left-hand parts are assigned automatically—
setting the parts to the same channel as the channel which is specified in the [FUNCTION] [B]
SONG SETTING.
1–16
Assigns the specified MIDI channel (1–16) to each of the left- and right-hand parts.
OFF (LEFT CH only)
No channel assignment: This disables display of the left-hand key range.
KEY SIGNATURE
This lets you enter key signature changes in the middle of a song, at the stopped position. This menu
is useful when the selected Song contains no key signature settings for displaying notation.
QUANTIZE
This gives you control over the note resolution in the notation, letting you shift or correct the timing
of all displayed notes so that they line up to a particular note value. Make sure to select the smallest
note value used in the song.
NOTE NAME
Selects the type of the note name indicated at the left of the note in the notation from among the fol-
lowing three types. The settings here are available when the NOTE parameter in “Display the note
name at the left of the note” step 1 is set to ON.
A, B, C
Note names are indicated as letters (C, D, E, F, G, A, B).
FIXED DO
Note names are indicated in solfeggio and differ depending on the selected language.
The language is specified in LANGUAGE of the OWNER display (page 63).
MOVABLE DO
Note names are indicated in solfeggio according to the scale intervals, and as such are relative to the
key. The root note is indicated as Do. For example, in the key of G major the root note of “So” would
be indicated as “Do.As with “Fixed Do,” the indication differs depending on the selected language.
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Turn the [GUIDE] button on.
234
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
40
The indicator of the [TRACK 1 (R)] button goes out. You can now play that part by yourself.
n Have the guide lamp flash a lead-in to the music
In the GUIDE LAMP TIMING, select NEXT (page 142).
Practice the muted part using the guide lamps.
n Adjusting the tempo
Refer to page 31.
Quickly changing tempo during a performance (Tap function)
The tempo can also be changed during Song playback by tapping the [TAP TEMPO] button twice at the desired tempo.
3 Press the [TRACK 1 (R)] button to mute the right-hand part.
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
6 Turn the [GUIDE] button off.
Adjusting the volume balance between the Song and the keyboard
This lets you adjust the volume balance between Song playback and the sound you play on the keyboard.
1 Call up the Main display.
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]
n The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display.
When the Balance display is not indicated, press the [EXIT] button.
2 To adjust the Song volume, press the [1
π†
] button. To adjust the keyboard (RIGHT 1) volume, press the [6
π†
]
button.
n About keyboard parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left)
See page 79.
Other guide functions
The initial setting “Follow Lights (page 142)” was used in the instructions “One-handed Practice with the Guide
Lamps” above. There are additional functions in the Guide feature, as described below. To select a guide function, see
page 141.
For keyboard performance
Any Key
This lets you practice the timing of playing the keys.
For Karaoke
Karao-Key
This function lets you control the Song playback timing with just one finger, while you sing along (page 54).
•Vocal CueTIME
This automatically controls the timing of the accompaniment to match the melody (pitch) of your singing—allow-
ing you to practice singing with the correct pitch.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
41
Practicing the Left-hand Part (TRACK 2) Using the Guide Lamps
The indicator of the [TRACK 2 (L)] button goes out. You can now play that part by yourself.
Practicing with the Repeat Playback Function
The Song Repeat functions can be used to repeatedly play back a Song or a specific range of measures in a Song. This
is useful for repeated practicing of difficult-to-play phrases.
Playing Back a Song Repeatedly
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn on Repeat playback.
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
The Song will be played back repeatedly until you press the SONG [STOP] button.
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
5 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn off Repeat playback.
Specifying a Range of Measures and Playing them Back Repeat-
edly (A-B Repeat)
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
3 Specify the repeat range.
Press the [REPEAT] button at the starting point (A) of the range to be repeated. Press the [REPEAT] button
again at the ending point (B). After an automatic lead-in (to help guide you into the phrase), the range from
Point A to Point B is played back repeatedly.
n Instantly returning to Point A
Regardless of whether the Song is playing back or is stopped, pressing the [STOP] button returns to Point A.
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
5 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn off Repeat playback.
1,2 Follow the same steps as in “Practice the Right-hand Part (TRACK 1) Using the
Guide Lamps” on page 39.
3 Press the [TRACK 2] button to mute the left-hand part.
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback and practice the muted part
using the guide lamps.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
6 Turn the [GUIDE] button off.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
42
Other Methods for Specifying the A–B Repeat Range
Specifying the repeat range while Songs are stopped
1 Press the [FF] button to advance to the Point A location.
2 Press the [REPEAT] button to specify Point A.
3 Press the [FF] button to advance to the Point B location.
4 Press the [REPEAT] button again to specify Point B.
Specifying the repeat range between Point A and the end of the Song
Specifying only Point A results in repeat playback between Point A and the end of the Song.
Recording Your Performance
Record your performance by using the Quick Recording feature. This is an effective practice tool, allowing you to easily
compare your own performance to the original song you are practicing. You can also use it to practice duet pieces by
yourself, if you have your teacher or partner record his or her part beforehand.
A blank Song for recording is automatically set.
Recording begins automatically as soon as you play a note on the keyboard.
A message prompting you to save the recorded performance appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT]
button.
1 Press the [REC] and [STOP] buttons simultaneously.
2 Select a Voice (page 32). The selected Voice will be recorded.
3 Press the [REC] button.
4 Start recording.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.
6 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to play back the recorded performance.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
43
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.
2 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the appropriate tab (USER, USB, etc.) to which you want to
save the data. Select USER to save the data to internal memory, or select USB to save the data to a
USB storage device.
3 Press the [6
] (SAVE) button to call up the file naming display.
4 Enter the file name (page 73).
5 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to save the file.
To cancel the Save operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
CAUTION
The recorded song will be lost if you change to another Song or you turn the power off without executing the Save oper-
ation.
Playing Backing Parts with the performance
assistant Technology
This feature makes it exceptionally easy to play the backing parts along with Song playback.
n Before using performance assistant technology
To use the performance assistant technology, the Song must contain chord data. If the Song contains this data, the current chord
name will be displayed in the Main display during Song playback, letting you easily check whether the Song contains chord data or
not.
In these example instructions, we recommend that you use the Songs in the “Sing-a-long” folder.
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING
7 Save the recorded performance.
When the following message appears: “Song” changed. Save?/“Song” speichern?/“Song” modifié.
Sauv.?/“Song” cambiado. ¿Guardar?/Salvare “’Song” ?
The recorded data has not yet been saved. To save the data, press the [G] (YES) button to open the Song selection dis-
play and save the data (see above). To cancel the operation, press the [H] (NO) button.
Playing Songs saved to a USER/USB storage device
Refer to page 36.
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Call up the operation display.
3 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] button to turn the [P.A.T.] (Performance Assistant) on.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
44
The instrument automatically matches your performance on the keyboard to the Song playback and chords,
no matter what keys you play. It even changes the sound according to the way you play. Try playing in the
three different ways below.
Playing Accompaniment with the Auto Accom-
paniment Feature (Style Playback)
The Auto Accompaniment features let you produce automatic accompaniment playback simply by playing
“chords” with your left hand. This lets you automatically recreate the sound of a full band or orchestra—
even if you’re playing by yourself. The Auto Accompaniment sound is made up of the rhythm patterns of the
Styles. The Styles of the instrument cover a wide range of different musical genres including pop, jazz, and
many others.
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
5 Play the keyboard.
Playing the left and right hand together
(method 1).
Playing the left and right hand together
(method 2).
Playing the left hand and right hand
alternately.
Play three notes at the
same time with your
right hand.
Play several notes one after
the other with different fin-
gers of your right hand.
Play three notes at the
same time with your
right hand.
●●
6 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
7 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] button to turn the [P.A.T.] (Performance Assistant) off.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
45
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto
Accompaniment Feature
122 233 35
1 1 1
3
21 2 3 2 3 2 1
1 1 4 1
4
C
CGC
C
GCC
MARY HAD A LITTLE LAMB
Traditional
Style: Country Pop
Ending
1 Press the STYLE CONTROL “COUNTRY” button.
Enabling tempo display above Style name
You can select whether the tempo is displayed above the Style name or not.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] CONFIG 2
2 Select the [B] (2 DISPLAY STYLE TEMPO) button, and use the [5
π†
]/[6
π†
] buttons to switch the tempo dis-
play on/off.
ON:
Tempo is displayed above the Style name.
With the default settings, the Display Style Tempo function is on.
OFF:
Tempo is not displayed above the Style name.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
46
•The Style type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Style name. For details on the character-
istics, see page 107.
•When the [7
π
] (REPERTOIRE) button is pressed after selecting a Style, you can call up the custom panel settings (for
voices and tempos, etc.) designed to best match the selected Style. To return to the previous display, press the [EXIT]
button.
•You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.
Use the left-hand section (lower part) of the keyboard to play the chords for sounding the Auto Accompaniment.
Try playing chords with your left hand and play a melody with your right hand.
n Chord Fingerings
There are seven different fingering methods you can use to specify chords (page 107).
When Ending playback is finished, the Style automatically stops.
About the various Styles
Refer to the Style List in the separate Data List booklet.
Quickly changing the Style tempo during a performance (Tap function)
The tempo can also be changed during playback by tapping the [TAP TEMPO] button twice at the desired tempo.
Specifying the split point (the border between the right- and left-hand range)
See page 111.
Turns touch response on/off for the Style playback (Style Touch)
See page 110.
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Style “CountryPop.”
n
3 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.
3 45 6
4 Press the [SYNC START] button to set Auto Accompaniment to standby—letting you
simultaneously start the accompaniment as soon as you start playing.
5 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the Auto Accompaniment starts.
6 Automatically play an appropriate ending by pressing the [ENDING] button, at the
point in the score (page 45) indicated by “Ending.”
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
47
Pattern Variation
While you play, you can automatically add specially created intros and endings, as well as variations in the rhythm/
chord patterns, for more dynamic, professional-sounding performances. There are several different auto accompani-
ment pattern variations for each situation: starting your performance, during your performance, and ending your per-
formance. Try out the variations and combine them freely.
To Start Playing
Start/Stop
Styles start playing back as soon as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button is pressed.
Intro
This is used for the beginning of the song. Each preset Style features three different intros. When the intro finished play-
ing, accompaniment shifts to the Main section (see “Main” in the “During Style playback” below).
Press one of the INTRO [I]–[III] buttons before starting Style playback and press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP]
button to start Style playback.
Synchro Start
This lets you start playback as soon as you play the keyboard.
Press the [SYNC START] button when Style playback is stopped and play a chord in the chord section of the keyboard
to start Style playback.
Tap
Tap out the tempo and automatically start the Style at that tapped speed. Simply tap (press/release) the [TAP TEMPO]
button (four times for a 4/4 time signature), and the Style playback starts automatically at the tempo you tapped.
n The particular drum sound and the velocity (loudness) of the sound when the Tap function is used can be selected in the following
display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
] CONFIG 1 [B] 4 TAP
Adjusting the volume balance between the Style and the keyboard (page 40)
This lets you adjust the volume balance between Style playback and the sound you play on the keyboard.
1 Call up the Main display.
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]
n
The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display. If the Balance display is not selected, press the [EXIT] button.
2 To adjust the Style volume, press the [2
π†
] button. To adjust the keyboard (RIGHT 1) volume, press the [6
π†
]
button.
Fade In
For information on the settings, see page 191.
n For details on setting the fade-in and fade-out time, see page 109.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
48
During Style Playback
Main
This is used for playing the main part of the Song. It plays an accompaniment pattern of several measures, and repeats
indefinitely. Each preset Style features four different patterns.
Press one of the MAIN [A]–[D] buttons during Style playback.
Fill In
The fill-in sections let you add dynamic variations and breaks in the rhythm of the accompaniment, to make your per-
formance sound even more professional.
Turn on the [AUTO FILL IN] button before starting Style playback or during playback. Then, simply press one of the
MAIN VARIATION (A, B, C, D) buttons as you play, and the selected fill-in section plays automatically (AUTO FILL), spic-
ing up the auto accompaniment. When the fill-in is finished, it leads smoothly into the selected main section (A, B, C, D).
Even when [AUTO FILL IN] button is turned off, pressing the same button of the currently playing section automatically
plays a fill-in before returning to the same main section.
Break
This lets you add dynamic breaks in the rhythm of the accompaniment, to make your performance sound even more
professional.
Press the [BREAK] button during Style playback.
To Finish Playing
Start/stop
Styles stop as soon as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button is pressed.
Ending
This is used for the ending of the Song. Each preset Style features three different endings. When the ending is finished,
the Style stops automatically.
Press one of the ENDING/rit. [I]–[III] buttons during Style playback. You can have the ending gradually slow down
(ritardando) by pressing the same ENDING/rit. button again while the ending is playing back.
n If you press the ENDING/rit. [I] button in the middle of your performance, a fill-in automatically plays before the ENDING/rit. [I].
Others
Synchro Stop
When Synchro Stop is on, you can stop and start the Style anytime you want by simply releasing or playing the keys (in
the chord section of the keyboard). This is a great way to add dramatic breaks and accents to your performance.
Press the [SYNC STOP] button before starting the Style playback.
Enable Synchro Stop by pressing/releasing keys (Synchro Stop Window)
See page 110.
Fixing the section pattern to either Intro or Main (Section Set)
For example, you can set this function to Intro to conveniently have an Intro play automatically whenever you select a Style (page 110).
Fade Out
For information on the settings, see page 191.
n For details on setting the fade-in and fade-out time, see page 109.
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
49
Learning How to Play (Indicate) Chords for Style Playback
Learning the Notes to Play for Certain Chords
If know the name of a chord but don’t know how to play it, you can have the instrument show you the notes to play
(Chord Tutor function).
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING TAB[][®] CHORD FINGERING
The notes you need to play to make the selected chord are shown in the display.
n The notes that are displayed correspond to Fingered, no matter which fingering type is selected (page 108).
About the section button (INTRO/MAIN/ENDING, etc.) lamps
• Green
The section is not selected.
• Red
The section is currently selected.
• Off
The section contains no data and cannot be played.
1 Call up the operation display.
2 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] button to select the root note.
2 3
3 Press the [7
ππ
ππ
]/[8
ππ
ππ
] button to select the chord type.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
50
Checking How to Play Chords with the Guide Lamps
For Songs containing chord data, you can have the individual notes of the chords indicated with the Guide lamps on
the instrument.
The Guide lamps in the chord section of the keyboard flash according to the chords of the Song. Try practic-
ing the chords, matching the Guide lamps.
Appropriate Panel Settings for the Selected Style (One Touch
Setting)
One Touch Setting is a powerful and convenient feature that automatically calls up the most appropriate panel settings
(Voices or effects, etc.) for the currently selected Style, with the touch of a single button. If you’ve already decided
which Style you wish to use, you can have One Touch Setting automatically select the appropriate Voice for you.
Not only does this instantly call up all the
settings (Voices, effects, etc.) that match the
current Style—it also automatically turns on
ACMP and SYNC START, so that you can
immediately start playing the Style.
n Parameter Lock
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.) to make them selectable only via the panel controls (page 132).
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the [FUNCTION] button and press the [B] button to call up the Song Setting dis-
play, and make sure that the GUIDE MODE is set to “Follow Lights.”
3 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.
4 Press the [GUIDE] button.
5 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
1 Select a Style (page 46 step 2).
2 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING [1]–[4] buttons.
3 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the selected Style starts.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
51
Helpful hints for using One Touch Setting
Automatically changing One Touch Settings with the Main sections (OTS Link)
The convenient OTS (One Touch Setting) Link function lets you automatically have One Touch Settings change when
you select a different Main section (A–D).To use the OTS Link function, press the [OTS LINK] button.
n Setting the timing for OTS changes
The One Touch Settings can be set to change with the sections in one of two different timings (page 110).
Memorizing the panel settings to the OTS
You can also create your own One Touch Setting setups.
1 Set up the panel controls (such as Voice, Style, effects,
and so on) as desired.
2 Press the [MEMORY] button.
3 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING [1]–[4] buttons.
A message appears in the display prompting you to save
the panel settings.
It is possible to save the panel settings with another file
(step 4), so register it in a favorite number from 1 to 4.
4 Press the [F] (YES) button to call up the Style selection
display and save the panel settings as a Style file (page 69).
CAUTION
The panel settings memorized to each OTS button will be lost if you change the Style or turn the power off without
executing the Save operation.
23
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
52
Calling Up Ideal Setups for Each Song—Music Finder
If you want to play in a certain genre of music but don’t know which Style and Voice settings would be
appropriate, the convenient Music Finder function can help you out. Simply select the desired music genre
from among the Music Finder “Records,” and the instrument automatically makes all appropriate panel set-
tings to let you play in that music style.
A new record can be created by editing the currently selected one (page 114).
n The data (records) of the Music Finder are not the same as Song data and cannot be played back.
The ALL tab contains the preset records.
•You can also select the desired record by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.
Searching the records
The Music Finder is also equipped with a convenient search function that lets you enter a song title or keyword—and
instantly call up all the records that match your search criteria (page 112).
MUSIC ...............Contains the song title or music genre that describes each record, letting you easily
find the desired music style.
n Skipping up or down through the song alphabetically
When sorting records by song title, use the [1
π†
] button to skip up or down through the songs
alphabetically. Simultaneously press the [
π†
] buttons to move the cursor to the first record.
STYLE.................This is the preset Style assigned to the record.
n Skipping up or down through the Style alphabetically
When sorting records by Style name, use the [4
π†
]/[5
π†
] button to skip up or down through the
Styles alphabetically. Simultaneously press the [
π†
] buttons to move the cursor to the first record.
BEAT ..................This is the time signature registered to each Record.
TEMPO ..............This is the assigned tempo setting for the record.
1 Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.
3
1
2
2 Press the TAB [
] button to select the ALL tab.
3 Select the desired record by using the following four search categories.
To select a record, press the [2
ππ
ππ
]/[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
53
Notice that the panel settings have been automatically changed to match the music genre of the selected record.
Tempo Lock
Tempo Lock function lets you avoid changing the Tempo during Style playback when selecting another record. To turn on the
Tempo Lock function, press the [I] (TEMPO LOCK) button in the Music Finder display.
Parameter Lock
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.) to make them selectable only via the panel controls (page 132).
Calling up the panel settings to match the Style (Rep-
ertoire)
The convenient Repertoire function automatically calls up the most appropriate panel settings (voice number, etc.) for
the currently selected Style.
n The Repertoire function is valid for Styles in the “PRESET”/“USER” tab. The Repertoire function cannot be used for Styles
saved to a USB storage device. To use the Repertoire function, save the desired Style in “USER” tab.
The panel settings that match the Style under selection is searched according to the record group of the
Music Finder. The list of the search results is shown on the “SEARCH 2” display of the Music Finder.
CAUTION
When the result of searching the record in the “SEARCH 2” display has already been shown, the searched result is
lost.
4 Play the keyboard.
n
1 Select the desired Style for which you want to call up the panel settings from the
“PRESET”/“USER” tab on Style selection display.
2 Press the [7
ππ
ππ
] (REPERTOIRE) button.
3 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the desired panel settings.
Sorting the records
Press the [F] (SORT BY) button to sort the records.
MUSIC .................. The record is sorted by song title.
STYLE.................... The record is sorted by Style name.
BEAT ..................... The record is sorted by beat.
TEMPO ................. The record is sorted by tempo.
Changing the order of the records
Press the [G] (SORT ORDER) button to change the order of the records (ascending or descending).
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
54
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke) or
Your Own Performance
Connect a microphone to the instrument and sing along with Song playback (Karaoke) or your own perfor-
mance.
The lyrics can be displayed when the Song contains lyric data. Sing with the microphone as you read the lyr-
ics shown in the display. Lyrics can also be displayed with the music score, letting you play and sing while fol-
lowing along with the notation and lyrics.
Connecting a Microphone
n Always set the INPUT VOLUME to minimum when nothing is con-
nected to the [MIC/LINE IN] jack. Since the [MIC/LINE IN] jack is
highly sensitive, it may pick up and produce noise when nothing is
connected.
Adjust the controls while checking the SIGNAL and OVER lamps. The SIGNAL
lamp lights to indicate that an audio signal is being received. Make sure to
adjust the INPUT VOLUME so that this lamp is light. The OVER lamp lights
when the input level is too high. Make sure to adjust the INPUT VOLUME so
that this lamp does not light.
Disconnecting the microphone
1
Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob on the bottom panel of the instrument to the minimum position.
2 Disconnect the microphone from the [MIC./LINE IN] jack.
n Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob to the minimum position before turning off the power.
1 Make sure you have a conventional dynamic microphone.
2 Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob on the bottom panel of the instrument to the minimum
position.
3 Connect the microphone to the [MIC./LINE IN] jack.
MIN MAX
INPUT
MIC.
MIC. LINE PHONES
VOLUME
LINE IN
2, 5
43
4 Set the [MIC. LINE] switch to “MIC.”
5 (For microphones having a power source, turn on the power first.) Adjust the [INPUT
VOLUME] knob while singing into the microphone.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
55
Singing with the Lyrics Display
Try singing while playing back a Song containing lyric data
When the Text display appears, press the [1
] (LYRICS) button to display the lyrics.
Sing while following along with the lyrics on the display. The color of the lyrics changes as the Song plays.
When the lyrics are unreadable
You may need to change the Lyrics Language setting to “International” or “Japanese” in the Song Setting display ([FUNCTION] [B]
SONG SETTING), if the lyrics shown are garbled or unreadable. This setting can be memorized as part of the Song data (page 162).
Changing the Lyrics Background Picture
You can change the background picture of the Lyrics display. Press the [7
π†
]/[8
π†
] (BACKGROUND) button in the Lyrics dis-
play to call up the Lyrics picture selection display for the available picture files and select the desired one. Press the [EXIT] button
to return to the previous display.
The lyrics background picture can be saved to the Song (page 162).
Changing the lyrics
You can change the lyrics as desired (page 166).
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the [LYRICS/TEXT] button to display the lyrics.
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.
n
Displaying Text
This feature lets you show text files (created on a computer) in the display of the instrument, enabling various
useful possibilities, such as the showing of lyrics, chord names, and text notes.
1 Connect the USB storage device containing the text file to [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.
2 Press the [LYRICS/TEXT] button to display the text.
When the lyrics are displayed, press the [1
] (TEXT) button to display the text.
3 Press the [5
π†
]/[6
π†
] (TEXT FILE) buttons to call up the Text selection display.
4 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the desired TAB.
5 Double-click one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a text file.
If the text is long, use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select other pages.
n An optional foot pedal can also be used to turn pages (page 191).
The following additional settings are available in the TEXT display:
LYRICS ..........................................Switches the screen to the Lyrics display.
CLEAR...........................................Clears the text from the display (the text data itself is not erased).
FIXED 16-PROPORTIONAL 28 .....Determines the text type (fixed or proportional) and font size.
TEXT FILE......................................Opens the Text selection display.
BACK GROUND...........................Allows changing of the background picture of the text display, as in the Lyrics
display described above. The background setting is common for both the Lyr-
ics display and Text display.
•The text file, which is copied in the USER tab can be showed.
Line feed (or “carriage return”) is not automatically performed in the instrument. If a sentence is not displayed in its
entirety because of limitations in the screen space, execute the line feed on your computer.
•When the background color is specified in the song data, the BACKGROUND setting cannot be changed.
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
56
Convenient Functions for Karaoke
Transpose
You can use this to adjust the key of the Song if it is too high or low.
•Transposing the Song key up................ Press the TRANSPOSE [+] button.
•Transposing the Song key down........... Press the TRANSPOSE [–] button.
• Resetting the transposition ................... Press the TRANSPOSE [+][–] buttons simultaneously.
Applying Effects to Your Voice
You can also apply various effects to your voice.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
n Selecting an effect type
You can select the effect type in the Mixing Console (page 92).
Adjusting the tempo page 31
Transpose See below.
Applying Effects to Your Voice See below.
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice page 57
Practicing Singing with Proper Pitch (Vocal CueTIME) page 142
1 Use an appropriate video cable to connect the [VIDEO OUT]/[RGB OUT]
connector of the instrument to the video input connector on the TV/com-
puter monitor.
2 Set the external television, video, or computer monitor signal (NTSC,
PAL, or RGB) used by your video equipment, if necessary.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] SCREEN OUT
2
Press the [1
π†
] button to select the external television, video, or com-
puter monitor signal.
RGB OUT
computer monitor
TV monitor
Displaying the lyrics/text on an external TV, video, or computer monitor
The lyrics/text indicated on the display can also be output via the VIDEO OUT/RGB OUT terminal.
1 Call up the operation display.
2 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons to turn the effect on.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
57
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice
You can also automatically apply various harmony vocals to your voice.
If the Song contains this data, the current chord name will be displayed in the Main display during Song
playback, letting you easily check whether the Song contains chord data or not.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
For details on the Vocal Harmony types, refer to the separate Data List.
The harmony is applied to your voice according to the chord data.
1 Select a Song which contains chord data (page 35).
2 Call up the operation display.
3 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
]/[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to turn the harmony vocals (Vocal Harmony) on.
3
4
4 Press the [H] button to call up the Vocal Harmony selection display.
5 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Vocal Harmony type.
6 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.
7 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button and sing into the microphone.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
58
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your
Own Performance
Changing the Key (Transpose)
You can match both the Song and your keyboard performance to a certain key. For example, the Song data is in F, but
you feel most comfortable singing in D, and you are accustomed to playing the keyboard part in C. To match up the
keys, set the Master Transpose to “0,” the Keyboard Transpose to “2,” and the Song Transpose to “-3.This brings the
keyboard part up and the song data down to your desired singing key.
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [
®
] KEYBOARD/PANEL [B] TRANSPOSE ASSIGN
The following types are available. Select the one most suited to your purpose.
KEYBOARD
Transpose pitch of the keyboard played Voices and Style playback (controlled by what you play in the chord
section of the keyboard).
SONG
Transposes the pitch of Song playback.
MASTER
Transpose the overall pitch of the instrument.
You can set the value in semitone steps.
To reset the transpose value, press the [+][–] buttons simultaneously.
Changing the Key (Transpose) See below.
Displaying the Music Score on the Instrument and the Lyrics and Text on external monitor page 59
Making Announcements Between Songs page 59
Controlling Playback Timing by Your Voice (Karao-Key) page 142
Adjusting the microphone and Song volume (page 40)
You can adjust the volume balance between the Song playback and the microphone.
1 Call up the Main display.
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]
n The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display.
If the Balance display is not indicated, press the [EXIT] button.
2 To adjust the microphone volume, press the [4
π†
] button.
To adjust the Song volume, press the [1
π†
] button.
1 Call up the operation display.
2 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] button to select the desired transpose type.
3 Press the TRANSPOSE [–]/[+] button to transpose.
4 Press the [EXIT] button to close the TRANSPOSE display.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
59
Displaying the Music Score on the Instrument and the Lyrics
and Text on external monitor
This convenient sing-along function lets you have the music score shown on the display of the instrument (for your
playing purposes), while only the lyrics are shown on an external monitor (page 56) so your audience can sing along.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] SCREEN OUT
Making Announcements Between Songs
This function is ideal for making announcements between your singing performances. When singing a song, several
effects are usually assigned to the MIC Setup. When speaking to your audience, however, these effects may sound dis-
turbing or unnatural. Whenever the TALK function is turned on, effects are automatically turned off.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
n Talk settings can be customized as well, allowing you to add any desired effects to your voice as you speak to your audi-
ence (page 174).
1 Call up the operation display.
2 Press the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] button to select LYRICS.
1 Call up the operation display.
2 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
]/[3
ππ
ππ
] (TALK) button to turn the function on.
2
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
60
Recording Your Performance as Audio (USB
Audio Recorder)
Here you’ll learn how to record your performance as audio data to a USB flash memory. For example, by connecting a
guitar, microphone or other device to the instrument, you can record an ensemble performance of guitar and keyboard
together or record yourself singing along with Song playback. The performance data is saved as a WAV file of conven-
tional CD quality (44.1 kHz/16 bit). Since it is possible to play back the file on computer, a listener doesn’t need to
have the particular instrument in order to hear the performance. This makes it possible to easily share your perfor-
mances and recordings with your friends via e-mail, record your own CDs, or upload the recordings to websites for
many others to enjoy as well.
Recording methods on the instrument include MIDI recording as well as audio recording. For details about the differ-
ence between audio and MIDI recording, see page 196. For specific instructions on MIDI recording, refer to page 200.
•When recording with the USB Audio Recorder function, make sure to use an appropriate USB flash memory device.
In order to record your own original CD, you’ll need a CD-R drive (or compatible device). Refer to the manual that came with your
specific computer for details.
•When you attach a recorded file in an e-mail message, make sure the file size is small enough to be sent.
The following sounds can be recorded.
• Internal tone generator of the instrument.
Keyboard parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left), Song parts, Style parts
• Input from a microphone, guitar or other instrument (via the [MIC./LINE IN] jack).
• Input from another audio device, such as a CD player, MP3 player or the like (via the [MIC./LINE IN] jack).
n Songs protected by copyright, such as preset songs, and the metronome sound cannot be recorded.
Moreover, the effect of iAFC (page 82) is not reflected in the recording.
The recorded data using this function is saved as:
Stereo WAV data
• 44.1 kHz sample rate/16 bit resolution
Recording Your Performance as Audio
Now, try recording a performance of your singing along with Song playback with a connected microphone. The maxi-
mum amount of recording time is 80 minutes, though this may differ depending on the capacity of the particular USB
flash memory.
Here, you’ll also see by example how to sing along with accompaniment/Style playback. To set the Style, go
on to step 6 (page 46).
•To record your performance by USB Audio Recorder, use the compatible USB flash memory. When the USB flash
memory is not compatible, it is not likely to be able to record/playback normally.
Before using a USB flash memory, be sure to read “Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash Memory/Floppy
Disk, etc)” on page 22.
n
1 Set the desired Voice, etc. which you want to use for your performance, and connect
a microphone. (For information on setting the Voice, see page 28; for connecting a
microphone, see page 54.)
2 Connect the USB flash memory to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.
n
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
61
The following information is indicated on the PROPERTY display.
• DRIVE NAME ...................................... Number of the USB storage device (USB 1, USB 2, etc.)
• ALL SIZE .............................................. Size of USB storage device
• FREE AREA........................................... Available recording space on the USB storage device
• POSSIBLE TIME.................................... Available time for recording
Press the [F] (OK)/[EXIT] button to close the PROPERTY display.
n The USB storage device of “USB1” is selected as the recording destination when multiple USB storage devices are connected. If a
floppy disk drive is assigned to “USB1,” “USB1” will be skipped. To check the number of the USB storage device (USB1 and USB2,
etc.), press the [A]/[B]/[F] button on the display of step 4, and change the tab. Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.
When recording begins, the “RECORDING” indication on the display changes to red, and the elapsed
recording time is displayed.
CAUTION
Avoid frequently connecting/disconnecting the USB flash memory, or turning the power on/off too often. Doing so
may corrupt the USB flash memory data or the recording data.
The file name is automatically named (and is always given a new, unique name), and a message indicating
the file name is displayed.
n The recording operation continues, even if you close the Recording display by pushing the [EXIT] button. To stop the
recording, press the [J] (STOP) button on the Recording display.
3 Press the [USB] button.
3
4
4 Press the [E] (USB AUDIO RECORDER) button to call up the recording display
(USB AUDIO RECORDER display).
5 If necessary, press the [E] (PROPERTY) button to call up the Property display, then
check the information of the USB flash memory.
5 6, 7
8
6 Start recording by pressing the [J] (REC) button, then start your performance.
7 Stop recording by pressing the [J] (STOP) button.
Quick Guide
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
62
Playing Back the Recorded Performance
Play back the recorded performance.
[USB] [E] (USB AUDIO RECORDER).
The file recorded is selected in step 1-7 (page 60). For information about the operation method to change the
name of the displayed file or to delete a file, see the section “File/Folder Operations in the File Selection Dis-
play” on page 68. However, the operation that copies/moves file/folder to the User tab cannot be done here.
The song is played back from the beginning, and the display indicates the auditioning process. This display
closes automatically when auditioning is stopped. Press the [G] (CANCEL) or [EXIT] button to stop audition-
ing.
CAUTION
Avoid frequently connecting/disconnecting the USB flash memory, or turning the power on/off too often. Doing so
may corrupt the USB flash memory data or the auditioning data.
n Audio recording is processed internally so that playback volume will be appropriate when played on a computer. There-
fore, the playback sound might be distorted if you record at too high a volume. In this case, lower and adjust the volume
of each part with Volume Balance display (page 40) and the Mixing Console (page 88), etc., and try recording again.
1 Call up the USB AUDIO RECORDER display.
2
Press the [7
ππ
ππ
]/[8
ππ
ππ
] (AUDITION) button to display the audio files (WAV data)
saved to the connected USB flash memory.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the file you want to listen to, then
press the [8
] (AUDITION) button.
4 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the USB AUDIO RECORDER display shown in step 4
of “Recording Your Performance as Audio” above.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
63
Basic Operation
Basic Operation
Selecting Message Language
You can select the desired language of the display messages.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
] OWNER
2 Use [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] (LANGUAGE) buttons to select the language.
3 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.
The Messages Shown in the Display
A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen
to facilitate operation. When the message appears, simply press the appropriate
button.
The language selected here is
also used for various “Mes-
sages” shown during operations.
2
3
In this example, press the [F] (YES) button
to start formatting the MEDIA (USB storage
device such as USB flash memory/floppy
disk, etc).
Instant Selection of the Displays—Direct Access
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
64
Basic Operation
Instant Selection of the Displays—
Direct Access
With the convenient Direct Access function, you can instantly call up the desired
display—with just a single additional button press.
1 Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button.
A message appears in the display prompting you to press the appropriate
button.
2 Press the button corresponding to the desired setting display to
instantly call up that display.
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of the displays that can be called up
with the Direct Access function.
Example of calling up the Guide function display
Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [GUIDE] button.
2
1
Returning to the Main display
You can conveniently return to the Main display from any other display by
simply pressing the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then the [EXIT] button.
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
65
Basic Displays (Main Display and File
Selection Display)
There are two basic display types – Main and Selection. Here are explanations of
each display segment and its basic operation.
Main Display
The Main display shows the current basic settings of the instrument such as the cur-
rently selected Voice and Style, allowing you to see them at a single glance. The
Main display is the one you’ll usually see when you play the keyboard.
1 Voice name
RIGHT 1 (indicated at the right edge):
Voice name currently selected for the RIGHT 1 part (page 79).
RIGHT 2 (indicated at the right edge):
Voice name currently selected for the RIGHT 2 part (page 79).
LEFT (indicated at the right edge):
Voice name currently selected for the LEFT part (page 79).
When the Left Hold function is ON, an “H” indication appears (page 86). Pressing one of
the [A]–[C] and [F]–[H] buttons calls up the Voice Selection display for each part (page 32).
2 Style name and related information
Displays the currently selected Style name, time signature and tempo. Pressing the [D]
button calls up the Style Selection display (page 45).
3 Current chord name
If the [ACMP ON/OFF] button is set to On, the chord specified in the chord section of the
keyboard will be displayed.
4 Song name and related information
Displays the currently selected Song name, time signature and tempo.
If the Song contains the chord data, the current chord name will be displayed in the “CHORD”
segment (see 3 above). Pressing the [I] button calls up the Song Selection display (page 35).
5 Registration Memory Bank name
Displays the currently selected Registration Memory Bank name.
Pressing the [J] button calls up the Registration Memory Bank Selection display (page 132).
When the Freeze function is ON, an “F” indication appears (page 133).
6 Volume Balance
Displays the volume balance among the parts.
Adjust the volume balance among the parts by using the [1
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons.
7 Transpose
Displays the amount of transposition in semitone units (page 56).
8 Tempo
Displays the current tempo of the Song or Style.
9 BAR (current position of the Song or Style)
Displays the current position of the Song or bar and beat number from playback start of the Style.
) Recording status of USB Audio recorder
While recording, a “REC” indication appears.
! Registration Sequence
Appears when the Registration Sequence is active (page 134).
Returning to the Main display
Here’s a convenient way to
return to the Main display from
any other display: Simply press
the [DIRECT ACCESS] button,
then the [EXIT] button.
When you select the RIGHT 1
part,
appears at the right of
the Voice name.
When you select the RIGHT 2
part,
appears at the right of
the Voice name.
When you select the LEFT part,
®
appears at the left of the Voice
name.
1
5
6
78 !)
2
9
3
4
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
66
File Selection Display Configuration and Basic Operation
The File Selection display appears when you press one of the buttons shown below. From here you can select
Voices, Styles, and other data.
File Selection Display Configuration
• Location (drive) of data
• Data files and folders
The data, both pre-programmed and your own original, are saved as “files.
You can drop files into a folder.
VOICE category selection buttons
SONG SELECT button
REGIST BANK
selection buttons
STYLE category
selection buttons
Preset
Location where pre-programmed
(preset) data is stored.
User
Location where recorded or
edited data is saved.
USB
Location where data on USB storage device
(USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc) is saved.
Hereafter in this manual, any USB storage device such as USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc. will be referred to as “USB storage device.
Folder
Folder
Icon
File
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
67
File Selection Display Basic Operation
1 Select the tab containing the desired file by using the TAB [
][
®
]
buttons.
2 Select the page containing the desired file by using the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
]
buttons ([1
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons for Voice, [1
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons for Song
and Style).
3 Select the file. There are two ways to do so.
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons.
Select the file by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER]
button to execute.
4 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.
Select the file to which the
data is saved.
You can also select the specified
file to which the data is to be
saved by pressing the [USB]/
[USER] buttons.
[USB]/[USER] [A] SONG/[B]
STYLE/[F] VOICE [A]–[J]
2
4
1
3
3
3
This display shows the Voice files
in a folder.
The next highest level—in this case,
folder—is shown. Each folder shown in
this display contains appropriately cat-
egorized Voices.
Closing the current folder and calling up the next highest level
folder
To close the current folder and call up the next highest level folder, press
the [8
π
] (UP) button.
Example of the PRESET Voice Selection display
The PRESET Voice files are categorized and contained in appropriate folders.
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
68
Basic Operation
File/Folder Operations in the File Selection
Display
•Saving Files .............................................................................................page 69
Copying Files/Folders (Copy & Paste)....................................................... page 70
•Moving Files (Cut & Paste)....................................................................... page 71
Deleting Files/Folders .............................................................................. page 71
Renaming Files/Folders............................................................................page 72
Selecting Custom Icons for Files (shown at the left of file name) .............. page 72
Creating a New Folder ............................................................................ page 72
Entering characters.................................................................................. page 73
The indications USB 1, USB 2,
etc. will be displayed depending
on the number of the connected
devices.
4
3
Formatting USB storage media
When a USB storage device is connected or media is inserted, a message
may appear prompting you to format the device/media. If so, execute the
format operation.
CAUTION
The format operation deletes any previously existing data. Make sure that the media
you are formatting does not contain important data. Proceed with caution, espe-
cially when connecting multiple USB storage medias.
1 Insert a USB storage device for formatting into the [USB TO
DEVICE].
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
][
®
]MEDIA
3 Press the [A]/[B] button to select the “USB” Tabs (USB1/USB2) con-
nected to the devices in step 1.
4 Press the [H] button to format the media.
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
69
Saving Files
This operation lets you save your original data (such as Songs and Voices you’ve
created) to a file.
1 After you’ve created a Song or Voice in the relevant SONG CREATOR
or VOICE SET display, press the [SAVE] display button.
The File Selection display for the corresponding data appears. Keep in mind
that the Save operation is executed from the File Selection display.
2 Select the appropriate tab (USER/USB) to which you want to save the
data by using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
3 Press the [6
] (SAVE) button to call up the file naming display.
4 Enter the file name (page 73).
5 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to save the file.
If you want to cancel the Save operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
The saved file will be automatically located at the appropriate position
among the files in alphabetical order.
Internal memory (User tab
displays) capacity
The internal memory capacity of
the instrument is about 3.2MB.
This capacity applies to all file
types, including Voice, Style,
Song, and Registration data files.
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
70
Basic Operation
Copying Files/Folders (Copy & Paste)
This operation lets you copy a file/folder and paste it to another location (folder).
1 Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to copy.
2 Press the [3
] (COPY) button to copy the file/folder.
The pop-up window for the Copy operation appears at the bottom of the dis-
play.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/
folder.
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.
Selecting all files/folders
Press the [6
] (ALL) button to select all files/folders indicated on the cur-
rent display including the other pages.
To cancel the selection, press the [6
] (ALL OFF) button again.
4 Press the [7
] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.
To cancel the Copy operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
5 Select the destination tab (USER/USB) to paste the file/folder, by
using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
6 Press the [4
] (PASTE) button to paste the file/folder.
The folder/file copied and pasted appears on the display at the appropriate
position among the files in alphabetical order.
Restrictions for protected Songs
Commercially available song data may be copy protected to prevent illegal
copying or accidental erasure. They are marked by the indications at the
upper left side of the file names. The indications and relevant restrictions
are detailed below.
Note for “Prot. 2 Orig” and “Prot. 2 Edit” Song file operation
Make sure to save the “Prot. 2 Edit” Song to the same folder containing its
original “Prot. 2 Orig” Song. Otherwise the “Prot. 2 Edit” Song cannot be
played back. Also, if you move a “Prot. 2 Edit” Song, be sure to move its
original “Prot. 2 Orig” Song to the same location (folder) at the same time.
Prot. 1 Indicates Preset Songs saved to the User tab display, Disk Orchestra
Collection (DOC) Songs, and Disklavier Piano Soft Songs. These
cannot be copied/moved/saved to USB storage device.
Prot. 2 Orig Indicates Yamaha-protection-formatted Songs. These cannot be
copied. These can be moved/saved only to the USER tab display
and USB storage device.
Prot. 2 Edit Indicates edited “Prot. 2 Orig” Songs. Make sure to save these to
the same folder containing the corresponding “Prot. 2 Orig” Song.
These cannot be copied. These can be moved/saved only to the
USER tab display and USB storage device.
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
71
Moving Files (Cut & Paste)
This operation lets you cut a file and paste it to another location (folder).
1 Call up the display containing the file you want to move.
2 Press the [2
] (CUT) button to cut the file.
The pop-up window for the Cut operation appears at the bottom of the dis-
play.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file.
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.
Selecting all files
Press the [6
] (ALL) button to select all files indicated on the current dis-
play including the other pages.
To cancel the selection, press the [6
] (ALL OFF) button again.
4 Press the [7
] (OK) button to confirm the file selection.
To cancel the Cut operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
5 Select the destination tab (USER/USB) to which the file is to be
pasted, by using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
6 Press the [4
] (PASTE) button to paste the file.
The file moved and pasted appears on the display at the appropriate position
among the files in alphabetical order.
Deleting Files/Folders
This operation lets you delete a file/folder.
1 Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to delete.
2 Press the [5
] (DELETE) button.
The pop-up window for the Delete operation appears at the bottom of the
display.
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/
folder.
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.
Selecting all files/folders
Press the [6
] (ALL) button to select all files/folders indicated on the cur-
rent display including the other pages.
To cancel the selection, press the [6
] (ALL OFF) button again.
4 Press the [7
] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.
To cancel the Delete operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
5 Follow the on-display instructions.
YES ........................Delete the file/folder
YES ALL .................Delete all selected files/folders
NO ........................Leave the file/folder as is without deleting
CANCEL ................Cancel the Delete operation
Deleting all data in a USB
storage device at once
Formatting a USB storage device
completely erases all data on the
USB storage device (page 68).
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
72
Basic Operation
Renaming Files/Folders
This operation lets you rename files/folders.
1 Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to rename.
2 Press the [1
] (NAME) button.
The pop-up window for the Rename operation appears at the bottom of the
display.
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/folder.
4 Press the [7
] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.
To cancel the Rename operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
5 Input the name (characters) of the selected file or folder (page 73).
The renamed folder/file appears on the display at the appropriate position
among the files in alphabetical order.
6 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to actually enter the new name.
Selecting Custom Icons for Files (Shown at the
Left of File Name)
You can select custom icons for files (shown at the left of file name).
1–4
Operations are the same as the above “Renaming Files/Folders” section.
5 Press the [1
] (ICON) button to call up the ICON display.
6
Select the icon by using the [A]–[J] buttons or [3
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
The ICON display includes several pages. Press the TAB [
®
] button to select
different pages.
To cancel the operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
7 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to apply the selected icon.
8 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to actually enter the new name.
Creating a New Folder
This operation lets you create new folders. Folders can be created, named and
organized as desired, making it easier to find and select your original data.
1 Call up the page of the File Selection display for which you wish to
create a new folder.
2 Press the [7
] (FOLDER) button to call up the naming display for a
new folder.
3 Input the name of the new folder (page 73).
A new folder cannot be made in
the PRESET tab.
Folder directories for the
USER tab display
In the USER tab display, folder
directories can contain up to
four levels. The maximum total
number of files and folders
which can be stored is 2550, but
this may differ depending on the
length of the file names. The
maximum number of files/folders
which can be stored in a folder
in the USER tab is 250.
Basic Operation
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
73
Entering Characters
The instructions that follow show you how to enter characters in naming your files/
folders and when entering the Keyword for Music Finder function/website. The
method is much the same as entering names and numbers to a conventional
mobile phone. Entering characters should be done in the display shown below.
1 Change the type of character by pressing the [1
ππ
ππ
] button.
If you select a language other than Japanese as the Language
(page 63), the following different types of characters are available:
CASE......................Alphabet (capital letters, half size), numbers (half
size), marks (half size)
case .......................Alphabet (lowercase letters, half size), numbers (half
size), marks (half size)
If you select Japanese as the Language (page 63), the following
different types of characters and sizes can be entered:
(kana-kan) ...Hiragana and Kanji, marks (full size)
(kana) ............Katakana (normal size), marks (full size)
(kana) ..............Katakana (half size), marks (half size)
A B C.....................Alphabet (capital and small letters, full size), num-
bers (full size), marks (full size)
ABC.......................Alphabet (capital and small letters, half size), num-
bers (half size), marks (half size)
2 Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to move the cursor to the desired position.
3 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] and [7
ππ
ππ
] buttons, corresponding to the
character you wish to enter.
For details on entering characters, refer to the following section, below
instruction step 4.
4 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to actually enter the new name and
return to the previous display.
Entering letters, numerals and symbols can be done by moving the cursor or
pressing one of the character entry buttons. Alternately, you can wait for a
short time and the characters will be entered automatically.
Deleting characters
Move the cursor to the character you wish to delete by using the [DATA
ENTRY] dial, and press the [7
] (DELETE) button. To delete all charac-
ters on the line at once, press and hold the [7
] (DELETE) button.
Entering special character marks (Japanese “ ” and “ ”)
Select a character to which a character mark is to be added and press
the [6
] button before actual entry of the character.
Entering marks
1 After actually entering a character by moving the cursor, press the
[6
] button to call up the mark list.
2 Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to move the cursor to the desired mark,
then press the [8
π
] (OK) button.
Depending on the display for
character entry you are working
in, some types of characters can-
not be entered.
Even if you select Japanese as the
Language, when you enter the
characters in the lyrics editing
display (page 166), the Internet
Setting display (page 183), or
website, the type of characters
“CASE”/“case” may be entered.
The following half-size marks
cannot be entered for a file/
folder name.
\ / : * ? " < > |
Entering password or WEP key of
wireless LAN connection in the
website, those characters are
converted to “*“.
In the case of characters which
are not accompanied by special
character marks (with the excep-
tion of kanakan and half-size
katakana), you can call up the
mark list by pressing the [6
]
button after selecting a charac-
ter (before actual entry of a char-
acter).
Several different characters are assigned to each button, and the
characters change each time you press the button.
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
74
Basic Operation
Inserting a Character
1 Move the cursor to the desired position.
Use the same operation as in “Deleting Characters” above.
2 Press the [2
π†
]–[6
π†
], [7
π
] buttons to enter numbers and sym-
bols.
3 Press the [8
π
] (OK) button to enter characters.
Entering a Space
1 Move the cursor to the desired position.
Use the same operation as in “Deleting Characters” above.
2 Press [6
] button to call up the mark list.
3 Make sure the cursor is at the beginning space (blank) of the mark list,
and press the [8
π
] (OK) button.
Entering numbers
First, select one of the following: “A B C” (full-size alphabet), “ABC”
”CASE“ (half-size capital alphabet) and “case” (half-size lowercase
alphabet). Then, press and hold down the appropriate button, [2
π†
]–
[5
π†
], [6
π
] and [7
π
] button, for a while, or press it repeatedly until
the desired number is selected.
Converting into Kanji (Japanese language)
When the entered “hiragana” characters are shown in reverse display
(highlighted), press the [1
π
]/[ENTER] button one or several times to
convert the characters into the appropriate kanji. To actually enter the
change, press the [1
]/[8
π
] (OK) button or enter the next character.
When the entered “hiragana” characters are shown in reverse
display (highlighted):
Re-converting the characters into other kanji
Press the [1
π
]/[ENTER] button.
Changing the reversed area
Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
Changing the converted kanji back to “hiragana”
Press the [7
] (DELETE) button.
Clearing the reversed area at once
Press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
Entering the “hiragana” itself (without converting it)
Press the [8
π
] (OK) button.
Canceling the character-entering operation
Press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
Restoring the Factory-programmed
Settings
Restoring the Factory-programmed System
While holding the C7 key (right-most key on the keyboard), turn the [POWER] but-
ton ON.
This operation has the same result as and is a shortcut for the System Setup restore
operation explained in step 2 of the following section.
Th
e operat
i
on o
f
restor
i
ng t
h
e
factory-programmed settings
does not affect the Internet Set-
tings. To reset the Internet Set-
tings, refer to page 187.
Basic Operation
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
75
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings
Independently by Item
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
®
]SYSTEM RESET
2 Select items by pressing the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
3 Checkmark the box of the item to be reset to the factory pro-
grammed settings by pressing the [4
ππ
ππ
] button.
4 Press the [D] button to execute the Factory Reset operation for all
checkmarked items.
Saving and Recalling Your Original Settings as
a Single File
For the items below, you can save your Original Settings as a Single File for future recall.
1 Make all desired settings on the instrument.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
®
]SYSTEM RESET
CAUTION
This operation deletes all your
original data for the respec-
tive item (MIDI SETUP, USER
EFFECT, MUSIC FINDER, and
FILES&FOLDERS).
SYSTEM SETUP Restores the System Setup parameters to the original factory resettings.
Refer to the separate Data List booklet for details about which parameters
belong to the System Setup.
MIDI SETUP Restores the MIDI settings including the MIDI templates on the User tab
display to the original factory status.
USER EFFECT Restores the User Effect settings including the user effect types, user master
EQ types, user master compressor types, and user vocal harmony types cre-
ated via the Mixing Console display to the original factory resettings.
MUSIC FINDER
Restores the Music Finder data (all records) to the original factory resettings.
FILES&FOLDERS Deletes all files and folders stored in the User tab display.
REGIST Temporarily deletes the current Registration Memory settings of the
selected Bank. The same can be done also by turning the [POWER] button
ON while holding the B6 key (right-most B key on the keyboard).
3
4
2
Data Backup
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
76
Basic Operation
3 Press one of the [F]–[I] buttons to call up the relevant display for sav-
ing your data.
4 Select one of the tabs (other than the PRESET) by pressing the TAB
[
][
®
] buttons.
Note that the file in the PRESET tab display is the file of factory-programmed
settings. If you select it, the factory-programmed settings for the respective
item will be restored. (This is the same results as on page 75 “Restoring the
Factory-programmed Settings Independently by Item”.)
5 Save your file (page 69).
6 To recall your file, select the tab and page to which you’ve saved the
file (same tab and page as specified in step 4), and press the corre-
sponding [A]–[J] button.
Data Backup
For maximum data security Yamaha recommends that you copy or save your
important data to a USB storage device. This provides a convenient backup if the
internal memory is damaged.
The backup procedure is different for the data types in 1, 2, and 3 above.
SYSTEM SETUP
Parameters set on the various displays such as the [FUNCTION] UTILITY and
microphone setting display are handled as a single System Setup file. Refer to the sep-
arate Data List booklet for details on which parameters belong to the System Setup.
MIDI SETUP The MIDI settings including the MIDI templates on the User tab display are
handled as a single file.
USER EFFECT The User Effect settings including the user effect types, user master EQ types,
user master compressor types, and user vocal harmony types created via the
Mixing Console displays are managed as a single file.
MUSIC FINDER
All the preset and created records of the Music Finder are handled as a single file.
Data that can be saved
1 Song*, Style, Registration Memory Bank and Voice
2 Music Finder Record, Effect**, MIDI Template and System File
* Protected Songs (those with a “Prot.1/Prot.2” indication at the upper left of the file name)
cannot be saved.
However, Songs with a “Prot.2” indication can be moved (cut-and-paste operation)
to a USB flash memory.
**Effect data includes the following:
- Edited or saved data in the Mixing Console “EFFECT/EQ/CMP.
- Edited or saved data of the Vocal Harmony type.
3 All data listed in 1 and 2 above, as well as the Internet settings.
Basic Operation
Data Backup
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
77
Backup procedure
1 Insert/connect the backup USB storage
device (destination).
2 Call up the display containing the desired
file to be copied.
Song:
Press the [SONG SELECT] button.
Style:
Press the STYLE category selection buttons.
Registration Memory Bank:
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEM-
ORY [REGIST BANK] buttons [+][–] .
Voice:
Press one of the VOICE category selection but-
tons.
3 Select the USER tab by using the TAB
[
][
®
] buttons.
4 Press the [3
] (COPY) button to copy the
file/folder.
The pop-up window for the Copy operation
appears at the bottom of the display.
5 Press the [6
] (ALL) button to select all
files/folders indicated on the current dis-
play and all other pages.
To cancel the selection, press the [6
] (ALL
OFF) button again.
6 Press the [7
] (OK) button to confirm the
file/folder selection.
To cancel the Copy operation, press the [8
]
(CANCEL) button.
7 Select the destination USB tab to which
the file/folder is to be copied, by using the
TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
8 Press the [4
] (PASTE) button to paste
the file/folder.
1 Insert/connect the backup USB storage
device (destination).
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
]
SYSTEM RESET
3 Press one of the [F]–[I] buttons to call up
the relevant display for saving your data.
4 Select the appropriate USB tab to which
you want to save the data by using the
TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
5 Save your data (page 69).
1 Insert/connect the backup USB storage
device (destination).
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
]
OWNER
3 Press the [D] (BACKUP) button to save the
data to the USB storage device.
To restore the data, press the [E] (RESTORE)
button in step 3 above.
It takes a few minutes to complete the backup/restore
operation.
Backup data which has not been created on the CVP-
409/407 cannot be restored.
CAUTION
Move the Protected Songs which are saved to the USER dis-
play before restoring. If the songs are not moved, the opera-
tion deletes the data.
1 Song, Style, Registration Memory Bank
and Voice Data
If a message appears indicating data
cannot be copied
Protected Songs (“Prot. 1/Prot.2” is indicated
at the upper left side of the file names) are
included in the copied files. These protected
Songs cannot be copied. However, Songs
with a “Prot.2” indication can be moved (cut-
and-paste operation) to a USB flash memory.
2 Music Finder Record, Effect, MIDI Tem-
plate and System Data
3 All data listed in 1 and 2 above
n
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
78
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Reference
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Characteristics
The Voice type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Voice
name.
Reference to Quick Guide pages
Playing Voices ................................................................................ page 28
Playing the Piano Voice ........................................................... page 28
Playing Various Voices............................................................. page 32
Mega Voices Compatibility
Mega Voices are unique to the
Clavinova and are not compati-
ble with other models. Any song
/
style data you’ve created on the
Clavinova using the Mega Voices
will not sound properly when
played back on other instru-
ments.
Natural!
These rich and luscious Voices are comprised mostly of keyboard instrument
sounds and are especially intended for playing piano and other keyboard parts.
They also take full advantage of Yamaha’s advanced sampling technology such as
Stereo Sampling, Dynamic Sampling, Sustain Sampling, and Key-off Sampling.
S. Articulation!
The Super Articulation voices sound remarkably authentic and natural, featuring
the unique performance characteristics of each instrument—for example, guitar
scratching sounds or the legato phrasing of wind instruments. They provide many
of the same benefits as the MegaVoices (see below), but with greater playability
and expressive control in real time. To effectively play these natural sounds in
performance of certain voices, you may need to use the pedal or footswitch. For
details on how to best play each voice, call up the Information window (pressing
the [7
π
] button in the Voice Selection display).
Mega Voice The Mega Voices are not intended to be played from the keyboard. They are
primarily designed for use with recorded MIDI sequence data (such as songs
and styles). Some of the guitar and bass Voices in particular have been cre-
ated as Mega Voices.
What makes Mega Voices special is their use of velocity switching. Normal
Voices use velocity switching, too—to make the sound quality and/or level of a
Voice according to how strongly or softly you play it. This makes the instrument’s
Voices sound authentic and natural. However, with Mega Voices, each velocity
range (the measure of your playing strength) has a completely different sound.
For example, a Mega guitar Voice includes the sounds of various performance
techniques. In conventional instruments, different Voices having those sounds
would be called up via MIDI and played in combination to achieve the desired
effect. However, now with Mega Voices, a convincing guitar part can be played
with just a single Voice, using specific velocity values to play the desired sounds.
Because of the complex nature of these Voices and the precise velocities need to
play the sounds, they’re not intended for playing from the keyboard. They are,
however, very useful and convenient when creating MIDI data—especially when
you want to avoid using several different Voices just for a single instrument part.
Live! These acoustic instrument sounds were sampled in stereo, to produce a truly
authentic, rich sound—full of atmosphere and ambience.
Cool! These Voices capture the dynamic textures and subtle nuances of electric
instruments—thanks to a huge amount of memory and some very sophisti-
cated programming.
Sweet! These acoustic instrument sounds also benefit from Yamaha’s sophisticated
technology—and feature a sound so finely detailed and natural, you’ll swear
you’re playing the real thing!
Live!Drums These are high-quality drum sounds taking full advantage of Stereo Sampling
and Dynamic Sampling.
Live!SFX These are high-quality Latin percussion sounds taking full advantage of Stereo
Sampling and Dynamic sampling. They give you a broader and more versatile
range of Latin percussion than the normal drum Voices.
Drums Various drum and percussion sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting
you play the sounds from the keyboard.
SFX Various special effect sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting you play
the sounds from the keyboard.
Organ Flutes!
This authentic organ Voice lets you use the Sound Creator to adjust the various
footages and craft your own original organ sounds. See page 103 for details.
Reference
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
79
Playing Different Voices Simulta-
neously
The instrument keyboard features various functions and performance conveniences
that are simply unavailable on an acoustic instrument. It allows you to play several
different Voices together in a layer, or play one Voice with your left hand while you
play a different Voice (or even two layered Voices!) with your right.
Keyboard Parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left)
Voices can be assigned independently to each keyboard part: Right 1, Right 2, and
Left. You can combine these parts by using the PART ON/OFF buttons to create a
rich, ensemble sound.
Keyboard Part Combinations
Playing a single Voice (Right 1 part)
You can play a single Voice over the entire keyboard range. This is used for nor-
mal performance—for example, with the piano Voice.
Make sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)] buttons are
turned off.
Dual: Playing Two Voices Simultaneously (Right 1 and 2 parts)
You can simulate a melody duet or combine two similar Voices to create a thicker sound.
Refer to page 80 for Voice selection operations for the Right 2 part.
Split: Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands (Right 1 and
Left parts)
You can play different Voices with the left and right hands. For example, try play-
ing the bass Voice with your left hand and the piano Voice with your right.
The keyboard lamp will light at the split point of the keyboard.
Refer to page 81 for Voice selection operations for the Left part.
Dual+Split: Playing Three Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands
(Right 1, 2 and Left parts)
You can combine these three parts to create a rich, ensemble sound.
Adjusting the volume balance
among parts
Adjust the volume balance
among the parts in the BALANCE
display (page 40).
Specifying the split point (the
border between the right-
and left-hand range)
See page 111.
Right 1 part
Right 2 part
Right 1 part
Left part
Right 1 part
Left part
Right 1 part
Right 2 part
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
80
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously (Right 1
and 2 Parts)
You can play two Voices simultaneously with the Right 1 and 2 parts by turning
Dual on.
1 Press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button to play two Voices
simultaneously with the Right 1 and 2 parts.
2 Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to call up the Voice
selection display for the Right 2 part.
3 Press the TAB [
] button to select the PRESET display.
4 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.
5 Play the keyboard.
6 Press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button again to turn it off.
For the selected part, a LEFT
mark appears at the right of the
Voice name in the Main display.
Quickly selecting Voices for
Right 1 and 2 parts
You can quickly select the Right
1 and 2 part Voices, just from the
VOICE category selection but-
tons. Press and hold one VOICE
category selection button, then
press another. The Voice of the
first pressed button is automati-
cally set for the Right 1 part,
while the Voice of the second
pressed button is set for the Right
2 part.
3
4
4
Switching the Dual on/off
with a pedal
You can use a pedal to switch the
Dual on/off (when the PART ON
/
OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] is appro-
priately assigned; page 191). This
is useful for turning the Dual on
and off while you play.
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
81
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Playing Different Voices with the Left and
Right Hands (Right 1 and Left Parts)
You can play different Voices with the Left and Right Hands (Right 1 and Left parts)
by turning Split on.
1 Press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button to play different Voices
with the Right and Left Hands (Right 1 and Left parts).
2 Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to call up the Voice
selection display for the Left part.
3 Press the TAB [
] button to select the PRESET display.
4 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.
5 Play the keyboard.
6 Press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button again to turn it off.
For the selected part, a RIGHT
mark appears at the left of the
Voice name in the Main display.
3
4
4
Switching the Split on/off
with a pedal
You can use a pedal to switch the
Split on/off (when the PART ON/
OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] is appropri-
ately assigned; page 191). This is
useful for turning the Split on
and off while you play.
Specifying the split point (the
border between the right-
and left-hand range)
See page 111.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound (iAFC)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
82
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of
the Sound (iAFC)
When iAFC is engaged, the instrument will sound deeper and more resonant, similar
to an acoustic musical instrument. This lets you experience the ambience and rever-
beration that are characteristic of performing on stage or simulates the sustain sound
that occur when you press the damper pedal of a grand piano.
This section describes how to make various settings for the iAFC function. You can
also perform an automatic adjustment in order to obtain the optimal iAFC effect.
Adjusting the iAFC Depth
The depth of the acoustic piano resonance simulation and stage ambience simula-
tion can be set.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [H] iAFC SETTING
2 Press the [D] button to turn the iAFC on.
3 Press the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] buttons to adjust the DYNAMIC DAMPER
EFFECT depth.
DYNAMIC DAMPER Effect
This simulates the sustain sound that occurs when you press the damper
pedal of a grand piano. The microphone is not used, but the sound pro-
duced within the instrument is processed to create a spacious sensation.
iAFC cannot be used in the
following cases.
•When the Speaker setting is
Headphones SW (page 17),
and headphones are con-
nected.
•When the Speaker setting is
Off.
• (CVP-409 grand piano type)
When the lid is closed or open
with the shorter stay.
When using iAFC, do not block
or cover the speaker located on
the underside of the keyboard
(CVP-409 grand piano type) or
the rear panel (CVP-409/407) of
the instrument. The optimal iAFC
effect cannot be obtained if this
speaker is blocked.
iAFC uses Yamaha’s EMR (Elec-
tronic Microphone Rotator) tech
-
nology to ensure stability against
acoustic feedback.
Turning on the iAFC of the CVP-409 grand piano type
To turn on the iAFC, open the lid with the longer stay using the inner recess.
When the lid is closed or open with the shorter stay, the iAFC will not be
turned on.
34
2
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound (iAFC)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
83
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
4
Press the [5
ππ
ππ
]/[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to adjust the SPATIAL EFFECT depth.
If you select the “SPATIAL EFFECT”, make sure to execute the calibration
operation (see below).
•SPATIAL EFFECT
Spatial Effect creates a sense of reverberation and spaciousness by picking up
the output sound using internal microphones and output the sound from the
speaker on the underside (CVP-409 grand piano type) or the rear (CVP-409/
407) of the instrument. The spread and spaciousness of the sound is different
depending on the depth. The default setting for the depth is 0.
For lower depth settings: This creates the resonance and enhances the
acoustic realism of the sound that is characteristic of acoustic instruments
by creating a virtual soundboard.
For deeper depth settings: The sound of the instrument itself and the sound
of singing and other instruments played nearby is picked up by internal
microphones, and processed to simulate the spatial characteristics of per-
forming together on stage.
Calibrating the iAFC Settings
This automatically adjusts the sensitivity and response of iAFC so that the optimal
iAFC effect will be obtained. Make sure to execute this operation when you use
“SPATIAL EFFECT.
1 Press the [I] (MIC CALIBRATION) button in the iAFC operation display
(page 82) to call up the calibration display.
2 Press the [G] (CALIBRATION START) button to begin calibration.
When automatic adjust begins, a test sound (noise) will sound for about five
seconds. While automatic adjustment is being performed, do not make
audible noises in the vicinity of the Clavinova.
2
If the iAFC effect is slight or inaudible:
If it seems that iAFC is not effective when playing back Songs or Styles, turn
the iAFC feature off.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [H] iAFC SETTING
2 Press the [D] button to turn iAFC off.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Changing Pitch
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
84
Restoring the Default Calibration Setting
[iAFC Default]
1 Press the [I] (MIC CALIBRATION) button in the iAFC operation display
(page 82) to call up the calibration display.
2 Press the [J] (BASIC SETTING) button to restore to the default setting.
Changing Pitch
Transpose
Transpose the pitch of the keyboard up or down (in semitones).
•Transposing during performance
You can easily set the desired transposition of the overall sound of the instru-
ment by pressing the TRANSPOSE [–]/[+] buttons.
•Transposing before performance
Change the transpose settings in the MIXING CONSOLE display. You can set the
transposition for the keyboard pitch (KBD), song playback (SONG), or overall
sound of the instrument (MASTER), respectively.
1 Call up the operation display.
[MIXING CONSOLE] TAB [
][
®
] TUNE
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the transposition.
Fine-tuning the Pitch of the Entire Instrument
You can fine-tune the pitch of the entire instrument—useful when you play the
instrument along with other instruments or CD music.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [A] MASTER TUNE/SCALE TUNE TAB [
] MASTER
TUNE
2 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the tuning.
Press the 4 or 5’s [
π
] and [
] buttons simultaneously to reset the value to
the factory resetting of 440.0 Hz.
Scale Tuning
You can select various scales for playing in custom tunings for specific historical
periods or music genres.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [A] MASTER TUNE/SCALE TUNE TAB [
®
] SCALE TUNE
Please note that the Tune func-
tion does not affect the Drum Kit
or SFX Kit Voices.
Hz (Hertz):
This unit of measurement refers
to the frequency of a sound and
represents the number of times a
sound wave vibrates in a second.
Changing Pitch
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
85
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
2 Select the desired part for which you want to set the scale by using
the [6
ππ
ππ
]/[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
Checkmark the box by pressing the [8
π
] button.
3 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the desired scale.
The tuning of each note for the currently selected scale is indicated in the
keyboard illustration at the upper right of the display.
4 Change the following settings as necessary.
•Tuning the individual notes of the keyboard (TUNE)
1 Press the [3
ππ
ππ
] button to select the note for tuning.
2 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the tuning in cents.
Determines the base note for each scale.
Press the [2
ππ
ππ
] button to select the base note.
When the base note is changed, the pitch of the keyboard is transposed,
yet maintains the original pitch relationship between the notes.
Preset Scale Types
Tuning values for Preset Scales (base note: C) (in cents)
* In the display, the rounded off value is shown.
Cent:
In musical terms a “cent” is 1/
100th of a semitone. (100 cents
equal one semitone.)
Instantly recalling the desired
scale
Register the desired scale to the
Registration Memory. Be sure to
checkmark the SCALE item when
registering (page 131).
EQUAL
TEMPERAMENT
The pitch range of each octave is divided equally into twelve parts, with
each half-step evenly spaced in pitch. This is the most commonly used
tuning in music today.
PURE MAJOR
PURE MINOR
These tunings preserve the pure mathematical intervals of each scale,
especially for triad chords (root, third, fifth). You can hear this best in
actual vocal harmonies – such as choirs and a cappella singing.
PYTHAGOREAN This scale was devised by the famous Greek philosopher and is created
from a series of perfect fifths, which are collapsed into a single octave.
The 3rd in this tuning are slightly unstable, but the 4th and 5th are
beautiful and suitable for some leads.
MEAN-TONE This scale was created as an improvement on the Pythagorean scale, by
making the major third interval more “in tune.” It was especially popu-
lar from the 16th century to the 18th century. Handel, among others,
used this scale.
WERCKMEISTER
KIRNBERGER
This composite scale combines the Werckmeister and Kirnberger sys-
tems, which were themselves improvements on the mean-tone and
Pythagorean scales. The main feature of this scale is that each key has
its own unique character. The scale was used extensively during the
time of Bach and Beethoven, and even now it is often used when per-
forming period music on the harpsichord.
ARABIC Use these tunings when playing Arabic music.
CC##
##
DEbb
bb
EFF##
##
GAbb
bb
ABbb
bb
B
EQUAL TEM-
PERAMENT
0 00 0 0 0000000
PURE MAJOR
0 -29.7 3.9 15.6 -14.1 -2.3 -9.4 2.3 -27.3 -15.6 18.0 -11.7
PURE MINOR
0 33.6 3.9 15.6 -14.1 -2.3 31.3 2.3 14.1 -15.6 18.0 -11.7
PYTHAGOREAN
0 14.1 3.9 -6.3 7.8 -2.3 11.7 2.3 15.6 6.3 -3.9 10.2
MEAN-TONE
0 -24.2 -7.0 10.2 -14.1 3.1 -20.3 -3.1 -27.3 -10.2 7.0 -17.2
WERCKMEISTER
0 -10.2 -7.8 -6.3 -10.2 -2.3 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8
KIRNBERGER
0 -10.2 -7.0 -6.3 -14.1 -2.3 -10.2 -3.1 -7.8 -10.2 -3.9 -11.7
ARABIC 1
00-50.0 0 0 0 0 0 0 -50.0 0 0
ARABIC 2
0000-50.0 0 0 0 0 0 0 -50.0
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the Keyboard
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
86
Adding Effects to Voices Played on
the Keyboard
The instrument features a sophisticated multi-processor effect system which can
add extraordinary depth and expression to your sound.
1 Call up the operation display.
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]
2 Select the desired part for which you want to add effects by pressing
one of the [A]–[C], [F]–[H] buttons.
3 Press the [VOICE EFFECT] button to call up the VOICE EFFECT display.
4 Use the buttons at the lower/right part of the display to apply effects
to the Voices.
Effect Parameters
You can use a pedal to turn the
Harmony/Echo effects on and off
(page 191).
Portamento:
Portamento is a function that cre
-
ates a smooth transition in pitch
from the first note played on the
keyboard to the next. The porta-
mento time (the pitch transition
time) can be set via the MIXING
CONSOLE display (page 90).
DSP:
Stands for Digital Signal Proces-
sor (or Processing). DSP changes
and enhances the audio signal in
the digital realm to produce a
wide range of effects.
LEFT HOLD
This function causes the LEFT part Voice to be held even when the keys are
released. Non-decaying voices such as strings are held continuously, while decay-
type voices such as piano decay more slowly (as if the sustain pedal has been
pressed).
HARMONY/
ECHO
The Harmony/Echo types are applied to the right-hand Voices (page 87).
MONO/POLY
This determines whether the part’s Voice is played monophonically (only one note
at a time) or polyphonically. Using the MONO mode lets you play single, lead
sounds (such as brass instruments) more realistically. It also lets you expressively
control the Portamento effect (depending on the selected Voice) by playing legato.
DSP/DSP
VARIATION
With the digital effects built into the instrument, you can add ambience and
depth to your music in a variety of ways—such as adding reverb that makes
you sound like you are playing in a concert hall.
•The DSP switch is used to turn the DSP (Digital Signal Processor) effect on
or off for the currently selected keyboard part.
•The DSP Variation switch is used to change between variations of the DSP
effect. You could use this while you play, for example, to change the rotat-
ing speed (slow/fast) of the rotary speaker effect.
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the Keyboard
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
87
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Selecting the Harmony/Echo type
You can select the desired Harmony/Echo effect from a variety of types.
In order to make the type you’ve selected here effective, set HARMONY/ECHO to
On in the display shown in step 4 above.
1
Call up the operation display by pressing the [J] (TYPE SELECT) button.
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the Harmony/Echo type
(see below).
3 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select various Harmony/Echo set-
tings (page 88).
The available settings differ depending on the Harmony/Echo type.
Harmony/Echo Types
The Harmony/Echo types are divided into the following groups, depending on the
particular effect applied.
Harmony Types
When one of the Harmony Types is selected, the Harmony effect is applied to notes
played in the right-hand section of the keyboard according to the type selected
above and the chord specified in the chord section of the keyboard shown below.
Echo Types
These types apply echo
effects to notes played in
the right-hand section of
the keyboard in time with
the currently set tempo.
Harmony Types
These types apply the harmony effect
to notes played in the right-hand sec-
tion of the keyboard according to the
chord specified in the left-hand sec-
tion of the keyboard. (Note that the
“1+5” and “Octave” settings are not
affected by the chord.)
Multi Assign Type
This type applies a special effect to
chords played in the right-hand section
of the keyboard.
Canceling the chord sound
for the harmony effect
This cancels the sound of the
chord played in the chord range
of the keyboard—letting you
hear only the Harmony effect.
Set [ACMP ON/OFF] to On, set
[SYNC START] to Off, and select
“Off” for the Stop Accompani-
ment parameter.
Split point Split point
Chord section for Style playback and
Harmony effect
Left Voice and
chord section for
Harmony effect
Split Point
(for Style)
Split Point
(for keyboard Voice)
Right 1
Right 2
Voices
Chord section
for Style
playback and
Harmony effect
Left Voice
Right 1
Right 2
Voices
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
88
Multi Assign Type
Multi Assign effect automatically assigns notes played simultaneously in the right-hand
section of the keyboard to separate parts (Voices). Both of the keyboard part [RIGHT
1] and [RIGHT 2] should be turned on when using the Multi Assign effect. The Right 1
and Right 2 Voices are alternately assigned to the notes in the order you play.
Echo Types
When one of the Echo Types is selected, the corresponding effect (echo, tremolo, trill) is
applied to the note played in the right-hand section of the keyboard in time with the cur-
rently set tempo, regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] and the LEFT part on/off status. Keep
in mind that Trill works when you hold down two notes on the keyboard simultaneously
(last two notes if more than two notes are held), and it plays those notes alternately.
Harmony/Echo Settings
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance
(MIXING CONSOLE)
The Mixing Console gives you intuitive control over aspects of the keyboard parts
and Song/Style channels, including volume balance and the timbre of the sounds.
It lets you adjust the levels and stereo position (pan) of each Voice to set the opti-
mum balance and stereo image, and lets you set how the effects are applied.
Basic Procedure
1 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CON-
SOLE display.
VOLUME
This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “Multi Assign.” It determines
the level of the harmony/echo notes generated by the Harmony/Echo effect.
SPEED This parameter is only available when Echo, Tremolo, or Trill is selected in Type
above. It determines the speed of the Echo, Tremolo, and Trill effects.
ASSIGN
This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “Multi Assign.” This lets
you determine the keyboard part via which the harmony/echo notes will be sounded.
CHORD
NOTE
ONLY
This parameter is available when one of the Harmony Types is selected. When this is set to
“ON,” the Harmony effect is applied only to the note (played in the right-hand section of
the keyboard) that belongs to a chord played in the chord section of the keyboard.
TOUCH
LIMIT
This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “Multi Assign.” It determines
the lowest velocity value at which the harmony note will sound. This allows you to selec-
tively apply the harmony by your playing strength, letting you create harmony accents in the
melody. The harmony effect is applied when you play the key strongly (above the set value).
1, 3
2
5
44
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
89
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
2 Use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.
For information on the available parameters, see the section “Adjustable
items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE displays” on page 90.
3 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button repeatedly to call up the MIX-
ING CONSOLE display for the relevant parts.
The MIXING CONSOLE displays actually consist of several different
part displays. The part name is indicated at the top of the display. The
various MIXING CONSOLE displays alternate among the following:
PANEL PART display STYLE PART display SONG CH 1–8 display
SONG CH 9–16 display
4 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired parameter.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the value.
6 Save your MIXING CONSOLE settings.
Saving the PANEL PART display settings
Register them to Registration Memory (page 131).
Saving the STYLE PART display settings
Save them as Style data.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU [B] STYLE CREATOR
2 Press the [EXIT] button to close the RECORD display.
3 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display for sav-
ing your data, then save it (page 69).
Saving the SONG CH 1–8/9–16 display settings
First register the edited settings as part of the Song data (SET UP), then save
the Song.
See the SONG CREATOR CHANNEL display SETUP item explana-
tion on page 162.
About Parts
See below.
Instantly setting all parts to
the same value
Once you’ve selected a parame-
ter in step 4, you can instantly
set the same value to all other
parts. To do this, simultaneously
hold down one of the [A]–[J] but-
tons, and use the [1]–[8] buttons
or the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
About Parts
PANEL PART
In the PANEL PART display of the MIXING CONSOLE, you can indepen-
dently adjust the level balance among the Keyboard parts (RIGHT 1, RIGHT
2 and LEFT), SONG, STYLE, and MIC parts. The part components are the
same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel [BAL-
ANCE] button (page 40).
STYLE PART
A Style consists of eight separate channels. Here you can adjust the level
balance among these eight channels or parts. These part components are the
same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel [CHAN-
NEL ON/OFF] button to call up the STYLE display.
SONG CH 1–8/9–16
A Song consists of sixteen separate channels. Here you can adjust the level
balance among these sixteen channels or parts. These part components are
the same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel
[CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the SONG display.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
90
Adjustable Items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE Dis-
plays
The following explanations cover the available items (parameters) in the MIXING
CONSOLE displays.
VOL/VOICE
FILTER
TUNE
EFFECT
•The RHY2 channel in the
STYLE PART display can only
be assigned to Drumkit Voices
and SFX kit Voices.
•When playing GM song data,
channel 10 (in the SONG CH
9–16 page) can only be used
for a Drum Kit Voice.
SONG AUTO REVOICE See page 91.
VOICE Allows you to re-select the Voices for each part. When the Style
channels are called up, neither Organ Flutes Voices nor User
Voices can be selected. When the Song channels are called up,
User Voices cannot be selected.
PANPOT Determines the stereo position of the selected part (channel).
VOLUME Determines the level of each part or channel, giving you fine
control over the balance of all the parts.
HARMONIC CONTENT Allows you to adjust the resonance effect (page 101) for each
part.
BRIGHTNESS Determines the brightness of the sound for each part by adjusting
the cutoff frequency (page 101).
PORTAMENTO TIME Portamento is a function that creates a smooth transition in pitch
from the first note played on the keyboard to the next. The Porta-
mento Time determines the pitch transition time. Higher values
result in a longer pitch change time. Setting this to “0” results in
no effect. This parameter is available when the selected keyboard
part is set to Mono (page 86).
PITCH BEND RANGE Determines the range of the PITCH BEND in semitones for each
keyboard part (when a pedal is assigned to this function).
OCTAVE Determines the range of the pitch change in octaves for each
keyboard part.
TUNING Determines the pitch of each keyboard part.
TRANSPOSE Allows you to set the transposition for the keyboard pitch (KEY-
BOARD), Song playback (SONG), or overall sound of the instru-
ment (MASTER), respectively.
TYPE Select the desired effect type (page 93). After editing various
parameters for the selected effect type, you can save it as an orig-
inal effect.
REVERB Adjusts the amount of the Reverb sound for each part or chan-
nel.
CHORUS Adjusts the amount of the Chorus sound for each part or chan-
nel.
DSP Adjusts the amount of the DSP sound for each part or channel.
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
91
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
EQ (Equalizer)
CMP (Master Compressor)
See page 97. This affects the overall sound of the instrument.
Song Auto Revoice
This feature lets you use the high-quality sounds of the instrument to full advantage
with XG-compatible song data. When you play back any commercially available
XG song data or that created on other instruments, you can use Auto Revoice to
automatically assign the specially created Voices of the instrument (Natural!, Live!,
Cool!, etc.) instead of the conventional XG Voices of the same type.
1–3 Same operation as in the “Basic Procedure” on page 88. In step 2,
select the VOL/VOICE tab.
4 Press the [G] (SETUP) button to call up the AUTO REVOICE SETUP dis-
play.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the Voice to be replaced.
6 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the Voice for replacing the
XG selected in step 5.
Several different Revoice settings are available by using the [F]/[G]/[I] but-
tons, for conveniently calling up the recommended Revoice settings in one
action.
ALL REVOICE: Replaces all of the replaceable XG Voices with the
high-quality Voices of the instrument.
PIANO REVOICE: Replaces only the piano Voices.
BASIC REVOICE: Replaces only the recommended Voices that are suit-
able for playing back the song.
ALL NO REVOICE: All Voices are returned to the original XG Voices.
TYPE Select the desired EQ type to suit the type of music and the per-
formance environment (page 95). This affects the overall sound
of the instrument.
EDIT For editing the EQ (page 95).
EQ HIGH Determines the center frequency of the high EQ band that is
attenuated/boosted for each part.
EQ LOW Determines the center frequency of the low EQ band that is
attenuated/boosted for each part.
567
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
92
7 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (OK) button to apply your Revoice settings.
To cancel the Revoice operation, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
8 In the VOL/VOICE tab display, press the [F] button to set SONG AUTO
REVOICE to ON.
Effect Type
Selecting an Effect type
1–3 Same operation as in the “Basic Procedure” on page 88. In step 2,
select the EFFECT tab.
4 Press the [F] (TYPE) button to call up the Effect Type selection display.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]/[2
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the effect BLOCK.
DSP:
Stands for Digital Signal Proces-
sor (or Processing). DSP changes
and enhances the audio signal in
the digital realm to produce a
wide range of effects.
5678
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
93
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
6 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the part to which you want
to apply the effect.
7 Use the [5
ππ
ππ
]/[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the effect CATEGORY.
8 Use the [7
ππ
ππ
]/[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the effect TYPE.
If you want to edit the effect parameters, go on to the next operation.
Editing and Saving the effect
9 Press the [F] (PARAMETER) button to call up the display for editing
the effect parameters.
Effect Block Effect-applicable parts Effect characteristics
REVERB All parts Reproduces the warm ambience of playing
in a concert hall or jazz club.
CHORUS All parts Produces a rich “fat” sound as if several
parts are being played simultaneously.
DSP1 STYLE PART
SONG CHANNNEL 1–16
In addition to the Reverb and Chorus types,
the instrument has special DSP effects, that
include additional effects usually used for a
specific part, such as distortion and tremolo.
DSP2
DSP3
DSP4
DSP5
RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2, LEFT,
SONG CHANNEL 1–16
Any unused DSP blocks are automatically
assigned to the appropriate parts (channels)
as needed.
DSP6 Microphone sound Dedicated for use only with the microphone
sound.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
94
10 If you have selected one of the DSP 2–5 effect blocks in step 5:
You can edit its standard parameters as well as its variation parameter.
To select the standard type of parameters, press the [B] button. To select its
variation parameter, press the [E] button.
11 Select one of the parameters you want to edit by using the [4
ππ
ππ
]/
[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
Available parameters differ depending on the selected Effect type.
12 Adjust the value for the selected parameter by using the [6
ππ
ππ
]/
[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons. If you have selected the REVERB, CHORUS or DSP1
effect block in step 5:
Adjust the Effect Return Level by pressing [8
π†
] button.
13 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the display for saving your origi-
nal effect.
14 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the destination for saving
the effect.
The maximum number for effects that can be saved differs depending on the
effect block.
15 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save the effect (page 69).
When recalling the saved effect, use the same procedure as in step 8.
Re-selecting the Effect block,
category and type
Use the [1
π†
]–[3
π†
] but-
tons. The re-selected effect con-
figuration is displayed at the
upper left side box in the display.
Effect Return Level:
Determines the level or amount
of effect applied.
This is set for all parts or chan-
nels.
10
13
11 12
14
15
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
95
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
EQ (Equalizer)
Equalizer (also called “EQ”) is a sound processor that divides the frequency spec-
trum into multiple bands that can be boosted or cut as required to tailor the overall
frequency response. Usually an equalizer is used to correct the sound from speak-
ers to match the special character of the room. For example, you can cut some of
the low range frequencies when playing in large spaces where the sound is too
“boomy,” or boost the high frequencies in rooms and close spaces where the sound
is relatively “dead” and free of echoes. The instrument possesses a high-grade five-
band digital EQ. With this function, a final effect—tone control can be added to the
output of your instrument. You can select one of the five preset EQ settings in the
EQ display. You can even create your own custom EQ settings by adjusting the fre-
quency bands, and save the settings to one of two User Master EQ types.
Select a Preset EQ type
1–3 Same operation as in the “Basic Procedure” on page 88. In step 2,
select the EQ tab.
4 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset EQ type to suit your perfor-
mance (music style or environment).
If you want to edit the EQ parameters, go on to the next operation.
Editing and Saving the selected EQ
5 Press the [F] (EDIT) button to call up the MASTER EQ EDIT display.
0
Gain
5 bands
Bandwidth
(also called “Shape” or “Q”)
Freq (Frequency)
EQ1 EQ2 EQ3 EQ4 EQ5
LOW LOW MID MID HIG MID HIGH
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
96
6 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset EQ type.
7 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to boost or cut each of the five
bands.
Use the [8
π†
] button to boost or cut all the five bands at the same time.
8 Adjust the Q (bandwidth) and the FREQ (center frequency) of the
band selected in step 7.
Bandwidth (also called “Shape” or “Q”)
Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]button. The higher the value of Q, the narrower the band
width.
FREQ (center frequency)
Use the [2
π†
]button. The available FREQ range is different for each
band.
9 Press the [H] or [I] (STORE 1 or 2) button to save the edited EQ type
(page 69).
Up to two types of EQ can be created and saved. When recalling the saved
EQ type, use the same procedure as in step 6.
6
9
7
8
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
97
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Master Compressor
Compressor is an effect commonly used to limit and compress the dynamics (soft-
ness/loudness) of an audio signal. For signals that vary widely in dynamics, such as
vocals and guitar parts, it “squeezes” the dynamic range, effectively making soft
sounds louder and loud sounds softer. When used with gain to boost the overall
level, this creates a more powerful, more consistently high-level sound. Compres-
sion can be used to increase sustain for electric guitar, smooth out the volume of a
vocal, or bring a drum kit or rhythm pattern further up-front in the mix. The instru-
ment has a sophisticated multi-band compressor that allows you to adjust the com-
pression effect for individual frequency bands—giving you detailed sonic control.
You can edit and save your own custom Compressor types, or conveniently select
from one of the presets.
Selecting a Master Compressor type
1–3 Same operation as in the “Basic Procedure” on page 88. In step 2,
select the CMP tab.
4 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset Master Compressor type.
Selecting a Master Compressor type automatically sets the parameters (at the
bottom of the display) to the optimum values for the type.
5 Press the [F] button to set the Master Compressor to ON.
If you want to edit the Master Compressor parameters, go on to the next operation.
4
5
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
98
Editing and Saving the selected Master Compressor
6 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]/[2
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the frequency curve for the
Compressor, or which frequencies compression is applied to.
For example, select “LOW” when you want to emphasize low frequencies,
and “HIGH” when you want to emphasize high frequencies.
7 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to determine the Threshold (mini-
mum level at which compression starts) and Gain (level of com-
pressed signal at three separate frequency bands).
These values offset those of the frequency curve settings in step 6.
8 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the display for saving your origi-
nal Master Compressor settings.
9 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the destination for saving
the Master Compressor settings.
10 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save the Master Compressor settings
(page 69).
When recalling the saved Master Compressor settings, use the same proce-
dure as in step 4.
67
8
Threshold:
Determines the minimum level
at which compression starts. The
compressor affects only the
sound of levels higher than that
of Threshold.
9
10
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
99
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
The instrument has a Sound Creator feature that allows you to create your own
Voices by editing some parameters of the existing Voices. Once you’ve created a
Voice, you can save it as a User Voice to the USER/(USB) display for future recall.
The editing method is different for the ORGAN FLUTES Voices and for other
Voices.
Basic Procedure
1
Select the desired Voice (other than an Organ Flutes Voice) (page 32).
2 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] (VOICE SET) button to call up the VOICE SET display.
3 Use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.
For information on the available parameters, see the “Editable Parameters in
the VOICE SET Displays” on page 100.
4 As necessary, use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the item (parameter)
to be edited.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the Voice.
6 Press the [D] (COMPARE) button to compare the sound of the edited
Voice with the unedited Voice.
7 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited Voice (page 69).
Editing the ORGAN FLUTES
Voices
The editing method is different
for the ORGAN FLUTES Voices
compared to other Voices. For
instructions on editing the
ORGAN FLUTES Voices, see
page 103.
CAUTION
If you select another Voice
without saving the settings,
the settings will be lost. If you
wish to store the settings
here, make sure to save the
settings as a User Voice before
selecting another Voice or
turning the power off.
4
6
5
7
3
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
100
Editable Parameters in the VOICE SET Displays
The following covers in detail the editable parameters that are set in the displays
explained in step 3 of the “Basic Procedure” on page 99. The Sound Creator param-
eters are organized into five different displays. The parameters in each display are
described separately, below. These are also treated as part of the Voice Set parame-
ters (page 106), which are automatically called up when the Voice is selected.
PIANO
This display is available only when the Natural! piano Voice (page 78) is selected.
COMMON
CONTROLLER
1. MODULATION
When a pedal function is assigned to MODULATION, the pedal can be used to
modulate the parameters below as well as the pitch (vibrato). Here, you can set the
degree to which the pedal modulates each of the following parameters.
The available parameters differ
depending on the Voice.
Changes to velocity curve
according to Touch sensitivity
TOUCH SENSE DEPTH
Changes to velocity curve
according to VelDepth (with Off-
set set to 64)
TOUCH SENSE OFFSET
Changes to velocity curve
according to VelOffset (with
Depth set to 64)
Portamento Time:
The Portamento Time deter-
mines the pitch transition time.
Portamento is a function that cre-
ates a smooth transition in pitch
from the first note played on the
keyboard to the next.
127
127
64
64
0
A
ctual Velocity
f
or tone generator
Depth=127
(twice)
Depth=32
(half)
Depth=64
(normal)
Depth=0
Received Velocity
(Actual KeyOn speed)
64
127
0
127
64
Actual Velocity
for tone generator
Offset=96 (+64)
Offset=127
(+127)
Offset=64
(normal)
Offset=32
(-64)
Received
Velocity
(Actual
KeyOn speed)
Offset=0 (-127)
Depends on
offset
Depends on
offset
TUNING CURVE Determines the tuning curve. Select “FLAT” if you feel the tuning
curve of the piano Voice does not quite match that of other instru-
ments Voices.
STRETCH
Tuning curve particularly for pianos
FLAT
Tuning curve in which the frequency is octave doubled over the
entire keyboard range
KEY OFF SAMPLE Adjusts the volume of the key-off sound (the subtle sound that
occurs when you release a key).
SUSTAIN SAMPLE Adjusts the depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal.
STRING RESONANCE Adjusts the depth of string resonance.
VOLUME Adjusts the volume of the current edited Voice.
TOUCH SENSE Adjusts the touch sensitivity (velocity sensitivity), or how greatly the
volume responds to your playing strength.
DEPTH
Determines the velocity sensitivity, or how much the level of the
voice changes in response to your playing strength (velocity).
OFFSET
Determines the amount by which received velocities are adjusted
for the actual velocity effect.
PART OCTAVE Shifts the octave range of the edited Voice up or down in octaves.
When the edited Voice is used as any of the RIGHT 1–2 parts, the
R1/R2 parameter is available; when the edited Voice is used as the
LEFT part, the LEFT parameter is available.
MONO/POLY Determines whether the edited Voice is played monophonically or
polyphonically (page 86).
PORTAMENTO TIME
Sets the portamento time when the edited Voice is set to “MONO” above.
FILTER Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the Filter Cut-
off Frequency. For details about the filter, see page 101.
AMPLITUDE Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the amplitude
(volume).
LFO PMOD Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the pitch, or
the vibrato effect.
LFO FMOD Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the Filter
modulation, or the wah effect.
LFO AMOD Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the amplitude,
or the tremolo effect.
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
101
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
2. LEFT PEDAL
This allows you to select the function to be assigned to the left pedal.
SOUND
FILTER
Filter is a processor that changes the timbre or tone of a sound by either blocking
or passing a specific frequency range. The parameters below determine the overall
timbre of the sound by boosting or cutting a certain frequency range. In addition to
making the sound either brighter or mellower, Filter can be used to produce elec-
tronic, synthesizer–like effects.
FUNCTION Selects the function to be assigned to the left pedal. For details on
the pedal functions, see page 191.
[2
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] but-
tons (RIGHT 1, RIGHT
2, LEFT, etc.)
Determines whether the assigned function is effective or not for the
respective keyboard part. This also determines the depth for the
function. For details, see page 192.
BRIGHTNESS Determines the cutoff frequency or effective frequency range of the
filter (see diagram). Higher values result in a brighter sound.
HARMONIC CONTENT Determines the emphasis given to the cutoff frequency (resonance),
set in BRIGHTNESS above (see diagram). Higher values result in a
more pronounced effect.
Volume
Cutoff frequency
These frequencies are
“passed” by the filter.
Frequency (pitch)
Cutoff range
Volume
Frequency (pitch)
Resonance
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
102
EG
The EG (Envelope Generator) settings determine how the level of the sound
changes in time. This lets you reproduce many sound characteristics of natural
acoustic instruments—such as the quick attack and decay of percussion sounds, or
the long release of a sustained piano tone.
VIBRATO
EFFECT/EQ
1. REVERB DEPTH/CHORUS DEPTH/DSP DEPTH
ATTACK Determines how quickly the sound reaches its maximum level after
the key is played. The lower the value, the quicker the attack.
DECAY Determines how quickly the sound reaches its sustain level (a
slightly lower level than maximum). The lower the value, the
quicker the decay.
RELEASE Determines how quickly the sound decays to silence after the key is
released. The lower the value, the quicker the decay.
Level
Sustain level
Time
Key on Key off
AT TACK DECAY RELEASE
Vibrato:
A quavering, vibrating sound
effect that is produced by regu-
larly modulating the pitch of the
Voice.
DEPTH Determines the intensity of the Vibrato effect. Higher settings result
in a more pronounced Vibrato.
SPEED Determines the speed of the Vibrato effect.
DELAY Determines the amount of time that elapses between the playing of
a key and the start of the Vibrato effect. Higher settings increase the
delay of the Vibrato onset.
Pitch
Time
SPEED
DEPTH
DELAY
Switching the VIBE ROTOR
on/off with a pedal
You can use a pedal to switch the
VIBE ROTOR on/off (when the
VIBE ROTOR ON/OFF function
is properly assigned; page 191).
REVERB DEPTH Adjusts the reverb (page 93) depth.
CHORUS DEPTH Adjusts the chorus (page 93) depth.
DSP DEPTH Adjusts the DSP (page 93) depth.
If you want to re-select the DSP type, you can do so in the DSP
menu explained on page 103.
DSP ON/OFF Determines whether the DSP is on or off.
VIBE ROTOR This will be displayed only if VIBE VIBRATE is selected for the DSP
Type parameter explained on page 93. Determines whether VIBE
VIBRATE should be set to on or off when selecting the Voice.
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
103
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
2. DSP
3. EQ
HARMONY
Harmony sets the Right 1 and 2 parts together. Select the Right 1 part (page 32,
step 1) in the Main display, before you set it. This has the same settings as the dis-
play of “Selecting the Harmony/Echo type” on page 87 in step 1.
Creating Your Original Organ Flutes Voices
The instrument features a variety of lush, dynamic organ Voices that you can call
up with the [ORGAN FLUTES] button. It also gives you the tools to create your
own original organ sounds by using the Sound Creator function. Just as on a tradi-
tional organ, you can create your own sounds by adjusting the levels of the flute
footages.
Basic Procedure
1 Select the desired Organ Flutes Voice to be edited (page 32).
DSP TYPE Selects the DSP effect category and type. Select a type after select-
ing a category.
VARIATION Two variations are provided for each DSP type.
Here, you can edit the VARIATION on/off status and variation-
parameter value setting.
ON/OFF
The factory-programmed assignments are set to variation-off for
all Voices (standard variation of DSP is assigned). If you select
VARIATION ON here, a variation of the DSP effect is assigned to
the Voice. The variation parameter value can be adjusted in the
VALUE menu explained below.
PARAMETER
Displays the variation parameter.
VALUE
Adjusts the value of the DSP variation parameter.
EQ LOW/HIGH These determine the Frequency and Gain of the Low and High EQ
bands.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
104
2 In the ORGAN FLUTES Voice Selection display, press the [6
ππ
ππ
] (FOOT-
AGE) button to call up the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] display.
3 Use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.
For information on the available parameters, see the following “Editable
Parameters in the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] displays.
4 If you select the EFFECT/EQ tab display, use the [A]/[B] buttons to
select the parameter to be edited.
5 Use the [A]–[D], [F]–[H] and [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the
Voice.
6 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited ORGAN FLUTES Voice
(page 69).
4
5
3
6
(When selecting
the EFFECT/EQ
tab display.)
CAUTION
If you select another Voice
without saving the settings,
the settings will be lost. If you
wish to store the settings
here, make sure to save the
settings as a User Voice before
selecting another Voice or
turning the power off.
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
105
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Editable Parameters in the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] displays
The following covers in detail the editable parameters that are set in the displays
explained in step 3 of the “Basic Procedure” on page 103. The Organ Flutes
parameters are organized into three different pages. The parameters in each page
are described separately, below. These are also treated as part of the Voice Set
parameters (page 106), which are automatically called up when the Voice is
selected.
FOOTAGE, VOLUME/ATTACK (common parameters)
FOOTAGE
VOLUME/ATTACK
ORGAN TYPE Specifies the type of organ tone generation to be simulated: Sine or
Vintage.
ROTARY SP SPEED Alternately switches between the slow and fast rotary speaker
speeds when a rotary speaker effect is selected for the Organ Flutes
(see “EFFECT/EQ” DSP TYPE parameter on page 103), and the Voice
Effect DSP (page 103) is turned on (this parameter has the same
effect as the Voice Effect VARIATION ON/OFF parameter).
VIBRATO ON/OFF Alternately turns the vibrato effect for the Organ Flutes Voice ON or
OFF.
VIBRATO DEPTH Sets the Vibrato depth to one of three levels: 1 (low), 2 (mid), or 3
(high).
Footage:
The term “footage” is a reference
to the sound generation of tradi-
tional pipe organs, in which the
sound is produced by pipes of
different lengths (in feet).
16' ← → 5 1/3'
Which footage (16' or 5 1/3') is operated with the [1
π†
] button can
be switched by pressing the [D] button.
16'–1'
Determines the basic sound of the organ flutes. The longer the pipe, the
lower the pitch of the sound. Hence, the 16' setting determines the low-
est pitched component of the Voice, while the 1' setting determines the
highest pitched component. The higher the value of the setting, the
greater the volume of the corresponding footage. Mixing various vol-
umes of the footages lets you create your own distinctive organ sounds.
VOL Adjusts the overall volume of the Organ Flutes. The longer the
graphic bar, the greater the volume.
RESP Affects both the attack and release (page 102) portion of the sound,
increasing or decreasing the response time of the initial swell and
release, based on the FOOTAGE controls. The higher the value, the
slower the swell and release.
VIBRATO SPEED Determines the speed of the vibrato effect controlled by the Vibrato
On/Off and Vibrato Depth above.
MODE The MODE control selects between two modes: FIRST and EACH.
In the FIRST mode, attack is applied only to the first notes played
and held simultaneously; while the first notes are held, any subse-
quently played notes have no attack applied. In the EACH mode,
attack is applied equally to all notes.
4', 2 2/3', 2' These determine the attack sound volume of the ORGAN FLUTE
Voice. The 4', 2-2/3' and 2' controls increase or reduce the volume
of attack sound at the corresponding footages. The longer the
graphic bar, the greater the attack sound volume.
LENG Affects the attack portion of the sound producing a longer or shorter
decay immediately after the initial attack. The longer the graphic
bar, the longer the decay.
Using, Creating and Editing Voices
Voice Creating (Sound Creator)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
106
EFFECT/EQ
Same parameters as in the VOICE SET “EFFECT/EQ” tab display explained on
page 102.
Disabling automatic selection of Voice Sets (effects, etc.)
Each Voice is linked to its related parameter settings that are indicated in the
VOICE SET displays, including effects and EQ. Usually these settings are
automatically called up when a Voice is selected. However, you can also
disable this feature by the operation in the relevant display as explained
below.
For example, if you want to change the Voice yet keep the same Harmony
effect, set the HARMONY/ECHO parameter to OFF (in the display explained
below).
You can set these independently by keyboard part and parameter group.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST.SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET TAB [
®
]
VOICE SET
2 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a keyboard part.
3 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to enable/disable automatic calling
up of the settings (ON or OFF) independently for each parameter
group.
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of parameters contained in each
parameter group.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
107
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Characteristics
The Style type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Style
name.
Selecting a Chord Fingering Type
Style playback can be controlled by the chords you play in the chord section of the
keyboard. There are seven types of fingerings.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING
TAB [
®
] CHORD FINGERING
2 Press the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[3
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select a fingering.
Reference to Quick Guide pages
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto
Accompaniment Feature ..................................................................... page 45
Pattern Variation ...................................................................... page 47
Learning How to Play (Indicate) Chords for Style Playback ...... page 49
Appropriate Panel Settings for the Selected Style
(One Touch Setting) ................................................................. page 50
Pro
These Styles provide professional and exciting arrangements combined
with perfect playability. The resulting accompaniment exactly follows the
chords of the player. As a result, your chord changes and colorful harmo-
nies are instantly transformed into lifelike musical accompaniment.
Session These Styles provide even greater realism and authentic backing by
mixing in original chord types and changes, as well as special riffs with
chord changes, with the Main sections. These have been programmed
to add “spice” and a professional touch to your performances of certain
songs and in certain genres. Keep in mind, however, that the Styles may
not necessarily be appropriate—or even harmonically correct—for all
songs and for all chord playing. In some cases for example, playing a
simple major triad for a country song may result in a “jazzy” seventh
chord, or playing an on-bass chord may result in inappropriate or unex-
pected accompaniment.
Pianist These special Styles provide piano-only accompaniment. Just by play-
ing the proper chords with your left hand, you can automatically add
complicated, professional-sounding arpeggios and bass/chord patterns.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels of a Style
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
108
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels
of a Style
Rhythm is one of the most important parts of a Style. Try to play the melody along
with just the rhythm. You can sound different rhythms for each Style. Keep in mind,
however, that not all Styles contain rhythm channels.
1 Select a Style (page 45).
2 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] to turn Auto Accompaniment off.
3 Press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button to play back the
rhythm channels.
4 Press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button to stop the rhythm.
AI:
Artificial Intelligence
Starting the rhythm with Sync
Start
You can also start the rhythm
simply by playing the keyboard,
if Sync Start is enabled (turn on
the [SYNC START] button).
The rhythm does not sound for
the Pianist Styles (or other similar
Styles). When you want to use
any of these Styles, always make
sure that ACMP ON/OFF is
turned on.
SINGLE FINGER Makes it simple to produce
orchestrated accompani-
ment using major, seventh,
minor and minor-seventh
chords by pressing a mini-
mum number of keys on the
Chord section of the key-
board. This type is available
only for Style playback.
The abbreviated chord fin-
gerings described at right are
used:
MULTI FINGER Automatically detects Single Finger or Fingered chord fingerings, so you
can use either type of fingering without having to switch fingering types.
FINGERED
Lets you finger your own chords on the Chord section of the keyboard,
while the instrument supplies appropriately orchestrated rhythm, bass,
and chord accompaniment in the selected Style. The Fingered type rec-
ognizes the various chord types which are listed on the separate Data List
booklet and can be looked up using the Chord Tutor function (page 49).
FINGERED ON
BASS
Accepts the same fingerings as the Fingered, but the lowest note played
in the Chord section of the keyboard is used as the bass note, allowing
you to play “on bass” chords (in the Fingered mode the root of the
chord is always used as the bass note).
FULL KEYBOARD Detects chords in the entire key range. Chords are detected in a way
similar to Fingered, even if you split the notes between your left and
right hands—for example, playing a bass note with your left hand and a
chord with your right, or by playing a chord with your left hand and a
melody note with your right.
AI FINGERED Basically the same as Fingered, with the exception that less than three
notes can be played to indicate the chords (based on the previously
played chord, etc.).
AI FULL KEYBOARD When this advanced fingering type is engaged, the instrument will auto-
matically create appropriate accompaniment while you play just about
anything, anywhere on the keyboard using both hands. You don’t have
to worry about specifying the Style chords. Although the AI Full Key-
board type is designed to work with many songs, some arrangements
may not be suitable for use with this feature. This type is similar to Full
Keyboard, with the exception that less than three notes can be played to
indicate the chords (based on the previously played chord, etc.). 9th,
11th and 13th chords cannot be played. This type is available only for
Style playback.
Cm
C
Cm
7
C
7
For a major chord,
press the root key only.
For a minor chord,
simultaneously press the root
key and a black key to its left.
For a seventh chord,
simultaneously press the root
key and a white key to its left.
For a minor-seventh chord,
simultaneously press the root key a
both a white and black key to its lef
t
Style Playback-related Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
109
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Playback-related Settings
The instrument has a variety of Style playback functions, which can be accessed in
the display , see page 110.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING
TAB[
] STYLE SETTING
Turning channels of the Style on/off
A Style contains eight channels: RHY1 (Rhythm 1) – PHR2 (Phrase 2). You
can add variations and change the feeling of a Style by selectively turning
channels on/off as the Style plays.
1 Press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the CHANNEL ON/
OFF display.
When the STYLE tab is not selected, press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] but-
ton again.
2 Press the [1
]–[8
] buttons to turn the channels on or off.
To listen to only one instrument by itself, hold down the appropriate but-
ton for the channel to set the channel to SOLO. To cancel SOLO, simply
press the appropriate channel button again.
Playing the chords in free tempo (without Style playback)
You can have the accompaniment chords sound without playing back the
Style, by setting [ACMP ON/OFF] to on, and [SYNC START] to off. For
example, if MULTI FINGER is selected (page 108), you can perform with
your own pace while sounding the chord by pressing the chord section of
the keyboard with your one finger.
Setting the fade in/out time
You can set the time of the fade in and fade out (page 137).
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[
] CONFIG 1 [A] FADE IN/OUT/
HOLD TIME
2 Set the parameters by using the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
FADE IN TIME Determines the time it takes for the volume to fade in, or go
from minimum to maximum.
FADE OUT TIME Determines the time it takes for the volume to fade out, or go
from maximum to minimum.
FADE OUT HOLD
TIME
Determines the time the volume is held at 0 following the fade
out.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Playback-related Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
110
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons for each setting.
Stop Accompaniment
When [ACMP ON/OFF] is turned on and [SYNC START] is off, you can play chords
in the chord section of the keyboard with the Style stopped, and still hear the accom-
paniment chord. In this condition—called “Stop Accompaniment”—any valid chord
fingerings are recognized and the chord root/type are shown in the display.
From the display above, you can determine whether the chord played in the
chord section will sound or not in the Stop Accompaniment status.
OFF...............................The chord played in the chord section will not sound.
STYLE...........................The chord played in the chord section will sound via the
Voices of the selected Style.
FIXED ...........................The chord played in the chord section will sound via the
specified Voice, regardless of the selected Style.
OTS Link Timing
This applies to the OTS Link function (page 51). This parameter determines the
timing in which the One Touch Settings change with the MAIN VARIATION [A]–
[D] change. (The [OTS LINK] button must be on.)
Real Time.....................One Touch Setting is immediately called up when you
press a MAIN VARIATION button.
Next Bar ......................One Touch Setting is called up at the next measure, after
you press a MAIN VARIATION button.
Synchro Stop Window
This determines how long you can hold a chord before the Synchro Stop function is
automatically cancelled. When the [SYNC STOP] button is turned on and this is set to a
value other than “OFF,” this automatically cancels the Synchro Stop function if you hold
a chord for longer than the time set here. This conveniently resets Style playback control
to normal, letting you release the keys and still have the Style play. In other words, if you
release the keys sooner than the time set here, the Synchro Stop function works.
Style Touch
Turns touch response for the Style playback on/off. When this is set to “ON,” the Style vol-
ume changes in response to your playing strength in the chord section of the keyboard.
Style Change Behavior
There are three types as shown below.
Section Set
Determines the default section that is automatically called up when selecting differ-
ent Styles (when Style playback is stopped). When set to “OFF” and Style playback
is stopped, the active section is maintained even if the different Style is selected.
When any of the MAIN A-D sections is not included in the Style data, the nearest
section is automatically selected. For example, when MAIN D is not contained in
the selected Style, MAIN C will be called up.
Data that is recorded when
recording a Song
Please note that both the Voice
that is sounded and the chord
data will be recorded when set
to “STYLE,” and only the chord
data will be recorded when set
to “OFF” or “FIXED.”
Split Point Settings
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
111
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Tempo
This determines whether the tempo changes or not when you change Styles dur-
ing Style playback.
HOLD ................The tempo setting of the previous Style is maintained.
RESET.................The tempo changes to that of the initial default tempo for the
selected Style.
Part On/Off
This determines whether the Style Channel On/Off status changes or not when
you change Styles during Style playback.
HOLD ................. The Style Channel On/Off status of the previous Style is maintained.
RESET.................All Style Channels are set to On.
Split Point Settings
These are the settings (there are two Split Points) that separate the different sec-
tions of the keyboard: the Chord section, the LEFT part section and the RIGHT 1
and 2 section. The two Split Point settings (below) are specified as note names.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD
FINGERING TAB [
][
®
] SPLIT POINT
2 Use the [F]–[H] buttons to set the Split Point (see below).
Split Point (S)—separates the Chord section for Style playback from the
section(s) for playing Voices (RIGHT 1, 2 and LEFT)
Split Point (L)—separates the two sections for playing Voices, LEFT and
RIGHT 1– 2.
These two settings can be set to the same note (as in the default) or two different
notes as desired.
Split Point (L) cannot be set lower than Split Point (S), and Split Point (S) cannot be
set higher than Split Point (L).
Specifying the Split Point by
note name
Press the [1
π†
]–[4
π†
] but-
tons. You can specify the Split
Point of the Voice and chord sec-
tion of the keyboard by using
STYLE in the display, and you can
specify the Split Point of the left
and right Voices by using LEFT.
Voice RIGHT 1and 2
Split Point (S+L)
Chord section +
Voice LEFT
Press the [F] (S+L) button and rotate the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
Press the [H] (S) button or the [G] (L) button and rotate the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
Split Point (S)
Split Point (L)
Chord section
Voice LEFT
Voice RIGHT 1and 2
Setting the Split Point (S) and the Split Point (L) to the same note
Setting the Split Point (S) and the Split Point (L) to different notes
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance of the Style (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
112
Editing the Volume and Tonal Bal-
ance of the Style (MIXING CONSOLE)
You can set various mixing-related parameters of the Style. (See “Adjustable items
(parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE display” on page 90.) Call up the “STYLE
PART” display in step #3 of the Basic Procedure in “Editing the Volume Balance and
Voice Combination (MIXING CONSOLE)” on page 88, and follow the instructions.
Convenient Music Finder feature
Music Finder (page 52) is a convenient feature that calls up pre-programmed panel
settings (for Voices, Styles, etc.) that match the song or type of music you want to
play. The records of the Music Finder can be searched and edited.
Searching the Records
You can search the records by specifying a song name or keyword, using the Search func-
tion of the Music Finder. You can also save your favorite records in the FAVORITE display.
1
Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.
2 Press the TAB [
] button to select the ALL tab.
The ALL tab display contains the preset Records.
3 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] (SEARCH 1) button to call up the Search display.
4 Enter the search criteria.
Clear the search criteria
To clear the entered Music/Key-
word/Style, press the [F]/[G]/[H]
(CLEAR) button.
Convenient Music Finder feature
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
113
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Search by song title or music genre (MUSIC) or keyword
1 Press the [A] (MUSIC)/[B] (KEYWORD) button to call up the character
entry display.
2 Enter the song title or music genre, or the keyword (page 73).
Search by Style name
1 Press the [C] (STYLE) button to call up the Style selection display.
2 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Style.
3 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the search display.
Adding other Search Criteria
You can specify other search criteria in addition to the song name/keyword/Style
name.
BEAT ............................Select the beat (time signature) you want to use in your
performance by pressing the [D] button. All beat settings
are included in the search if you select ANY.
SEARCH AREA .............Select the pages to be included in the search by pressing
the [E] button. (These correspond to the tabs at the top
of the Music Finder display.)
TEMPO.........................Set the range of the tempo you want to use in your per-
formance by using the [1
π†
]/[2
π†
] (TEMPO) but-
tons.
GENRE .........................Select the desired music genre by using the [5
π†
]/
[6
π†
] (GENRE) buttons.
5 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (START SEARCH) button to start the search.
The Search 1 display appears, showing the results of the search. To cancel
searching, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
Entering several different key-
words
You can search several different
keywords simultaneously by
inserting a separator (comma)
between each.
Searching other music genres
When you want to search other music genres, press the [6
] (SEARCH 2)
button in the Music Finder display. The search result is displayed in the
SEARCH 2 display.
Calling up the panel settings to match the style (REPERTOIRE)
When searching by style name, the same search result is obtained even if
the search is done by using the Repertoire function. See page 53 for
details.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Convenient Music Finder feature
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
114
Creating a Set of Favorite Records
As convenient as the Search function is in plumbing the depths of the Music Finder
records, you may want to create a “folder” of favorite records—so you can quickly
call up those Styles and settings you use most often in your performance.
1 Select the desired record from the Music Finder display.
2 Press the [H] (ADD TO FAVORITE) button to add the selected record
to the FAVORITE display.
3 Call up the FAVORITE display by using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons, and
check to see if the record has been added.
Deleting Records from the FAVORITE Display
1 Select the record you want to delete from the FAVORITE display.
2 Press the [H] (DELETE FROM FAVORITE) button.
Editing Records
You can create a new record by editing the currently selected record. The newly
created records are automatically saved in the internal memory.
1 Select the desired record to be edited in the Music Finder display.
2 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (RECORD EDIT) button to call up the Edit display.
CAUTION
You can also change a preset
record to create a new one. If
you want to keep the original
preset, make sure to change
the name and register the
edited record as a new record
(see step 5, page 115).
Convenient Music Finder feature
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
115
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
3 Edit the record as desired.
Editing the song name/keyword/Style name
Input each item in the same way as done in the Search display (page 113).
Changing the Tempo
Press the [1
π†
] (TEMPO) button.
Memorizing the Section (Intro/Main/Ending)
Use the [2
π†
]/[4
π†
] buttons to select the section that will automatically be
called up set when the record is selected. This is useful, for example, when you
want to have a selected Style automatically be set up to start with an Intro sec-
tion.
Editing the Genre
Select the desired genre by using the [5
π†
]/[6
π†
] (GENRE) buttons. When
creating a new genre, press the [7
π†
] (GENRE NAME) button and input the
genre name. (page 73)
Deleting the Currently Selected Record
Press the [I] (DELETE RECORD) button.
Canceling and Quitting the Edit functions
Press the [8
] (CANCEL) button.
4 To enter the edited record to the FAVORITE display, press the [E]
(FAVORITE) button to turn on the FAVORITE.
5 Enter the edits you’ve made to the record as described below.
Creating a new record
Press the [J] (NEW RECORD) button. The record is added to the ALL display. If
you’ve entered the record to the FAVORITE display in step 4 above, the record is
added to both the ALL display and the FAVORITE display.
Overwriting an existing record
Press the [8
π
] (OK) button. If you set the record as a Favorite in step 4 above,
the record is added to the FAVORITE display. When you edit the record in the
FAVORITE display, the record is overwritten.
Saving the Record
The Music Finder feature handles all the Records including the presets and addi-
tionally created records as a single file. Keep in mind that individual records (panel
setups) cannot be handled as separate files.
1 Call up the Save display.
[MUSIC FINDER]TAB[
][
®
]ALL[7
π†
] (FILES)
2 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the location for saving (USER/
USB).
3 Press the [6
] button to save the file (page 69).
All records are saved together as a single file.
Keep in mind that the Beat set-
ting made here is only for the
Music Finder search function;
this does not affect the actual
Beat setting of the Style itself.
The maximum number of
records is 2500, including inter-
nal records.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Convenient Music Finder feature
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
116
CAUTION
Selecting "REPLACE" auto-
matically deletes all your
original records from inter-
nal memory.
Make sure that all impor-
tant data has been archived
to another location before-
hand.
•Make sure that all impor-
tant data has been archived
to another location before-
hand, when the file to
delete all records of the
Music Finder is down-
loaded from the web
(page 117) and executed.
Restoring the Music Finder
Data
You can restore the instrument’s
Music Finder to its original fac-
tory resettings (page 74).
Calling up Music Finder Records Saved to USER/USB
To call up the Music Finder records you’ve saved to USER/USB, follow the
instructions below.
1 Call up the [MUSIC FINDER] display.
[MUSIC FINDER] TAB [
][
®
] ALL
2 Press the [7
ππ
ππ
] (FILES) button to open the File selection display of
the Music Finder.
3 Use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select USER/USB.
4 Press the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Music Finder file.
The message is displayed according to the content of the file when the file
is chosen, and the desired button is pressed.
REPLACE
All Music Finder records currently in the instrument are deleted and
replaced with the records of the selected file.
APPEND
The records called up are added.
Execute the operation to call up the Music Finder file. Select “CANCEL
to abort this operation.
2
3
4
4
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
117
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
You can create your own Styles—recording them by yourself or by combining the
internal Style data. The created Styles can be edited.
Style Structure
Styles are made up of fifteen different sections and each section has eight separate
channels. With the Style Creator feature, you can create a Style by separately
recording the channels, or by importing pattern data from other existing Styles.
The available contents of the ser-
vice described at left are subject
to change.
Viewing information about Music Finder records
Information on the record about which you like in Music Finder is called,
and the song of the model is downloaded, or it is possible to add it to
musical instruments by downloading the Music Finder record which you
like. For more details about this service, refer to the following website.
http://music.yamaha.com/idc
1 Make sure that you’re connected to the Internet (page 179), press
the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons in the display to select the record
for which you want to view information on the Web.
You can also use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to make a selection. After using
the dial to make a selection, press [ENTER].
3 Press the [J] (MUSIC FINDER +) button to open the Web page.
4 Press the [EXIT] button to exit the browser screen and return to the
MUSIC FINDER display.
4
3
Style
Section
Four different
Fill-ins are
available.
Channel
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
118
Creating a Style
You can use one of the three different methods described below to create a Style.
The created Styles can also be edited (page 123).
Realtime Recording See below
This method lets you record the Style by simply playing the instrument. You can
select an internal Style that most closely matches your image of the Style you want
to create and then re-record parts of the Style as desired, or you can create a new
Style from scratch.
Step Recording See page 121
This method is like writing music notation on paper, since it allows you to enter
each note or individually, and specify its length.
This allows you to create a Style without having to play the parts on the instrument,
since you can enter each event manually.
Style Assembly See page 122
This convenient feature lets you create composite Styles by combining various pat-
terns from the internal preset Styles. For example, if you want to create your own
original 8-beat Style, you could take rhythm patterns from the “70’s 8Beat” Style,
use the bass pattern from “ 60’s Rock1” Style and import the chord patterns from
the “Cool8Beat” Style—combining the various elements to create one Style.
Realtime Recording (BASIC)
Create a single Style by recording the individual channels one-by-one, using real-
time recording.
Realtime Recording Characteristics
Loop Recording
Style playback repeats the rhythm patterns of several measures in a “loop,” and
Style recording is also done using loops. For example, if you start recording with
a two-measure main section, the two measures are repeatedly recorded. Notes
that you record will play back from the next repetition (loop), letting you record
while hearing previously recorded material.
Overdub Recording
This method records new material to a channel already containing recorded
data, without deleting the original data. In Style recording, the recorded data is
not deleted, except when using functions such as Rhythm Clear (page 120) and
Delete (page 120). For example, if you start recording with a two-measure MAIN
section, the two measures are repeated many times. Notes that you record will
play back from the next repetition, letting you overdub new material to the loop
while hearing previously recorded material.
When creating a Style based on an existing internal Style, overdub recording is
applied only to the rhythm channels. For all other channels (except rhythm),
delete the original data before recording.
Rhythm 1
Rhythm 2
Bass
Chord 1
Chord 2
Pad
Phrase 1
Phrase 2
Rhythm 1
Rhythm 2
Bass
Chord 1
Chord 2
Pad
Phrase 1
Phrase 2
Rhythm 1
Rhythm 2
Bass
Chord 1
Chord 2
Pad
Phrase 1
Phrase 2
Rhythm 1
Rhythm 2
Bass
Chord 1
Chord 2
Pad
Phrase 1
Phrase 2
60’s Rock1
70's 8Beat Cool8Beat
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
119
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
When using realtime recording based on the internal Styles:
1 Select the desired Style to serve as the basis for recording/editing
(page 45).
When creating a new Style from scratch, press the [C] (NEW STYLE) button
from the display shown in step 5 below.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU
3 Press the [B] button to call up the Style Creator display.
4 Use the TAB [
][
®
] buttons, then select the BASIC tab to call up the
RECORD display.
5 Call up the display for selecting sections, etc. by pressing the [EXIT]
button.
6 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the section (page 117) to
be recorded.
7 Use the [5
ππ
ππ
]/[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to determine the length (number of
measures) of the selected section.
Actually enter the specified length for the selected section by pressing the
[D] (EXECUTE) button.
When recording channels BASS-
PHR2 based on an internal Style,
delete the original data before
recording. Overdub recording is
not possible on channels BASS-
PHR2 (see page 118).
When the RECORD display (chan-
nel indication) at the lower part of
the STYLE CREATOR display dis-
appears, you can press the [F]
(REC CH) button to re-display it.
Muting specific channels dur-
ing recording
Turn off the desired channels by
pressing the [1
]–[8
] but-
tons.
Specifying sections from the
panel buttons
You can specify the sections to
be recorded by using the Section
buttons ([INTRO]/[MAIN]/[END-
ING], etc) on the panel. Pressing
one of the Section buttons calls
up the SECTION display. Change
the sections by using the
[6
π†
]/[7
π†
] buttons and
execute the selection by pressing
the [8
π
] button.
The INTRO 4/ENDING 4 sec-
tions cannot be specified with
the panel controls.
Overdub recording possible.
Overdub recording not possible.
Delete the data before recording.
6 7-1
7-2
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
120
8 Specify the channel to be recorded by simultaneously holding down
the [F] (REC CH) button and pressing the appropriate numbered but-
ton, [1
]–[8
].
To cancel the selection, press the appropriate numbered button [1
]–[8
]
again.
9 Call up the Voice Selection display by using the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
]
buttons
and select the desired Voice for the corresponding recording channels.
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.
10 To delete a channel, simultaneously hold down the [J] (DELETE) but-
ton and press the appropriate numbered button, [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
].
You can cancel the deletion by pressing the same numbered button again,
before releasing your finger from the [J] button.
11 Start recording by pressing the Style Control [START/STOP] button.
Playback of the specified section starts. Since the accompaniment pattern
plays back repeatedly in a loop, you can record individual sounds one by
one, listening to the previous sounds as they play. For information on
recording to channels other than the rhythm channels (RHY1, 2), refer to the
section “Rules when recording non-rhythm channels” (see below).
12 To continue recording with another channel, simultaneously hold
down the [F] (REC CH) button and press the appropriate [1
]–[8
]
button to specify the channel, then play the keyboard.
13 Stop recording by pressing the Style Control [START/STOP] button.
14 Call up the display for selecting sections, etc. by pressing the [EXIT]
button.
15 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to
save your data.
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).
Limits on the recordable
Voices
RHY1 channel:
Any except Organ Flute Voice/
S. Articulation Voice
RHY2 channel:
Only drum/SFX kits
BASS–PHR2 channels:
Any except Organ Flute Voice,
Drum/SFX kits, and S. Articula
-
tion Voice
Deleting the recorded rhythm
channel (RHY 1, 2)
To delete a specific instrument
sound, simultaneously hold
down the [E] (RHY CLEAR) but-
ton (from the display where the
recorded channels are shown)
and press the appropriate key.
CAUTION
The recorded Style will be lost
if you change to another Style
or you turn the power off
without executing the Save
operation (page 69).
8
10
9
8
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
121
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Step Recording (EDIT)
The explanation here applies when selecting the EDIT tab in step 4 of “Realtime
Recording” (page 119).
In the EDIT display, you can record notes with absolutely precise timing. This Step
Recording procedure is essentially the same as that for Song Recording (page 147),
with the exception of the points listed below:
In the Song Creator, the End Mark position can be changed freely; in the Style
Creator, it cannot be changed. This is because the length of the Style is automati-
cally fixed, depending on the selected section. For example, if you create a Style
based on a section of four measures length, the End Mark position is automati-
cally set to the end of the fourth measure, and cannot be changed in the Step
Recording display.
Any desired chord or chord pro-
gression can be used for the
INTRO and ENDING sections.
Changing the Source Chord
If you want to record the pattern
with a Source Chord other than
CM7, set the PLAY ROOT and
PLAY CHORD parameters on the
PARAMETER page (page 127)
before recording.
Rules when recording non-rhythm channels
Use only the CM7 scale tones when recording the BASS and PHRASE
channels (i.e., C, D, E, G, A, and B).
Use only the chord tones when recording the CHORD and PAD chan-
nels (i.e., C, E, G, and B).
Using the data recorded here, the auto accompaniment (Style playback) is appro-
priately converted depending on the chord changes you make during your per-
formance. The chord which forms the basis for this note conversion is called the
Source Chord, and is set by default to CM7 (as in the example illustration above).
You can change the Source Chord (its root and type) from the PARAMETER dis-
play on page 127. Keep in mind that when you change the Source Chord from
the default CM7 to another chord, the chord notes and recommended notes will
also change. For details on chord notes and recommended notes, see page 128.
CRC CRC
C = Chord notes
C, R = Recommended notes
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
122
Recording channels can be changed in the Song Creator 1–16 tab display; how-
ever, they cannot be changed in the Style Creator. Select the recording channel
in the BASIC tab display.
In the Style Creator, the channel data can be entered and System Exclusive data can
be edited (delete, copy, or move). You can switch between the two by pressing the
[F] button. However, Chord, Lyrics, and System Exclusive data cannot be entered.
Style Assembly (ASSEMBLY)
Style Assembly allows you to create a single Style by mixing the various patterns
(channels) from existing internal Styles.
1 Select the basic Style, then call up the display for Style Assembly.
The operation steps are the same as steps 1–4 in “Realtime recording”
(page 119). In step 4, select the ASSEMBLY tab.
2
Select the desired section (Intro, Main, Ending, etc.) for your new Style.
Call up the SECTION display by pressing one of the Section buttons
([INTRO]/[MAIN]/[ENDING], etc.) on the panel. Change the section as
desired by using the [6
π†
]/[7
π†
] buttons and execute the operation by
pressing the [8
π
] (OK) button.
3 Select the channel for which you wish to replace the pattern by using
the [A]–[D] and [F]–[I] buttons. Call up the Style Selection display by
pressing the same button again. Select the Style containing the pat-
tern you want to replace in the Style Selection display.
To return to the previous screen, press the [EXIT] button after selecting the Style.
4 Select the desired section of the newly imported Style (chosen in step
3 above) by using the [2
ππ
ππ
]/[3
ππ
ππ
] (SECTION) buttons.
5 Select the desired channel for the section (chosen in step 4 above) by
using the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] (CHANNEL) buttons.
6 Repeat steps 3–5 above to replace the patterns of other channels.
7 Press the [J] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display, and
save your data from the display (page 69).
You cannot select the SECTION
INTRO 4/ENDING 4 directly via
the panel operation.
CAUTION
The recorded Style will be lost
if you change to another Style
or you turn the power off
without executing the Save
operation (page 69).
Section display
Indicates the channels
that make up the section.
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
123
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Editing the Created Style
You can edit the Style you’ve created by using Realtime recording, Step recording
and/or Style Assembly.
Basic Operation for Editing Styles
1 Select a Style to be edited.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU
3 Call up the Style Creator/Edit display by pressing the [B] button.
4 Press the TAB[
][
®
] button to select a tab.
Changing the Rhythmic Feel (GROOVE) See page 124
These versatile features give you a wide variety of tools for changing the
rhythmic feel of your created Style.
Editing Data for each Channel (CHANNEL) See page 126
The editing features let you delete data as desired and apply quantize set-
tings for each channel in the Style data.
Making Style File Format Settings (PARAMETER) See page 127
For playback of your created Style, you can decide how notes will be con-
verted and sounded for the accompaniment when changing chords in the
chord section of the keyboard.
5 Edit the selected Style.
Playing the Style During Style Assembly
While you are assembling a Style, you can play back the Style and select
the method of playback. Use the [6
π†
]/[7
π†
] (PLAY TYPE) buttons in
the Style Assembly display to select the playback method.
SOLO
Mutes all but the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display. Any
channels set to ON in the RECORD display on the BASIC page are played
back simultaneously.
ON
Plays back the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display. Any chan-
nels set to something other than OFF in the RECORD display on the BASIC
page are played back simultaneously.
OFF
Mutes the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display.
Select the file to which the
data is saved.
You can also select the specified
file to which the data is to be
saved by pressing the [USB]/
[USER] buttons.
[USB]/[USER] [B] STYLE
[A]–[J]
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
124
Changing the Rhythmic Feel (GROOVE)
The explanation here applies when you select the GROOVE tab in step 4 of “Basic
Operation for Editing Styles” (page 123).
1 Press the [A]/[B] button to select the edit menu (page 125).
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the data.
For details on editable parameters, see page 125.
3 Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to actually enter the edits for each
display.
After the operation is completed, you can execute the edition and this but-
ton changes to “UNDO,” letting you restore the original data if you’re not
satisfied with the Groove or Dynamics results. The Undo function only has
one level; only the previous operation can be undone.
4 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to
save your data.
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).
1
2
3
4
CAUTION
The edited Style will be lost if
you change to another Style
or you turn the power off
without executing the Save
operation (page 69).
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
125
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
GROOVE
This lets you add swing to the music or change the “feel” of the beat by making
subtle shifts in the timing (clock) of the Style. The Groove settings are applied to all
channels of the selected Style.
DYNAMICS
This changes the velocity/volume (or accent) of certain notes in the Style playback.
The Dynamics settings are applied to each channel or all channels of the selected
Style.
ORIGINAL BEAT Specifies the beats to which Groove timing is to be applied. In other
words, if “8 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is applied to the 8th notes;
if “12 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is applied to 8th-note triplets.
BEAT CONVERTER Actually changes the timing of the beats (specified in the ORIGINAL
BEAT parameter above) to the selected value. For example, when
ORIGINAL BEAT is set to “8 Beat” and BEAT CONVERTER is set to “12,
all 8th notes in the section are shifted to 8th-note triplet timing. The
“16A” and “16B” Beat Converter which appear when ORIGINAL BEAT
is set to “12 Beat” are variations on a basic 16th-note setting.
SWING Produces a “swing” feel by shifting the timing of the back beats,
depending on the ORIGINAL BEAT parameter above. For example, if
the specified ORIGINAL BEAT value is “8 Beat,” the Swing parameter
will selectively delay the 2nd, 4th, 6th, and 8th beats of each measure
to create a swing feel. The settings “A” through “E” produce different
degrees of swing, with “A” being the most subtle and “E” being the most
pronounced.
FINE Selects a variety of Groove “templates” to be applied to the selected
section. The “PUSH” settings cause certain beats to be played early,
while “HEAVY” settings delay the timing of certain beats. The numbered
settings (2, 3, 4, 5) determine which beats are to be affected. All beats
up to the specified beat—but not including the first beat—will be
played early or delayed (for example, the 2nd and 3rd beats, if “3” is
selected). In all cases, “A” types produce minimum effect, “B” types
produce medium effect, and “C” types produce maximum effect.
CHANNEL Selects the desired channel (part) to which Dynamics is to be applied.
ACCENT TYPE Determines the type of accent applied—in other words, which notes in
the part(s) are emphasized with the Dynamics settings.
STRENGTH Determines how strongly the selected Accent Type (above) will be
applied. The higher the value, the stronger the effect.
EXPAND/COMP. Expands or compresses the range of velocity values. Values higher than
100% expand the dynamic range, while values lower than 100% com-
press it.
BOOST/CUT Boosts or cuts all velocity values in the selected section/channel. Values
above 100% boost the overall velocity, while values below 100%
reduce it.
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
126
Editing Data for Each Channel (CHANNEL)
The explanation here applies when you select the CHANNEL tab in step 4 of
“Basic Operation for Editing Styles” (page 123).
1 Press the [A]/[B] button to select the edit menu (see below).
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]/[2
ππ
ππ
] (CHANNEL) buttons to select the channel to
be edited.
The selected channel is shown at the upper left of the display.
3 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the data.
For details on editable parameters, see below.
4 Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to actually enter the edits for each
display.
After the operation is completed, you can execute the edition and this but-
ton changes to [UNDO], letting you restore the original data if you’re not
satisfied with the results of the edit. The Undo function only has one level;
only the previous operation can be undone.
5 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to
save your data.
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).
1
23
5
4
CAUTION
The edited Style will be lost if
you change to another Style
or you turn the power off
without executing the save
operation.
QUANTIZE Same as in the Song Creator (page 161), with the exception of the two
additional available parameters below.
Eighth notes with swing
Sixteenth notes with swing
VELOCITY
CHANGE
Boosts or cuts the velocity of all notes in the specified channel, accord-
ing to the percentage specified here.
BAR COPY This function allows data to be copied from one measure or group of
measures to another location within the specified channel. SOURCE
specifies the first (TOP) and last (LAST) measures in the region to be
copied. DEST specifies the first measure of the destination location, to
which the data is to be copied.
BAR CLEAR This function clears all data from the specified range of measures within
the selected channel.
REMOVE EVENT This function lets you remove specific events from the selected channel.
C
C
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
127
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Making Style File Format Settings (PARAMETER)
Special Parameter Settings Based on Style File
Format
The explanation here applies when you select the PARAMETER tab in step 4 of
“Basic Operation for Editing Styles” (page 123).
1 Press the [A]/[B] button to select the edit menu (page 128).
Editing of Style File Format data
is related only to note conver-
sion. Editing the rhythm chan-
nels has no effect.
The Style File Format (SFF) combines all of Yamaha’s auto
accompaniment (Style playback) know-how into a single
unified format. By using the Style Creator, you can take
advantage of the power of the SFF format and freely create
your own Styles.
The chart shown at left indicates the process by which the
Style is played back. (This does not apply to the rhythm
track.) These parameters can be set via the Style Creator
feature.
• Source Pattern
There are a variety of possibilities for Style playback
notes, depending on the particular root note and chord
type that are selected. The Style data is appropriately con-
verted depending on the chord changes you make during
your performance. This basic Style data that you create
with the Style Creator is referred to as the “Source Pat-
tern.
• Note Transposition
This parameter group features two parameters that deter-
mine how the notes of the Source Pattern are to be con-
verted in response to chord changes.
• Other Settings
Using the parameters of this group, you can fine-tune how
Style playback responds to the chords you play. For exam-
ple, the Note Limit parameter allows you to have the
Voices of the Style sound as realistic as possible by shift-
ing the pitch to an authentic range—ensuring that no
notes sound outside the natural range of the actual instru-
ment (e.g., very low notes of a piccolo sound).
Source Pattern
SOURCE ROOT
(Chord Root setting of a Source Pattern)
SOURCE CHORD
(Chord Type setting of a Source Pattern)
Note Transposition
NTR
(Note Transposition Rule applied to the
Chord Root change)
NTT
(Note Transposition Table applied to the
Chord Type change)
Chord change via the
chord section of the
keyboard.
Other Settings
HIGH KEY
(Upper limit of the octaves of the note
transposing caused by the Chord Root
change)
NOTE LIMIT (Note range in which the
note is sounded)
RTR
(Retrigger Rules that determine how
notes held through chord changes will be
handled)
Output
1
2
3
4
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
128
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]/[2
ππ
ππ
] (CHANNEL) buttons to select the channel to
be edited.
The selected channel is shown at the upper left of the display.
3 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the data.
For details on editable parameters, see below.
4 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to
save your data.
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).
SOURCE ROOT/CHORD
These settings determine the original key of the source pattern (i.e., the key used
when recording the pattern). The default setting of CM7 (with a Source Root of “C”
and a Source Type of “M7”), is automatically selected whenever the preset data is
deleted prior to recording a new Style, regardless of the Source Root and Chord
included in the preset data. When you change Source Root/Chord from the default
CM7 to another chord, the chord notes and recommended notes will also change,
depending on the newly selected chord type.
When the Source Root is C:
NTR (Note Transposition Rule)
This determines the relative position of the root note in the chord, when converted
from the Source Pattern in response to chord changes.
CAUTION
The edited Style will be lost if
you change to another Style
or you turn the power off
without executing the Save
operation.
Auditioning Your Style with a
Specific Chord
Normally in the Style Creator,
you can hear your original Style-
in-process with the Source Pat-
tern. However, there is a way to
hear it played by a specific chord
and root. To do this, set NTR to
“Root Fixed,” NTT to “Bypass,”
and NTT BASS to “OFF” then
change the newly displayed
“Play Root” and “Play Chord”
parameters to the desired set-
tings.
ROOT TRANS
(Root Transpose)
When the root note is transposed, the
pitch relationship between notes is
maintained. For example, the notes
C3, E3 and G3 in the key of C become
F3, A3 and C4 when they are trans-
posed to F. Use this setting for chan-
nels that contain melody lines.
ROOT FIXED The note is kept as close as possible to
the previous note range. For example,
the notes C3, E3 and G3 in the key of
C become C3, F3 and A3 when they
are transposed to F. Use this setting for
channels that contain chord parts.
CR CR
C
Cm
CR CCR
C
Cm
6
CCR
CC
Cm
7
CR
RRCCC
Cm
b5
7
CC RC
CC
7
Cm
(9)
CR CC
CC
7
Cm
(11)
CR C CR
C
CmM
7
CC RC
C
Cm
(9)
CCC
C
7
C
CC RC C
C
7
CmM
(9)
CR
CCR
Cdim
CR R RC
CCR
Cdim
7
CCC C
C
C
(9)
7
CRC
CC
C
b5
7
CRC CR
CC
C
(#11)
7
CCC
C
C sus
4
7
CRC CR
CM
CRC C CR
CM
7
CCC C CR
7
CM
(9)
CCC C RC
C
(9)
6
CRC
RCR
Caug
CRC C RC
CM
6
CRC C CR
C
7
CM
(#11)
CCC CR
CM
add9
CRC CC
C
C
(13)
7
CCC
CC
C
(b9)
7
C
C
1+8
CC
C
1+5
CCC
RCC
C
(#9)
7
CRC
RCC
C aug
7
CRC CRR
C
CM aug
7
CCCR
RCC
C
(b13)
7
CR CC
Csus
4
CCR CR
Csus
2
C = Chord notes C, R = Recommended notes
When playing a
C major chord.
When playing an F
major chord.
When playing a C
major chord.
When playing an
F major chord.
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
129
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
NTT (Note Transposition Table)
This sets the note transposition table for the source pattern.
NTT BASS ON/OFF
The channels for which this is set to ON will be played back by the bass root note,
when the on-bass chord is recognized by the instrument.
HIGH KEY
This sets the highest key (upper octave limit) of the note transposition for the chord
root change. Any notes calculated to be higher than the highest key are transposed
down to the next lowest octave. This setting is available only when the NTR param-
eter (page 128) is set to “Root Trans.
BYPASS When NTR is set to ROOT FIXED, the transposition table used does not
do any note conversion. When NTR is set to ROOT TRANS, the table
used only converts the root note.
MELODY Suitable for melody line transposition. Use this for melody channels
such as Phrase 1 and Phrase 2.
CHORD
Suitable for chord transposition. Use this for the Chord 1 and Chord 2
channels, especially when they contain piano or guitar-like chordal parts.
MELODIC MINOR When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this
table lowers the third interval in the scale by a semitone. When the
chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third interval is
raised by a semitone. Other notes are not changed. Use this for melody
channels of Sections which respond only to major/minor chords, such
as Intros and Endings.
MELODIC MINOR
5th
In addition to the Melodic Minor transposition above, augmented and
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source Pattern.
HARMONIC
MINOR
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this
table lowers the third and sixth intervals in the scale by a semitone.
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor
third and flatted sixth intervals are raised by a semitone. Other notes are
not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which respond
only to major/minor chords, such as Intros and Endings.
HARMONIC
MINOR 5th
In addition to the Harmonic Minor transposition above, augmented and
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.
NATURAL MINOR
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this table
lowers the third, sixth and seventh intervals in the scale by a semitone.
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third,
flatted sixth and flatted seventh intervals are raised by a semitone. Other
notes are not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which
respond only to a Major/minor chord such as Intros and Endings.
NATURAL MINOR
5th
In addition to the Natural Minor transposition above, augmented and
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.
DORIAN When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this
table lowers the third and seventh intervals in the scale by a semitone.
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor
third and flatted seventh intervals are raised by a semitone. Other notes
are not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which respond
only to a Major/minor chord such as Intros and Endings.
DORIAN 5th In addition to the Dorian transposition above, augmented and dimin-
ished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.
CM
C3-E3-G3
FM
F3-A3-C4
F#M
F#2-A#2-C#3
C#M
C#3-F3-G#3
Example—When the highest key is F.
Root changes
Notes played
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles
Style Creator
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
130
NOTE LIMIT
This sets the note range (highest and lowest notes) for voices recorded to the style
channels. By judicious setting of this range, you can ensure that the voices sound
as realistic as possible—in other words, that no notes outside the natural range are
sounded (e.g., high bass sounds or low piccolo sounds). The actual notes that
sound are automatically shifted to the set range.
RTR (Retrigger Rule)
These settings determine whether notes stop sounding or not and how they change
pitch in response to chord changes.
STOP The notes stop sounding.
PITCH SHIFT The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the type
of the new chord.
PITCH SHIFT TO
ROOT
The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the root
of the new chord.
RETRIGGER The note is retriggered with a new attack at a new pitch corresponding
to the next chord.
RETRIGGER TO
ROOT
The note is retriggered with a new attack at the root note of the next
chord. However, the octave of the new note remains the same.
CM
E3-G3-C4
FM
High Limit
Low Limit
F3-A3-C4
C#M
F3-G#3-C#4
Example—When the lowest note is C3 and the highest is D4.
Root changes
Notes played
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
131
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups—Registration Memory
The Registration Memory function allows you to save (or “register”) virtually all
panel settings to a Registration Memory button, and then instantly recall your cus-
tom panel settings by pressing a single button. The registered settings for eight Reg-
istration Memory buttons should be saved as a single Bank (file).
Registering and Saving Custom
Panel Setups
Registering Custom Panel Setups
1 Set up the panel controls (such as Voice, Style, effects, and so on) as
desired.
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of parameters that can be registered
with the Registration Memory function.
2 Press the REGISTRATION MEMORY [MEMORY] button. The display
for selecting the items to be registered appears.
Only the items selected here will be registered.
3 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select items.
To cancel the operation, press the [I] (CANCEL) button.
4 Enter or remove the checkmark in the box of the item to determine
whether the item should be registered or not, by pressing the
[8
ππ
ππ
] button.
5 Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] buttons to register
your settings.
It is recommended that you select a button whose lamp is not lit in red or
green. Buttons that are lit in red or green, already contain the panel setup
data. Any panel setup previously registered to the selected REGISTRATION
MEMORY button (lamp lights in green or red) will be erased and replaced
by the new settings.
6 Register various panel setups to other buttons by repeating steps #1–
#5.
2
43
5
When recalling registration set-
ups, you can also select the
items to be recalled or not, even
if you selected all items when
registering (page 133).
About the lamp status:
Off.............. no data registered
On (green)...data registered, but
not currently selected
On (red)......data registered, and
currently selected
Deleting an unneeded panel
setup
See page 133.
Deleting all eight current
panel setups
To delete all the eight current
panel setups, turn the [POWER]
button ON while holding the B6
key (right-most B key on the key-
board).
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
132
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
Saving the Registered Panel Setups
You can save all the eight registered panel setups as a single Registration Memory
Bank file.
1 Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.
2 Press the [6
] button to save the Bank file (page 69).
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups
1 Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a bank.
3 Press one of the green-lit numbered buttons ([1]–[8]) in the Registra-
tion Memory section.
Bank 1
Bank 2
Bank 3
Bank 4
R
eg
i
strat
i
on
M
emory
d
ata
compatibility
In general, Registration Memory
data (Bank files) is compatible
among the models CVP-409/
407/405/403/401. However, the
data may not be perfectly com-
patible, depending on the speci-
fications of each model.
1
2
Ab
out reca
lli
ng setups
f
rom a
USB storage device
When recalling the setups includ-
ing Song/Style file selection from
a USB storage device, make sure
that the appropriate USB storage
device including the registered
Song/Style is connected into the
[USB TO DEVICE] Terminal.
22
3
Parameter Lock
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.) to make them
selectable only via the panel controls—in other words, instead of via Registration
Memory, One Touch Setting, Music Finder, Song or incoming MIDI data, etc.
Call up the Parameter Lock display ([FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
]
CONFIG 1 [B] 3 PARAMETER LOCK). Select the desired parameter by
using the [1
π†
]–[7
π†
] buttons, then lock it with the [8
π
] button.
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
133
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
Deleting an Unneeded Panel Setup/Naming a
Panel Setup
The panel setups can be deleted or named individually as desired.
1 Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a bank to be edited.
3 Press the [8
] (EDIT) button to call up the REGISTRATION EDIT Dis-
play.
4 Edit the panel setups.
Deleting a panel setup
Press the [5
] button to delete a panel setup (page 71).
Renaming a panel setup
Press the [1
] button to rename a panel setup (page 72).
5 Press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (UP) button to return to the REGISTRATION BANK
Selection display.
Disabling Recall of Specific Items (Freeze Func-
tion)
Registration Memory lets you recall all the panel setups you made with a single
button press. However, there may be times that you want certain items to remain
the same, even when switching Registration Memory setups. For example, you may
want to switch Voices or effect settings while keeping the same accompaniment
Style. This is where the Freeze function comes in handy. It lets you maintain the set-
tings of certain items and leave them unchanged, even when selecting other Regis-
tration Memory buttons.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET
TAB [
][
®
] FREEZE
The number above
the file name corre-
sponds to the
REGISTRATION
MEMORY [1]–[8]
buttons.
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
134
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
2 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select items.
3 Enter checkmarks for the items to be “Frozen” (i.e., to remain
unchanged), by pressing the [8
ππ
ππ
] button.
4 Press the [FREEZE] button on the panel to turn the Freeze function
on.
5 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the operation display.
Calling Up Registration Memory Numbers in
Order—Registration Sequence
As convenient as the Registration Memory buttons are, there may be times during a
performance when you want to quickly switch between settings—without having
to take your hands from the keyboard. The convenient Registration Sequence func-
tion lets you call up the eight setups in any order you specify, by simply using the
TAB [
][
®
] buttons or the pedal as you play.
1 Select the desired Registration Memory bank to program a sequence
(page 132).
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET
TAB [
][
®
] REGISTRATION SEQUENCE
3 If you intend to use a pedal to switch Registration Memory settings,
specify here how the pedal will be used—to advance or to reverse
through the sequence.
Use the [C] button to select the pedal for advancing through the sequence.
Use the [D] button to select the pedal for reversing through the sequence.
4 Use the [E] button to determine how Registration Sequence behaves
when reaching the end of the sequence (SEQUENCE END).
STOP .....................Pressing the TAB [
®
] button or the “advance” pedal has
no effect. The sequence is “stopped.
TOP .......................The sequence starts again at the beginning.
NEXT BANK...........The sequence automatically moves to the beginning of
the next Registration Memory Bank in the same folder.
5 Program the Sequence order.
The numbers shown at the lower part of the display correspond to the REG-
ISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] buttons on the panel.
Program the Sequence order from left to right.
CAUTION
Settings in the REGISTRATION
FREEZE display are automati-
cally saved to the instrument
when you exit from this dis-
play. However, if you turn the
power off without exiting
from this display, the settings
will be lost.
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
135
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups
Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] button on the
panel, then press the [6
ππ
ππ
] (INSERT) button to input the number.
Replacing the number
Press the [5
π†
] (REPLACE) button to replace the number at the cursor
position with the currently selected Registration Memory number.
Deleting the number
Press the [7
π†
] (DELETE) button to delete the number at the cursor
position.
Deleting all numbers
Press the [8
π†
] (CLEAR) button to delete all numbers in the sequence.
6 Press the [F] button to turn the Registration Sequence function on.
7 Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [EXIT] button to
return to the Main display and confirm whether the Registration
Memory numbers are called up according to the sequence pro-
grammed above.
Use the TAB [
®
] button to call up the Registration Memory numbers in the
order of the sequence, or use the TAB [
] button to call them up in
reverse order. The TAB [
] [
®
] buttons can only be used for Registration
Sequence when the Main display is called up.
When pedal operation has been set in step 3, you can use a pedal to select
the Registration Memory numbers in order. The pedal can be used for Reg-
istration Sequence no matter which display is called up (except for the dis-
play in step 3 above).
Saving the Registration Sequence Settings
The settings for the Sequence order and how Registration Sequence behaves when
reaching the end of the sequence (SEQUENCE END) are included as part of the
Registration Memory Bank file. To store your newly programmed Registration
Sequence, save the current Registration Memory Bank file.
1 Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection display.
2 Press the [6
] button to save the Bank file (page 69).
CAUTION
Settings in the REGISTRATION
SEQUENCE display are auto-
matically saved to the instru-
ment when you exit from this
display. However, if you turn
the power off without exiting
from this display, the settings
will be lost.
Returning to the first
Sequence in one action
In the Main display, press the
TAB [
] and [
®
] buttons simul-
taneously. This cancels the cur-
rently selected Sequence
number (the box indicator at the
top right goes out). The first
Sequence will be selected by
pressing one of the TAB [
][
®
]
buttons or by pressing the pedal.
The Registration Sequence is indicated at the top right of
the Main display, letting you confirm the currently selected
number.
CAUTION
Keep in mind that all Registra-
tion Sequence data is lost
when changing Registration
Memory Banks, unless you’ve
saved it with the Registration
Memory Bank file.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
136
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Compatible Song Types
The instrument can play back the following Song types.
Preset Songs
Songs in the Song Selection PRESET display.
Your Own Recorded Songs
These are Songs which you’ve recorded (page 42, page 143) and saved to the
USER/USB display. (USB is available when you connect an USB storage device
such as USB flash memory/floppy disk to the instrument.)
Commercially Available Song Data
Song data downloaded from the Yamaha Web site and commercially available Disk
Songs are available when you connect the optional floppy disk drive to the instru-
ment. The instrument is compatible with the Song disks (floppy disks) that bear the
following marks:
Reference to Quick Guide Pages
Practicing with the Preset Songs .................................................. page 35
Playing Back Songs Before Practicing ..................................... page 35
Displaying Music Notation (Score) ......................................... page 38
One-handed Practice with the Guide Lamps ........................... page 39
Practicing with the Repeat Playback Function ......................... page 41
Recording Your Performance.................................................... page 42
Singing Along with Song playback (Karaoke) or Your Own
Performance ............................................................................page 54
Connecting a Microphone...................................................... page 54
Singing with the Lyrics Display ................................................ page 55
Displaying Text ....................................................................... page 55
Convenient Functions for Karaoke ........................................... page 56
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your
Own Performance ................................................................... page 58
Recording Your Performance as Audio ..................................... page 60
Before using a USB storage
device, be sure to read “Han-
dling the USB Storage Device
(USB Flash Memory/Floppy
Disk, etc)” on page 22.
Before using a floppy disk and
the disk slot, be sure to read
“Handling the Floppy Disk Drive
(FDD) and Floppy Disks” on
page 21.
Commercially available music
data is subject to protection by
copyright laws. Copying com-
mercially available data is strictly
prohibited, except for your own
personal use.
See page 199 for information on
the types of Song data that can
be played on the instrument.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Operations for Song Playback
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
137
Operations for Song Playback
This section explains detailed operations and functions related to Song playback
which are not covered in the “Quick Guide.
Starting/Stopping a Song
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start Song playback, and press the SONG
[STOP] button to stop. In addition, there are several other convenient ways to start/
stop a Song.
Starting Playback
Synchro Start
You can start playback as soon as you start playing the keyboard.
When playback is stopped, simultaneously hold down the SONG [STOP] button
and press the [PLAY/PAUSE] button.
To cancel the Synchro Start function, simultaneously hold down the SONG [STOP]
button and press the [PLAY/PAUSE] button once again.
•Tap function
This useful function lets you press the [TAP TEMPO] button to tap out the tempo
and automatically start the Song at that tapped speed. Simply tap (press/release)
the button (four times for a 4/4 time signature) while the instrument is in Synchro
Start standby mode, and the Song playback starts automatically at the tempo you
tapped.
Fade In
The Fade In function can be used to produce smooth fade-ins when starting the
Song. To produce fade-ins, press the foot pedal which is assigned to Fade In/Out
while playback is stopped and then press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start
playback. For information on the settings, see page 191.
Stopping Playback
Fade Out
The Fade Out function can be used to produce smooth fade-outs when stopping
the Song playback. Press the foot pedal which is assigned to Fade In/Out at the
beginning of the phrase you want to fade out. For information on the settings, see
page 191.
Depending on the particular
Song data, the Style will also
play back at the same time.
Set the Fade In/Out time
The times of the fade-in and fade-out can be set independently. For details,
refer to page 109.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Operations for Song Playback
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
138
Top/Pause/Rewind/Fast Forward
Moving to the top position of the Song
Press the SONG [STOP] button, regardless of whether the Song is stopped or play-
ing back.
Pausing the Song
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button during Song playback. Press the SONG
[PLAY/PAUSE] button again and the Song will resume from the current position.
Moving back and forth (rewind and fast forward)
1 Press the SONG [REW] or SONG [FF] button to move back and forth
(rewind and fast forward).
It calls up a pop-up window showing the current measure number in the
Main display.
For Songs containing Phrase Marks, you can use the [FF] or [REW] buttons
to navigate through the Phrase Marks in the Song. If you don’t want to set the
Song position by the phrase marks, press the [E] button and select “BAR” in
the window showing the Song position.
2 Press the [EXIT] button to close the pop-up window showing the cur-
rent measure number (or Phrase Mark number).
Repeat Playback/Chain Playback
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING
2 Set the parameters related to the Repeat Playback by using the [H]/[I]
buttons. The available parameters are shown below.
Phrase Mark:
Phrase Mark is a pre-pro-
grammed marker in certain Song
data, which specifies a certain
location (set of measures) in the
Song.
The preset Songs in the “Follow
Lights” folder contain the Guide
settings. These Songs are inap-
propriate for use with ALL or
RANDOM repeat.
REPEAT MODE OFF
Plays through the selected Song, then stops.
SINGLE
Plays through the selected Song repeatedly.
ALL
Continues playback through all the Songs in the folder
containing the current Song repeatedly.
RANDOM
Randomly and repeatedly plays back all Songs in the
folder containing the current Song.
PHRASE MARK REPEAT For Songs containing Phrase Marks, you can set Repeat
Playback to “ON” or “OFF.When this is on, the part corre-
sponding to the specified Phrase Mark number is repeatedly
played back. The steps for specifying the Phrase Mark num-
ber are the same as in the steps 1–2 of the section “Moving
back and forth (rewind and fast forward)” (see above).
For Songs not containing
Phrase Marks
For Songs containing
Phrase Mark
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Operations for Song Playback
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
139
Queuing the Next Playback Song
While a Song is playing back, you can queue up the next Song for playback. This is
convenient for chaining it to the next Song smoothly during stage performance.
Select the Song you want play next in the Song Selection display, while a Song is
playing back.
The “NEXT” indication appears at the upper right of the corresponding Song name.
To cancel this setting, press the [8
] (Cancel) button.
Using the Auto Accompaniment Features with the
Song Playback
When playing back a Song and a Style at the same time, channels 9–16 in the Song
data are replaced with style channels—allowing you to play the accompaniment
parts of the Song yourself. Try playing chords along with the Song playback as
shown in the instructions below. When playing back a Song and a Style at the same
time, we recommend that you use the Preset Songs in the “Sing-a-long” folder.
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Select a Style (page 45).
3 Press the STYLE CONTROL [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on the
Auto Accompaniment function.
4 Press the STYLE CONTROL [SYNC START] button to enable standby—
letting you simultaneously start the accompaniment as soon as you
start playing.
5 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.
6 Play chords along with the Song.
The chord name is indicated in the Main display. To return to the Main dis-
play, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [EXIT] button.
When the Song playback is stopped, the style playback is also stopped at the same
time.
•Tempo for playing back a Song and a style at the same time
When playing back a Song and a Style at the same time, the tempo value set in
the Song is automatically used.
Parameter Lock
You can “lock” specific parame-
ters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.)
to make them selectable only via
the panel controls (page 132).
If the Song data does not contain
this data, the current chord name
will not be displayed in the Main
display during Song playback.
Playing Songs with the Quick Start function
With the default settings, the Quick Start function is turned on. On some
commercially available Song data, certain settings related to the Song
(such as voice selection, volume, etc.) are recorded to the first measure,
before the actual note data. When Quick Start is set to “ON,” the instru-
ment reads all initial non-note data of the Song at the highest possible
speed, then automatically slows down to the appropriate tempo at the first
note. This allows you to start playback as quickly as possible, with a mini-
mum pause for reading of data. When Quick Start is set to “ON,” a Song is
played back directly from the first note (which may be in the middle of a
measure). If you want to play from the beginning of the measure that has
silence prior to the first note, turn Quick Start “OFF.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING
2 Press the [7
] (QUICK START) button to turn the Quick Start
“OFF.”
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Adjusting the Volume Balance and Voice Combination, etc. (MIXING CONSOLE)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
140
Adjusting the Volume Balance and
Voice Combination, etc. (MIXING
CONSOLE)
You can set the mixing-related parameters of a Song. Refer to the section “Adjust-
able items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE display” on page 90. Call up the
“SONG CH 1–8” or “SONG CH 9–16” display in step 3 of the Basic Procedure in
“Editing the Volume Balance and Voice Combination (MIXING CONSOLE)” on
page 88. Below are two operation examples.
Adjusting the Volume Balance of Each Channel
1 Select a Song (page 35).
2 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CON-
SOLE display.
3 Select the [VOL VOICE] tab by pressing the TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
4 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button repeatedly to call up the display
of “SONG CH 1–8” or “SONG CH 9–16.”
5 Press the [J] button to select the “VOLUME.”
6 Adjust the volume balance of each channel by using the [1
ππ
ππ
]–
[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
7 You can save the volume settings to the Song in the Setup operation
of the SETUP (page 162).
Make sure to checkmark the “VOLUME” item in step 2 of the Setup proce-
dure.
Reading Song data automatically when connecting a USB stor-
age device
You can have the instrument automatically call up the first Song (not con-
tained in a folder) on a USB storage device, as soon as the device is con-
nected in the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] MEDIA
2 Press the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
] (SONG AUTO OPEN) button to select “ON”.
About the [SONG CH 1–8]/
[SONG CH 9–16] displays
A Song consists of 16 separate
channels. Separate settings can
be made for each of the 16 chan-
nels in the MIXING CONSOLE
display. Adjust the parameters in
the SONG CH 1–8 or SONG CH
9–16 display respectively. Usu-
ally, CH 1 is assigned to the
[TRACK 1] button, CH 2 is
assigned to the [TRACK 2] but-
ton, and CH 3–16 are assigned
to the [EXTRA TRACKS] button,
respectively.
Press the [C]/[H] (VOICE) but-
tons in step 5 to select the Voice
which you want to change. Then,
press one of the [1
π†
] to [8
π†
] buttons to call up the
Voice selection display for the
channel.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Using the Practice Function (Guide)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
141
Changing Voices
1–4 The operation steps are the same as in the “Adjusting the Volume
Balance of Each Channel” (see page 140).
5 Press the [H] button to select the “VOICE”.
6 Press one of the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to call up the Voice selec-
tion display for the channel.
7 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.
8 You can save the changed Voice selection to the Song in the Setup
operation (page 162).
Make sure to checkmark the “VOICE” item in step 2 of the Setup procedure.
Using the Practice Function (Guide)
The keyboard guide lamps indicate the notes (location and timing) for you to play.
Also, when you sing along with a Song playback using a connected microphone,
the instrument automatically adjusts the timing of the Song playback to match your
vocal performance.
To use the practice function, press the [GUIDE] button.
Selecting the Guide Function Type
1 Call up the setting display:
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING
2 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the desired Guide function type. The
following types are available.
Saving the Guide settings in
the SONG SETTING display
You can save the Guide settings
as a part of the Song data
(page 162). For Songs to which
Guide settings have been saved,
the Guide function will be auto-
matically turned on and the
related settings will be recalled
when the Song is selected.
Turning the keyboard guide
lamps off
Press the [C] (GUIDE LAMP) but-
ton in the SONG SETTING dis-
play (in step 1 as described at
left) to turn the keyboard guide
lamps off.
2
1
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Using the Practice Function (Guide)
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
142
For Keyboard Performance
Follow lights
With this function, the keyboard guide lamps indicate which notes you should play
(page 39). Song playback pauses and waits for you to play. When you play the cor-
rect notes, Song playback continues.
Any key
With this function, you can play the melody of a Song just by pressing a single key
(any key is OK) in time with the rhythm. Song playback pauses and waits for you to
play any key. Simply play a key on the keyboard in time with music (any key is OK)
and the Song playback continues.
For Karaoke
Karao-key
This function lets you control the Song playback timing with just one finger, while
you sing along.
Song playback pauses, waiting for you to sing. Simply play a key on the keyboard
(any key is OK) and the Song playback continues. (For this function, the notes of
the keyboard do not sound.)
Vocal CueTIME
This function lets you practice singing with the proper pitch.
Song playback pauses, waiting for you to sing. When you sing with proper pitch,
Song playback continues.
Determining the timing by which the keyboard guide lamps
light (GUIDE LAMP TIMING)
Press the [D] button in the SONG SETTING display in step 1 (page 141) to
select the timing by which the keyboard guide lamps light.
JUST........................... The guide lamps light in time with the music, at the
same timing you should play.
NEXT ......................... The guide lamps light slightly ahead of the music,
indicating the notes you should play next. The
guide lamps flash if you fail to play the keys with
the correct timing.
If the guide lamps do not light as intended
The guide lamps light according to Song channels recorded to Track 1 and
2 and the chord data in the Song (when such data is included).
If the guide lamps do not light as intended, you may need to assign the
appropriate right- and left-hand channels to Track 1 and 2 respectively, by
using the [1
π†
]/[2
π†
] buttons in the SONG SETTING display as
described in step 1 on the previous page.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
143
Recording Your Performance
You can record your own performances and save them to the User tab display or a
USB storage device. Several different recording methods are available:
Quick Recording which lets you record performance conveniently and quickly,
Multi track Recording which lets you record several different parts to multiple
channels, and Step Recording which lets you enter notes one by one. You can also
edit the Songs you’ve recorded.
For details on MIDI Recording, see page 196.
For details on USB Audio Recording, see page 60.
Recording Methods
There are three methods as shown below.
You can also edit Songs after they’ve been recorded (page 158).
For example, you can edit specific notes one by one, or you can use the Punch In/
Out function to re-record a specific part.
Turning playback channels of the Song on and off
A Song consists of 16 separate channels. You can independently turn each
channel of the selected Song playback on or off. Usually, CH 1 is assigned to
[TRACK 1] button, CH 2 is assigned to [TRACK 2] button, and CH 3–16 are
assigned to the [EXTRA TRACKS] button.
1 Press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the Song CHANNEL
ON/OFF display.
If the display shown below does not appear, press the [CHANNEL ON/
OFF] button again.
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to turn each channel on or off.
If you want to play back only one particular channel (muting all other chan-
nels), press and hold down one of the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons corresponding
to the desired channel. To cancel solo playback, press the same button again.
The microphone input signal can
not be recorded.
Internal memory (User tab
displays) capacity
The internal memory capacity of
the instrument is about 3.2MB.
This capacity applies to all file
types, including Voice, Style,
Song, and Registration data files.
Quick Recording
page 144
This convenient and simple recording method lets you quickly
record your performance—useful, for example, in recording solo
piano pieces. You can record to the [TRACK 1 (R)] or [TRACK 2
(L)] button, and also to the [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] track,
which can be used for recording at the same time.
Multi track Recording
page 145
This lets you record a whole Song including several different
instrument parts, to create the sound of a full band or orchestra.
Record the performance of each instrument part one by one
and create fully orchestrated compositions. You can also record
over already-recorded parts of an existing Song (Preset Song or
a Song on USB storage device) with your own performance.
Step Recording
page 147
This method lets you compose your performance by “writing”
it down one event at a time. This is a non-realtime, manual
recording method – similar to writing music notation onto
paper. You can input notes, chords and other events one by
one (realtime performance is not needed).
R
ea
l
t
i
me
R
ecor
di
ng
S
tep
R
ecor
di
ng
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
144
Quick Recording
This lets you conveniently and quickly record your performance.
1 Press the SONG [REC] and SONG [STOP] buttons simultaneously.
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up for recording.
2 Make the desired panel settings for your keyboard performance.
Below are some example settings you may want to try.
Recording the RIGHT 1 part
Select the voice for the RIGHT 1 part by calling up the Voice selection dis-
play (page 32).
Recording the Dual voice (RIGHT 1 and 2 parts)
Turn on the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button (page 80). Select the
voice for each keyboard part (RIGHT 1, 2) by calling up the Voice selec-
tion display (page 32).
Recording the LEFT part
Turn on the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button (page 81). Select the
voice for the LEFT part by calling up the Voice selection display (page 32).
Recording Styles
1 Select a Style (page 45).
2 Set the tempo for recording by pressing the TEMPO [–] [+] buttons, as
necessary.
Using Registration Memory panel setups
Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1–8] buttons.
3 While holding the SONG [REC] button, press the SONG TRACK but-
tons to be recorded.
Recording your performance
Press the SONG [TRACK 1 (R)] button for the right-hand part recording,
and/or the SONG [TRACK 2 (L)] button for the left-hand part recording.
Recording Styles
Press the SONG [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button.
Recording your performance and the Style playback simultaneously
Press the SONG [TRACK 1 (R)]/[TRACK 2 (L)] buttons and the
SONG[EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button.
The RIGHT and/or LEFT parts are
recorded onto separate tracks.
With Multi Track Recording, you
can record RIGHT 2 part individ-
ually.
+
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
145
4 Start recording.
There are several different ways you can start recording.
Starting by playing the keyboard
If you’ve selected the SONG [TRACK 1(R)]/[TRACK 2 (L)] buttons in step 3
above, play in the right-hand section of the keyboard (page 79). If you’ve
selected the SONG [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLES)] button in step 3 above,
play in the left-hand (chord) section of the keyboard (page 111). Record-
ing begins automatically as soon as you play a note on the keyboard.
Starting by pressing the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button
If you start recording in this way, “empty” data is recorded until you play a
note on the keyboard. This is useful for starting a Song with a short one-or
two-beat pick-up or lead-in.
Starting by pressing the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.
In this case the rhythm parts (channels) of the Style begin playing back and
recording starts simultaneously.
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.
When recording is finished, a message prompting you to save the recorded
performance data appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT] button.
See step 7 for instructions on saving your recording.
6 Listen to your newly recorded performance. Press the SONG [PLAY/
PAUSE] button to play back the performance you just recorded.
7 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display
for saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
Multi Track Recording
A Song consists of 16 separate channels. With this method, you can record data to
each channel independently, one by one. Both Keyboard and Style parts can be
recorded.
1 Press the SONG[REC] and
SONG[STOP] buttons simultaneously.
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up
for recording.
Select Voices for recording the keyboard
parts (RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2, and/or LEFT)
(page 32, page 80, page 81). Select a Style
for recording also, as necessary (page 45).
Using the metronome
You can record your perfor-
mance while playing back the
metronome (page 30). But the
metronome sound is not
recorded.
Pausing and restarting your
recording
To pause recording, press the
SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button
during recording. To restart
recording, follow the operations
shown below.
•For recording to [TRACK 1]/
[TRACK 2] recording, press the
SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.
•For recording to [EXTRA
TRACKS (STYLES)] recording,
press the STYLE CONTROL
[SYNC START] button, then
play in the chord section of the
keyboard.
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
About Channels
See page 147.
Recording the keyboard RIGHT 2
part to the channel 2
Turn the PART ON/OFF [DUAL
(RIGHT2)] button on. Then, call up
Voice Selection display, and select a
voice for the RIGHT 2 part (page 80).
Example
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
146
2 While holding the SONG [REC] button,
press the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to
set the desired channels to “REC”.
Normally, the keyboard parts should be
recorded to channels 1–8, and the Styles
should be recorded to channels 9–16. To
cancel the channel selection, press the
SONG [REC] button again.
3 Use the [C]/[D] buttons to select the
desired part for the channel to be
recorded.
This determines which part—keyboard or
Style (Rhythm 1/2, Bass, etc.)—is recorded
to each of the channels selected in step 2.
Default channel/part assignments are
shown in the section “About Song chan-
nels” (page 147).
To close PART selection display, press the
[EXIT] button.
4 Start recording.
The method for starting is the same as in step 4 of Quick Recording (page 145).
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.
When recording is finished, a message appears prompting you to save the
recorded performance appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT] but-
ton. For instructions on saving Song data, see step 8.
6 Listen to your newly recorded performance. Press the SONG [PLAY/
PAUSE] button to playback the performance you just recorded.
7 To record another channel, repeat steps 2 through 6.
Sett
i
ng a
ll
o
f
t
h
e 9–16 c
h
an-
nels to “REC” simultaneously
While holding the SONG [REC]
button, press the SONG [EXTRA
TRACKS (STYLE)] button.
When selecting the MIDI part
• Setting a single channel to
MIDI
All incoming data received via
any of the MIDI channels 1–16
is recorded. When using an
external MIDI keyboard or
controller to record, this lets
you record without having to
set the MIDI transmit channel
on the external device.
• Setting several channels to
MIDI
When using an external MIDI
keyboard or controller to
record, this records data only
over the set MIDI channel—
meaning the external device
must also be set to the same
channel.
Recording each channel with
the same tempo
Use the Metronome function
(page 30) to record each channel
with the same tempo. Keep in
mind that the metronome sound
is not recorded.
Pausing and restarting your
recording
See page 145.
While holding the SONG [REC] but-
ton, press the [2
π
] button to set the
channel 2 to “REC”.
2
3
+
Press the [D] button to select
the “RIGHT2”.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
147
8 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display
for saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
Step Recording
This method lets you record regular music data such as melodies and chords.
Basic Operations for Step Recording
1 Press the SONG[REC] and SONG[STOP] buttons simultaneously.
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up for recording.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
About Song channels
Default channel/part assignments are shown below.
About keyboard parts
There are three keyboard parts, RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2 and LEFT. As the
default, the RIGHT 1 part is assigned to each of the channels 1–8. Nor-
mally, the keyboard parts should be recorded to the channels 1–8.
About Style parts
As the default, each of the Style parts is assigned to the channels 9–16,
respectively as shown below. Normally, the Style parts should be recorded
to the channels 9–16.
RHYTHM ......... This is the basic part of the Style, containing the drum and
percussion rhythm patterns. Usually one of the drum kits
is used.
BASS ................ The bass part uses various appropriate instrument sounds
to match the style.
CHORD ........... This is the rhythmic chord backing, commonly used with
piano or guitar Voices.
PAD ................. This part is used for sustained instruments such as strings,
organ, choir, etc.
PHRASE ........... This part is used for punchy brass stabs, arpeggiated
chords, and other extras that make the accompaniment
more interesting.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RIGHT1
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
RHYTHM1
RHYTHM2
BASS
CHORD1
CHORD2
PAD
PHRASE1
PHRASE2
Channels ChannelsDefault Parts Keyboard parts
Keyboard Parts
Style parts
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
148
3 Press the [A] button to call up the Song Creator display for recording/
editing a Song.
4 Select the appropriate tab by using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons.
For recording melodies .............. Select the [1–16] tab.
For recording chords .................. Select the [CHORD] tab.
5 If you select the “1–16” tab in step 4, press the [F] button to select the
channel for recording.
6 Press the [G] button to call up the STEP RECORD display.
7 Start Step Recording.
For recording melodies .............. See page 149.
For recording chords .................. See page 156.
3
6
5
4
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
149
Recording Melodies
This section explains how to step-record notes, using three music score examples.
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the section “Basic Operations for Step
Recording” on page 148.
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.
1 Press the [G] button to select “
.”
2 Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”
3 Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.
4 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] button to select the quarter-note length.
5 Play the keys C3, D3, E3, F3, G3, and A3 in order, according to the
notation example.
Since the music score displayed
on the instrument is generated
from the recorded MIDI data, it
may not appear exactly the same
as shown below.
About the items which can be
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-
tons
See page 151.
Example 1
1
2
6 7
3–5
* The numbers shown in the notation correspond to the following opera-
tion step numbers.
4
1
2
3
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
150
6 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] button to enter a quarter-note rest.
To enter the rest, use the [4
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons. (Press the button once to
select the rest value, and once again to actually enter it.) A rest having spec-
ified note length will be entered.
7 Play the C4 key.
8 Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning
of the Song.
9 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered
notes.
10 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner
(page 158).
11 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
89
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
Move the cursor to the begin-
ning of the Song.
Press the SONG [STOP] button
during recording.
Deleting data
Mistakenly entered notes can be deleted.
1 Use the [A]/[B] buttons in the STEP RECORD display (page 148) to
select the data you want to delete.
2 Press the [J] (DELETE) button to delete the selected data.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
151
About velocity
Velocity is determined by how
strongly you play the keyboard.
The more strongly you play the
keyboard, the higher the velocity
value and the louder the sound.
The velocity value can be speci-
fied within a range from 1 to
127. The higher the velocity
value, the louder the sound
becomes.
About items which can be selected via the [G] [H] [I] buttons
in the Step Record display
[G] button ........... Determines the velocity (loudness) of the note to
be entered.
[H] button ........... Determines the gate time (note length) of the note to
be entered.
[I] button ............. Determines the note type to be entered. Pressing the
button alternately switches the note selectors (at the
bottom of the display) among three basic note values:
normal, dotted and triplet.
Kbd.Vel
fff
ff
f
mf
mp
p
pp
ppp
127
111
95
79
63
47
31
15
Items Velocity to be recorded
Actual velocity you play the keyboard with
Normal
Tenuto
Staccato
Staccatissimo
Manual
80%
99%
40%
20%
Items Gate time to be recorded
The gate time (note length) can be set to any
desired percentage by using the [DATA
ENTRY] dial.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
152
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”
on page 148.
In this example, keep in mind that one of the steps involves holding down a key on
the keyboard while executing the operation.
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.
1 Press the [G] button to select “
.”
2 Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”
3 Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.
4 Press the [5
ππ
ππ
] button to select the half-note length.
5 While holding F3 on the keyboard, press the [7
ππ
ππ
] button.
Before you go on to step 6, release the F3 key and the [7
ππ
ππ
] button.
6 Press the [H] button to select the “Staccato”.
7 Press the [7
ππ
ππ
] button to select the eighth-note length.
Example 2
1
2–5 10–13 14–16
6–8
9
* The numbers shown in the sheet correspond to the following operation
step numbers.
A
b
out t
h
e
i
tems w
hi
c
h
can
b
e
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-
tons
See page 151.
4
1
2
3
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
153
8 Play the keys E3, F3, and A3 in order, according to the notation exam-
ple.
9 Press the [G] button to select “
.”
10 Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”
11 Press the [I] button to select “dotted.”
12 Press the [5
ππ
ππ
] button to select the dotted half-note length.
13 Play the A3 key on the keyboard, as specified in the example.
14 Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.
15 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] button to select the quarter-note length.
16 Play the F3 key on the keyboard, as specified in the example.
17 Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning
of the Song.
18 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered
notes.
19 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.
You can also edit the Songs you’ve recorded as necessary (page 158).
20 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
17 18
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
154
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”
on page 148.
In this example, keep in mind that one of the steps involves holding down a key on
the keyboard while executing the entire operations.
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.
1 Press the [H] button to select “Normal.”
2 Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.
3 Press the [7
ππ
ππ
] button to select the eighth note.
4 While holding C3 key on the keyboard, press the [7
ππ
ππ
] button.
Do not release the C3 key yet. Keep holding it while executing the following
steps.
Example 3
67
5
1–4
* The numbers shown in the sheet correspond to the following
operation step numbers.
A
b
out t
h
e
i
tems w
hi
c
h
can
b
e
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-
tons
See page 151.
3
1
2
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
155
5 While holding the C3 and E3 keys on the keyboard, press the [7
ππ
ππ
]
button.
Do not release the C3 and E3 keys yet. Keep holding them while executing
the following steps.
6 While holding the C3, E3 and G3 keys on the keyboard, press the
[7
ππ
ππ
] button.
Do not release the C3, E3 and G3 keys yet. Keep holding them while exe-
cuting the following steps.
7 While holding the C3, E3, G3 and C4 keys on the keyboard, press the
[7
ππ
ππ
] button, and successively press the [5
ππ
ππ
] button.
After you press the [5
ππ
ππ
] button, release the keys.
8 Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning
of the Song.
9 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered
notes.
10 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner
(page 158).
11 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
156
Recording Chords
You can record Chords and Sections (Intro, Main, Ending, and so on) one at a time
with precise timing. These instructions show how to record chord changes using
the Step Record function.
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”
on page 148.
1 Make sure the STYLE CONTROL [AUTO FILL IN] button is set to OFF,
then press the STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARIATION A] button.
2 Press the [5
ππ
ππ
] button to select the half-note length.
3 Play the chords C, F and G in the chord section of the keyboard.
4 Press the STYLE CONTROL [BREAK] button.
CF GFG7 C
2,3 5,6 8,9
147
* The numbers shown in the notation correspond to the following operation step
numbers.
MAIN A
BREAK
MAIN B
G
F
C
1
2
3
4
5
6
G7
F
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
157
5 Press the [6
ππ
ππ
] button to select the quarter-note length.
6 Play the chords F, and G7 in the chord section of the keyboard.
7 Press the STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARIATION B] button.
8 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
] button to select the whole-note length.
9 Play the chord C in the chord section of the keyboard.
10 Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning
of the Song.
11 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered
notes.
12 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner
(page 158).
13 Press the [F] (EXPAND) button to convert the input chord change
data into the Song data.
14 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
7
8
9
C
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
Deleting data
Mistakenly entered notes can be
deleted (page 150).
Entering fill-ins
Turn the STYLE CONTROL
[AUTO FILL IN] button to ON,
and simply press one of the
STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARI-
ATION (A, B, C, D)] buttons.
(The appropriate fill-in section
plays and then automatically
goes to the selected [MAIN
VARIATION (A, B, C, D)] pattern
playback.)
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
158
Editing a Recorded Song
You can edit the Songs you’ve recorded with any recording method—Quick
Recording, Multi Track Recording, or Step Recording.
Basic Editing Operation
1 Select a Song for editing.
2 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU
3 Press the [A] button to call up the SONG CREATOR display to record
or edit Songs.
4 Select the appropriate tab by using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons and edit
the Song.
Re-Recording a Specific Section
—Punch In/Out (REC MODE) ............................................... page 159
This lets you re-record a specific section of a Song.
Editing Channel Events (CHANNEL) .................................... page 160
This lets you edit the channel events. For example, you can delete data or
transpose notes by channel.
Editing Note or Chord Events (CHORD, 1–16) .................... page 163
This lets you change or delete the recorded notes or chords.
Editing System Event (SYS/EX.) ........................................... page 165
This lets you change the tempo or the time signature.
Editing Lyrics (LYRICS).......................................................... page 166
This lets you change the Song name or lyrics events.
3
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
159
Re-Recording a Specific Section—Punch In/
Out (REC MODE)
When re-recording a specific section of an already-recorded Song, use the Punch
IN/OUT function. In this method, only the data between the Punch In point and
the Punch Out point is overwritten with the newly recorded data. Keep in mind
that the notes before and after the Punch In/Out points are not recorded over,
although you will hear them play back normally to guide you in the Punch In/Out
timing. You can specify the Punch In and Punch Out points as measure numbers
beforehand for automatic operation, or manually execute the Punch In/Out record-
ing by using a Foot Pedal or simply by playing the keyboard.
The explanations here apply to the REC MODE display in step 4 of the “Basic Edit-
ing Operation” on page 158.
1 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[6
ππ
ππ
] buttons to determine the settings for re-
recording (see below).
2 While holding the SONG [REC] button, press the desired track but-
ton.
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback. Play the key-
board at the Punch In point and stop recording at the Punch Out
point.
4 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
PUNCH IN settings
PUNCH OUT settings
+
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
NORMAL Overwrite recording starts when pressing the SONG [PLAY/
PAUSE] button or when you play the keyboard in the Synchro
Standby mode.
FIRST KEY ON The Song plays back normally, then starts overwrite recording as
soon as you play the keyboard.
PUNCH IN AT The Song plays back normally up to the beginning of the indi-
cated Punch In measure, then starts overwrite recording at that
point. You can set the Punch In measure by pressing the [3
π†
]
button.
REPLACE ALL This deletes all data after the point at which recording is stopped.
PUNCH OUT The Song position at which recording is stopped is regarded as
the Punch Out point. This setting maintains all data after the
point at which recording is stopped.
PUNCH OUT AT Actual overwrite recording continues until the beginning of the
specified Punch Out measure (set with the corresponding display
button), at which point recording stops and normal playback
continues. This setting maintains all data after the point at which
recording is stopped. You can set the Punch Out measure by
pressing the [6
π†
] buttons.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
160
Examples of re-recording with various Punch In/Out settings
This instrument features several different ways you use the Punch In/Out function.
The illustrations below indicate a variety of situations in which selected measures
in an eight-measure phrase are re-recorded.
Pedal Punch In/Out settings
Pedal Punch In/Out operation
may be reversed depending on
the particular pedal you've con-
nected to the instrument. If nec-
essary, change the pedal polarity
to reverse the control (page 191).
When this is set to ON, you can use the sostenuto pedal to control the punch-in
and punch-out points. While a Song is playing back, pressing (and holding) the
sostenuto pedal instantly enables Punch In recording, while releasing the pedal
stops recording (Punch Out).You can press and release the sostenuto pedal as often
as you want during playback, to punch in/out of overwrite recording. Note that the
current function assignment of the sostenuto pedal is cancelled when the Pedal
Punch In/Out function is set to ON.
Editing Channel Events (CHANNEL)
The explanations here apply to the CHANNEL tab display in the step 4 of the Basic
Editing Operation on page 158.
1 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the Edit menu (page 161).
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to edit the data.
For information on the available parameters, see page 161.
3 Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to execute the operation for the cur-
rent display.
After the operation (with the exception of the SETUP menu display) is com-
pleted, this button changes to “UNDO,” letting you restore the original data
if you are not satisfied with the Operation results. The Undo function only
has one level; only the immediate operation can be undone.
12345678
12345
12345678
12345678
12345
12345678
12345678
12345
12345678
8
1234567
PUNCH IN setting
PUNCH OUT setting
NORMAL
REPLACE ALL
NORMAL
PUNCH OUT
NORMAL
PUNCH OUT AT=006
FIRST KEY ON
REPLACE ALL
FIRST KEY ON
PUNCH OUT
FIRST KEY ON
PUNCH OUT AT=006
PUNCH IN AT=003
REPLACE ALL
PUNCH IN AT=003
PUNCH OUT
PUNCH IN AT=003
PUNCH OUT AT=006
Original data
Start overwrite recording
*1
Start overwrite recording
*1
Start overwrite recording
*1
Play back (Original data)
Play the keyboard to
start overwrite recording
Play the keyboard to
start overwrite recording
Play the keyboard to
start overwrite recording
Start overwrite recording
Start overwrite recording
Start overwrite recording
Stop recording
*2
Play back (Original data)
Play back (Original data)
Play back (Original data)
Play back (Original data)
Play back (Original data)
Stop recording
*2
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data
Stop recording
*2
Stop recording
*2
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data
Stop recording
*2
Stop recording
*2
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data
*1 To avoid overwriting measures 1-2, start recording from measure 3
*2 To stop recording, press the [REC] button at the end of measure 5.
Previously recorded data
Newly recorded data
Deleted data
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
161
4 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
QUANTIZE menu
The Quantize function allows you to align
the timing of all the notes in a channel. For
example, if you record the musical phrase
shown at right, you may not play it with
absolute precision, and your performance
may have been slightly ahead of or behind
the precise timing. Quantize is a conve-
nient way of correcting for this.
Deleting the data of the specified channel (DELETE menu)
You can delete the data of the specified channel in the Song. Select the channel
whose data to be deleted by using the [1
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons, then press the [D]
(EXECUTE) button to execute the operation.
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
About Quantize size (resolu-
tion)
The Quantize size or resolution
is the number of clocks per quar-
ter note.
CHANNEL Determines the channel in the Song to be quantized.
SIZE Selects the quantize size (resolution). For optimum results, you should set the
Quantize size to the shortest note value in the channel. For example, if eighth
notes are the shortest in the channel, you should use eighth note as the Quantize
size.
Settings
The three Quantize settings marked with asterisks (*) are exceptionally conve-
nient, since they allow you to quantize two different note values at the same
time. For example, when the straight eighth notes and eighth notes triplet are
contained in the same channel, if you quantize by the straight eighth notes, all
notes in the channel are quantized to straight eighth notes—completely elimi-
nating any triplet feel. However, if you use the eighth note + eighth note triplet
setting, both the straight and triplet notes will be quantized correctly.
STRENGTH Determines how strongly the notes will be quantized. A setting of 100% pro-
duces exact timing. If a value less than 100% is selected, notes will be moved
toward the specified quantization beats according to the specified percentage.
Applying less than 100% quantization lets you preserve some of the “human”
feel in the recording.
After eighth note quantization
quarter
note
eighth note sixteenth
note
thirty-second
note
sixteenth note
+ eighth note
triplet*
quarter
note triplet
eighth note
triplet
sixteenth
note triplet
eighth note
+ eighth
note triplet*
sixteenth
note + six-
teenth triplet*
Quarter-note length
Original data
Quantizing strength=100
Quantizing strength=50
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
162
Mixing (merging) the data of the specified two channels (MIX menu)
This function lets you mix the data of the two channels and place the results in a
different channel. It also lets you copy the data from one channel to another.
CHANNEL TRANSPOSE menu
This allows you to transpose the recorded data of individual channels up or down
by a maximum of two octaves in semitone increments.
To display the channels 9–16
Press the [F] button to toggle between the two channel displays—Channels 1–8,
and Channels 9–16.
Transposing to the same value for all channels simultaneously
While holding the [G] (ALL CH) button, press one of the [1
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons.
SETUP menu
The current settings of the Mixing Console (page 88) displays and other panel set-
tings can be recorded to the top position of the Song as the Setup data. The Mixing
Console and panel settings recorded here are automatically recalled when the
Song starts.
Setup recording procedure
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU [A] SONG CREATOR TAB
[
][
®
] CHANNEL [B] SET UP
2 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to determine the settings to be
automatically called up when the Song starts.
3 Checkmark the selected item by pressing the [8
ππ
ππ
] button.
SOURCE 1 Selects the channel (1–16) to be mixed. All MIDI events in the
selected channel are copied to the destination channel.
SOURCE 2 Selects the channel (1–16) to be mixed. Only note events in the
selected channel are copied to the destination channel. In addi-
tion to the values 1–16, there is a “COPY” setting that allows you
to copy the data from Source 1 to the destination channel. If
“COPY” is selected here, the data from Source 1 is copied to the
destination channel. (The original channel data is maintained.)
DESTINATION Selects the channel into which the mix or copy results will be
placed.
SONG Records the tempo setting and all settings made from the Mixing
Console.
KEYBOARD VOICE Records the panel settings including the Voice selection of the
keyboard parts (RIGHT1, 2, and LEFT) and their on/off status.
Panel settings recorded here are same as the ones memorized to
the One Touch Setting. This can be recorded at any point in a
Song (the other items in this chart can be recorded only to the
top position of the Song).
SCORE SETTING Records the settings in the Score display.
GUIDE SETTING Records the settings of the Guide functions including the Guide
ON/OFF setting.
LYRICS SETTING Records the settings in the Lyrics display.
MIC SETTING Records the microphone and the Vocal Harmony settings in the
Mixing Console display (page 88).
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
163
4 Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to execute the SETUP recording oper-
ation.
5
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for saving
your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display (page 69).
Editing Note or Chord Events (CHORD, 1–16)
The explanations here apply to the CHORD and 1–16 tab displays in step 4 of the
Basic Editing Operation on page 158.
1 When the 1–16 tab display is selected, press the [F] button to select
the channel to be edited.
2 Move the cursor to the desired data.
To move the cursor up or down ..............................Use the [A]/[B] button.
To move the cursor to the top data..........................Press the [C] button.
To move the cursor by Measure/Beat/Clock units ....Use the [1
π†
]–
[3
π†
] buttons.
3 Edit the data.
Editing the data line by line
Use the [6
π†
]–[8
π
] buttons to cut/copy/paste/insert/delete the
events.
Editing each parameter of the data
1 Use the [D]/[E] buttons to select the parameter to be edited.
2 Use the [4
π†
]/[5
π†
] buttons to edit the parameter value. The
[DATA ENTRY] dial can also be used. To actually enter an edited
value, simply move the cursor away from the parameter.
To restore the original value, press the [8
] (CANCEL) button before move
the cursor.
4 When the CHORD tab display is selected, press the [F] (EXPAND) but-
ton to convert the data into Song data.
5 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
Selecting multiple lines of
data
While holding the [J] (MULTI
SELECT) button, press the [A]/[B]
buttons.
Displaying specific types of
event (FILTER)
You can select the event types to
be displayed in the [CHORD]
and [1-16] tab displays. This is
convenient, for example, when
you wish to have only the note
events shown (page 165).
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
The data recorded by Realtime
Recording will not appear on the
display and cannot be edited.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
164
About Clock
A unit of note resolution. The
Quantize size is the number of
clocks per quarter note. On the
instrument, one clock is equal to
1/1920th of a quarter note.
About the events shown in the display
12 3
001 : 1 : 1440
Example
Measure number (BAR)
Beat
Clock
1 Indicates the location (position) of the corresponding event. Same as the indication
at the lower left of the display.
2 Indicates the event types (see below).
3 Indicates the event values.
Event types shown on the 1–16 tab display
Event types shown on the CHORD tab display
Note The individual note of a Song. Includes the note number
which corresponds to the key which was played, plus a
velocity value based on how hard the key is played, and the
gate time value (the length of a note).
Ctrl (Control Change) Settings to control the Voice, such as volume, pan, filter and
effect depth (edited via the Mixing Console described on
page 88), etc.
Prog
(Program Change)
MIDI program change number for selecting a Voice.
P.Bnd (Pitch Bend) Data for changing the pitch of a Voice continuously.
A.T. (Aftertouch) This event is generated when pressure is applied to a key
after the note is played.
Style Style
Tempo tempo
Chord chord root, chord type, on bass chord
Sect Accompaniment Style Section (Intro, Main, Fill In, Break,
Ending)
OnOff On/off status for each part (channel) of the Accompaniment
Style
CH.Vol Volume for each part (channel) of the Accompaniment Style
S.Vol Overall volume of the Accompaniment Style
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
165
Displaying Specific Types of Events (FILTER)
In the edit displays various types of events are shown. It may sometimes be difficult
to pinpoint the ones you want to edit. This is where the Filter function comes in
handy. It lets you determine which event types will be shown in the edit displays.
1 Press the [H] (FILTER) button in the edit displays.
2 Select the event type by using the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
3 Checkmark (show) or remove the checkmark for the selected item by
using the [6
ππ
ππ
]/[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
[H] (ALL ON)..............Checkmarks for all event types.
[I] (NOTE/CHORD).....Selects only NOTE/CHORD data.
[J] (INVERT) ................Reverses the checkmark settings for all boxes. In
other words, this enters checkmarks to all boxes that
were previously unchecked and vice versa.
4 Press the [EXIT] button to execute the settings.
Pressing the [C]–[E] buttons calls up the respective Filter displays as shown below.
MAIN .........................Call up the Main Filter display.
CTRL CHG .................Call up the Control Change Filter display.
STYLE .........................Call up the Accompaniment Style Filter Display.
Editing System Exclusive Events (SYS/EX.)
The explanations here apply to the [SYS/EX] tab display in step 4 of the Basic Edit-
ing Operation on page 158.
From this display, you can edit recorded System Exclusive events, which do not
belong to a specific channel, such as tempo and beat (time signature). The opera-
tions here are basically the same as those in the section “Editing Note or Chord
Events” on page 163.
System Events
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for saving your
data, then save the data in the Song Selection display (page 69).
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
ScBar (Score Start Bar) Determines the top measure of a Song.
Tempo Determines the tempo value.
Time (Time Signature) Determines the time signature.
Key (Key Signature) Determines the key signature, as well as the major/minor set-
ting, for the music score shown on the display.
XGPrm (XG Parameters) Allows you to make various detailed changes to the XG parame-
ters. Refer to the “MIDI Data Format” in the separate Data List
booklet for details.
SysEx (System exclusive) Displays the System Exclusive data in the Song. Keep in mind
that you cannot create new data or change the contents of the
data here; however, you can delete, cut, copy, and paste the
data.
Meta (Meta Event) Displays the SMF meta events in the Song. Keep in mind that
you cannot create new data or change the contents of the data
here; however, you can delete, cut, copy, and paste the data.
Using, Creating and Editing Songs
Recording Your Performance
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
166
Editing Lyrics (LYRICS)
The explanations here apply to the LYRICS tab display in step 4 of the Basic Editing
Operation on page 158. From this display, you can edit the recorded Lyrics events.
The operations here are basically the same as in the section “Editing Note or Chord
Events” on page 163.
Lyrics Events
Inputting and Editing Lyrics
1 Use the [4
ππ
ππ
]/[5
ππ
ππ
] (DATA ENTRY) buttons to call up the lyrics
editing display.
Operations are the same as in the section “Entering Characters” (page 72).
2 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display
(page 69).
Name Allows you to enter the Song name.
Lyrics Allows you to enter lyrics.
Control Codes CR
Enters a line break in the lyrics text.
LF
Unavailable on the instrument. On some MIDI devices, this
event may delete the currently displayed lyrics and display the
next set of lyrics.
CAUTION
The recorded Song data will
be lost if you select another
Song or turn the power to the
instrument off without exe-
cuting the Save operation
(page 69).
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
167
Using a Microphone
Using a Microphone
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters
This section explains briefly how to create your own Vocal Harmony (page 57)
types, and lists the detailed parameters for editing. Up to ten Vocal Harmony types
can be created and saved.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
2 Press the [H] (VOCAL HARMONY TYPE) button to call up the VOCAL
HARMONY TYPE selection display.
Reference to Quick Guide pages
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke) or Your Own
Performance.................................................................................. page 54
Connecting a Microphone...........................................................page 54
Singing with the Lyrics Display ...................................................page 55
Convenient Functions for Karaoke ..............................................page 56
Adjusting the tempo ................................................................ page 31
Transpose ................................................................................ page 56
Applying effects to Your Voice ................................................. page 56
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice..................................... page 57
Practicing Singing with Proper Pitch (Vocal CueTIME)........... page 142
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your Own
Performance................................................................................. page 58
Changing the Key (Transpose).................................................. page 58
Displaying the Music Score on Instrument and Lyrics on TV .... page 59
Making Announcements Between Songs ................................. page 59
Controlling Playback Timing by Your Voice (Karao-Key) ......... page 142
2
Using a Microphone
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
168
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Vocal Harmony type to be
edited.
4 Press the [8
] (EDIT) button to call up the VOCAL HARMONY EDIT
display.
5 If you want to re-select the Vocal Harmony type, use the [1
ππ
ππ
]/
[2
ππ
ππ
] buttons.
Or you can re-select the Vocal Harmony type by pressing the [8
π†
]
(RETURN) button to return to the Vocal Harmony selection display.
6 Use the [3
ππ
ππ
]–[5
ππ
ππ
] buttons to select the parameter (page 169)
you want to edit.
7 Set the value of the parameter selected above.
8 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited Vocal Harmony type
(page 69).
33
4
567
8
CAUTION
The settings here will be lost
if you change to another
Vocal Harmony type or you
turn the power off without
executing the save operation.
Using a Microphone
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
169
Editable Parameters in the VOCAL HARMONY EDIT Display
VOCODER TYPE Determines how the harmony notes are applied to the micro-
phone sound when the Harmony mode (page 173) is set to
“VOCODER.
CHORDAL TYPE Determines how the harmony notes are applied to the micro-
phone sound when the Harmony mode (page 173) is set to
“CHORDAL.
HARMONY GENDER TYPE Determines whether the gender of the harmony sound is
changed or not.
Off
The gender of the harmony sound is not changed.
Auto
The gender of the harmony sound is changed automatically.
LEAD GENDER TYPE Determines whether and how the gender of the lead vocal sound
(i.e., the direct microphone sound) will be changed. Please note
that the number of harmony notes differs depending on the
selected type. When set to Off, three harmony notes are pro-
duced. Other settings produce two harmony notes.
Off
No gender change occurs.
Unison
No gender change occurs. You can adjust the LEAD GENDER
DEPTH below.
Male
The corresponding gender change is applied to the lead vocal.
Female
The corresponding gender change is applied to the lead vocal.
LEAD GENDER DEPTH Adjusts the degree of lead vocal gender change. This is available
when the LEAD GENDER TYPE above is set to other than Off.
The higher the value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice
becomes. The lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.
LEAD PITCH CORRECT This parameter is only effective when the LEAD GENDER TYPE
above is set to other than Off.
When Smooth or Hard is selected, the pitch of the lead vocal is
shifted in precise semitone steps.
UPPER GENDER THRESH-
OLD
Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or
exceeds the specified number of semitones above the lead vocal
pitch.
LOWER GENDER THRESH-
OLD
Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or
exceeds the specified number of semitones below the lead vocal
pitch.
UPPER GENDER DEPTH Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes
higher than the UPPER GENDER THRESHOLD. The higher the
value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice becomes. The
lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.
LOWER GENDER DEPTH Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes
lower than the LOWER GENDER THRESHOLD. The higher the
value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice becomes. The
lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.
VIBRATO DEPTH Sets the depth of vibrato applied to the harmony sound. Also
affects the lead vocal sound when the LEAD GENDER TYPE
above is set to other than Off.
VIBRATO RATE Sets the speed of the vibrato effect. Also affects the lead vocal
sound when the LEAD GENDER TYPE above is set to other than
Off.
VIBRATO DELAY Specifies the length of the delay before the vibrato effect begins
when a note is produced. Higher values result in a longer delay.
Using a Microphone
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
170
Adjusting the Microphone and Har-
mony Sound
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
2 Press the [I] (MIC SETTING) button to call up the MICROPHONE SET-
TING display.
HARMONY1/2/3 VOLUME Sets the volume of the first (lowest), second, and third (highest)
harmony notes.
HARMONY1/2/3 PAN Specifies the stereo (pan) position of the first (lowest), second,
and third (highest) harmony notes.
Random
The stereo position of the sound will change randomly when-
ever the keyboard is played. This is effective when the Har-
mony mode (page 173) is set to “VOCODER” or “CHORDAL.
L63>R – C – L<R63
A setting of L63>R pans the sound hard left, while C is at cen-
ter, and L<R63 is at hard right.
HARMONY1/2/3 DETUNE Detunes the first (lowest), second, and third (highest) harmony
notes by the specified number of cents.
PITCH TO NOTE When this is set to “ON,” you can “play” the voices of the instru-
ment with your voice. (The instrument tracks the pitch of your
voice and converts it to note data for the tone generator. Keep in
mind, however, that dynamic changes in your voice do not affect
the volume of the tone generator.)
PITCH TO NOTE PART Determines which of the instrument parts will be controlled by
the lead vocal when the Pitch to Note parameter is “ON.
2
Using a Microphone
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
171
3 Press the TAB [
] button to select the OVERALL SETTING tab display.
4 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select the item (parameter) (see below) to
be adjusted.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the value.
6 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-
play.
Adjustable Items (Parameters) in the OVERALL SETTING Tab
Display
3BAND EQ
EQ (Equalizer) is a processor that divides the frequency spectrum into multiple
bands, which can be boosted or cut as required to tailor the overall frequency
response. The instrument features a high-grade three-band (LOW, MID and HIGH)
digital equalizer function for the microphone sound.
•Hz
Adjusts the center frequency of the corresponding band.
•dB
Boosts or cuts the level of the corresponding band by up to 12 dB.
NOISE GATE
This effect mutes the input signal when the input from the microphone falls below
a specified level. This effectively cuts off extraneous noise, allowing the desired sig-
nal (vocal, etc.) to pass.
SW (Switch)
This turns the Noise Gate on or off.
TH. (Threshold)
This adjusts the input level at which the gate begins to open.
5
44
6
3
CAUTION
Settings in the OVERALL SET-
TING tab display are automat-
ically saved to the instrument
when you exit from the dis-
play. However, if you turn the
power off without exiting
from this display, the settings
will be lost.
Using a Microphone
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
172
COMPRESSOR
This effect holds down the output when the input signal from the microphone
exceeds a specified level. This is especially useful for smoothing out vocals that
have widely varying dynamics. It effectively “compresses” the signal, making soft
parts louder and loud parts softer.
SW (Switch)
This turns the Compressor on or off.
TH. (Threshold)
This adjusts the input level at which compression begins to be applied.
•RATIO
This adjusts the compression ratio.
OUT
This adjusts the final output level.
VOCAL HARMONY CONTROL
The following parameters determine how the harmony is controlled.
VOCODER CONTROL
The Vocal Harmony effect in Vocoder mode (page 173) is controlled by note
data—the notes you play on the keyboard and/or the notes of the song data. This
parameter lets you determine which notes are used to control the harmony.
BAL.
This lets you set the balance between the lead vocal (your own voice) and Vocal
Harmony. Raising this value increases the volume of the Vocal Harmony and
decreases that of the lead vocal.
When this is set to L<H63 (L: Lead Vocal, H: Vocal Harmony), only the Vocal
Harmony is output; when it is set to L63>H, only the lead vocal is output.
SONG CHANNEL MUTE/PLAY
When set to “MUTE,” the channel selected below (to control
Harmony) is muted (turned off) during song playback.
OFF/Channels 1–16
When set to “OFF,” song data control over harmony is turned
off. When set to one of the values 1–16, note data (played
from a song on the instrument or an external MIDI sequencer)
contained on the corresponding channel is used to control the
harmony. This setting is linked to the HARMONY CH setting in
the SONG SETTING display (page 141).
KEYBOARD OFF
Keyboard control over harmony is turned off.
UPPER
Notes played to the right of the split point control the har-
mony.
LOWER
Notes played to the left of the split point control the harmony.
Using a Microphone
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
173
MODE
All of the Vocal Harmony types fall into one of three modes, which produce har-
mony in different ways. The harmony effect is dependent on the selected Vocal
Harmony mode, and this parameter determines how the harmony is applied to
your voice. The three modes are described below.
CHORD
The following parameters determine which data in a recorded song is used for
chord detection.
•Vocal Range
Set this to obtain the most natural vocal harmony, depending on your voice.
MIC
The following parameters determine how the microphone sound is controlled.
MUTE
When set to ON, the microphone sound is turned off.
VOLUME
Adjusts the output volume of the microphone sound.
AUTO When the [ACMP ON/OFF] or [LEFT] is set to ON and if chord
data exists in the song, the mode is automatically set to
CHORDAL. In all other cases, the mode is set to VOCODER.
VOCODER The harmony notes are determined by the notes you play on the
keyboard and/or song data. You can specify whether the Vocoder
effect is controlled by your keyboard performance or by the Song
data (page 172).
CHORDAL The harmony notes are determined by the following three types
of chord: chords played in the chord section of the keyboard
(with the [ACMP] turned on), chords played in the LEFT Voice
section of the keyboard (with the [ACMP] turned off and the
[LEFT] turned on), and chords contained in song data for control-
ling the harmony. (Not available if the song does not contain any
chord data.)
OFF Chords are not detected from the song data.
XF Chords of XF format are used for the Vocal Harmony.
1–16 Chords are detected from note data in the specified song chan-
nel.
Normal Normal setting
Low Setting for lower voice. This setting is also appropriate for growl-
ing and shouting.
High Setting for higher voice. This setting is also appropriate for sing-
ing close to the microphone.
Using a Microphone
Talk Setting
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
174
Talk Setting
This function lets you have special settings for making announcements between
songs, separate from the settings for your singing performance.
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY
2 Press the [I] (MIC SETTING) button to call up the MICROPHONE SET-
TING display.
3 Press the TAB [
®
] button to select the TALK SETTING tab display.
4 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the item (parameter) (page 175) to
be set.
5 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
]–[7
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the value.
6 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-
play.
5
4
3
6
CAUTION
Settings in the TALK SETTING
tab display are automatically
saved to the instrument when
y
ou exit from the display.
However, if you turn the
power off without exiting
from this display, the settings
will be lost.
Using a Microphone
Talk Setting
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
175
Adjustable Items (Parameters) in the TALK SETTING Tab Display
VOLUME This determines the output volume of the microphone sound.
PAN This sets the stereo pan position of the microphone sound.
REVERB DEPTH This sets the depth of the reverb effects applied to the micro-
phone sound.
CHORUS DEPTH This sets the depth of the chorus effects applied to the micro-
phone sound.
TOTAL VOLUME ATTENUA-
TOR
This determines the amount of attenuation to be applied to the
overall sound (excepting the microphone input)—allowing you
to effectively adjust the balance between your voice and the
overall instrument sound.
DSP MIC ON/OFF This turns the DSP effect applied to the microphone sound ON
or OFF.
DSP MIC TYPE This selects the type of DSP effect to be applied to the micro-
phone sound.
DSP MIC DEPTH This sets the depth of the DSP effect applied to the microphone
sound.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
176
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
You can purchase and download Song data and other types of data from the spe-
cial Clavinova website by directly connecting the instrument to the Internet. This
section contains terms related to computers and online communications. If there
are some terms you are unfamiliar with, refer to the Internet Glossary (page 188).
Connecting the Instrument to the
Internet
You can connect the instrument to a full-time online connection (ADSL, optical fiber,
cable Internet, etc.) via a router or a modem equipped with a router. For specific
instructions on connecting (as well as information on compatible LAN adaptors, rout-
ers, etc.), refer to the Yamaha website:
http://music.yamaha.com/homekeyboard
To use the Internet connection, you will first need to subscribe to an Internet ser-
vice or provider.
Connection example 1:
Connecting by cable (using a modem without router)
Connection example 2:
Connecting by cable (using a modem with router)
Connection example 3: Wireless connection
The special website can be
opened when directly connect-
ing the Clavinova to the Internet.
Depending on the Internet con-
nection, you may not be able to
connect to two or more devices
(for example, a computer and
the instrument), depending on
the contract with the provider.
This means you cannot connect
with the Clavinova. If in doubt,
check your contract or contact
your provider.
Connect the LAN cable to the
LAN port.
Due to EU regulations, users
within Europe should use an STP
(shielded twisted pair) cable to
prevent electromagnetic interfer-
ence.
Some types of modems require
an optional hub network for
simultaneously connecting to
several devices (such as com-
puter, musical instrument, etc.).
Connect the LAN cable to the
LAN port.
A USB wireless LAN adaptor
also can be used.
Use a computer to connect to the Internet and get online before connect-
ing the instrument, since no modem or router settings can be made from
the instrument itself.
Modem*
No router capability
Router
Cable type
LAN cable
LAN port
* Here, “modem” refers to an ADSL modem, optical network unit (ONU) or cable modem.
LAN cable
ADSL modem
Router capability
LAN cable
LAN port
LAN cable
Modem* Access point
Wireless Game Adaptor
* Here, “modem” refers to an ADSL modem, optical network unit (ONU) or cable modem.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Accessing the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
177
Accessing the Special Website
From the special website, you can audition and purchase Song data, among other
things. To access the site, press the [INTERNET] button, while the instrument is
connected to the Internet.
To close the website display and return to the operation display of the instrument,
press the [EXIT] button.
Operations in the Special Website
Scrolling the Display
When the size of the web page is too large to be shown at one time in the browser
display of the instrument, a scroll bar appears at the right side of the display. Use
the [DATA ENTRY] dial to scroll through the display and view those parts of the
page that are not shown.
Scroll bar
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
178
Following Links
When there is a link in the page, it is shown as a button or in colored text, etc. To
select the link, press the [6
]/[7
π†
]/[8
] buttons or use the [DATA ENTRY]
dial. Press the [8
π
] (ENTER) button to actually call up the link destination.
You can also select and call up links by using the [A]–[J] buttons.
Entering Characters
This section explains how to enter characters within the website, for inputting a
password or searching for data, refer to the “Entering Characters” on page 73.
Return to the Previous Web Page
To return to a previously selected web page, press the [1
π†
] (BACK) button. To
return to the page selected before pressing the [1
π†
] (BACK) button, press the
[2
π†
] (FORWARD) button.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
179
Refreshing a Web Page/Canceling Loading of
a Web Page
To refresh a web page (to make sure you have the latest version of the page, or to
try reloading), press the [5
π
] (REFRESH) button.
To cancel loading of a page (if the page is taking too long to open), press the [6
π
]
(STOP) button.
SSL:
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) is an
industry-standard method for
protecting web communications
by using data encryption and
other tools.
Monitoring the Internet Connection Status
The messages and icons at the bottom right of the Internet display indicate
the current Internet connection status.
2
13 4
Message
The following three messages are displayed according to the loading status of
the web page.
“Disconnected”
This appears when the instrument is not connected with the Internet. When
this message is displayed, the web page cannot be seen. Icon 1 is displayed.
“Now opening web page... ”
The web page is being loaded. Icon 2 flashes.
“Web page has been displayed. ”
Loading of the web page is completed, and the page is displayed completely.
Icon 2 stops flashing. When the displayed web page uses SSL, icon 3 is dis-
played, and information is encrypted for communication.
Strength of the reception is displayed in 4 when connecting to the Internet by
wireless LAN. When reception is weak, move the instrument near the access
point to improve reception.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
180
Purchasing and Downloading Data
You can purchase and download Song data (for playback on this instrument) and
other types of data from the special website. For details on purchasing and down-
loading data, refer to the instructions on the site itself.
Operation after purchase and download
When downloading is completed, a message appears asking you whether or not to
open the File Selection display. Select “YES” to call up the File Selection display,
from which you can select the downloaded data. To return to the Internet display,
select “NO” When the File Selection display is open, press the [8
π
] (UP) button to
call up the next highest level folder.
Download Destination
The download destination depends on the use of storage media, as
described below.
When a USB storage device is connected to the instrument during pur-
chase:
The downloaded data is saved in the “MyDownloads” folder in the USB
tab display of the File Selection display. To close the folder and call up
the next highest level folder, press the [8
π
] (UP) button in the File
Selection display.
When a USB storage device is not connected to the instrument during pur-
chase:
The downloaded data is saved in the “MyDownloads” folder in the User
tab display of the File Selection display. To close the folder and call up
the next highest level folder, press the [8
π
] (UP) button in the File
Selection display.
Registering Bookmarks of Your Favorite Pages
You can “bookmark” the page you’re viewing, and set up a custom link so the page
can be instantly called up in the future.
1 With the desired page currently selected, press the [4
ππ
ππ
] (BOOK-
MARK) button. The Bookmark display appears, showing a list of the
currently registered bookmarks.
The title of the currently selected web page is shown below the list.
2 Call up the display for registering bookmarks by pressing the [3
ππ
ππ
]
(ADD) button.
CAUTION
The purchased data will be
lost if you turn the power to
the instrument off during
download.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
181
3 Select the position of the new bookmark by pressing the [1
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
) button.
4 To register the bookmark, press the [7
ππ
ππ
] (EXECUTE) button, or
press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (CANCEL) button to cancel.
5 To return to the browser, press the [8
ππ
ππ
] (CLOSE) button.
Opening a Bookmarked Page
1 Press the [4
ππ
ππ
] (BOOKMARK) button to call up the Bookmark dis-
play.
2 Press the [1
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
) button to select the desired bookmark.
3 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
] (VIEW) button to open the page of the selected
bookmark.
34
23
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
182
Editing Bookmarks
From the Bookmark display, you can change the names and rearrange the
order of your bookmarks, as well as delete unnecessary bookmarks from
the list.
123456 7
1
ππ
ππ
/
Moves the selection position in the Bookmark list.
2 View
Opens the web page of the selected bookmark.
3 Add
Used when registering a bookmark (page 180).
4 Move
Changes the order of the bookmarks.
1 Select the bookmark you wish to move, then press the [4
ππ
ππ
]
(MOVE) button.
The lower part of the display changes, letting you select the new posi-
tion for the bookmark.
2 Select the intended position by pressing the [1
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
)
button.
3 Move the bookmark to the selected position by pressing the
[7
ππ
ππ
] (EXECUTE) button.
5 Changing names
Changes the name of the selected bookmark. Pressing the [5
π†
] (CHANGE) but-
ton calls up the display for entering characters. For details on entering characters,
see page 73.
6 Delete
Deletes the selected bookmark from the Bookmark list.
7 Close
Closes the Bookmark display and returns to the browser display.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
183
About the Internet Settings Display
From the Internet Settings display, you can make various settings related to the
Internet connection, including preferences for the menus and displays. The Internet
Settings display has four sub-displays: Browser, LAN, Wireless LAN, and Others.
Basic Operation
1 Press the [5
] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Setting dis-
play.
2 Press the TAB [
][
®
] buttons to select the desired display.
3 Select the desired item by pressing the [1
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
) button.
4 To call up the relevant Edit display, press the [2
ππ
ππ
]/[3
ππ
ππ
] (EDIT)
button.
For some items, the Edit display may not be shown, but the setting or change
may be executed.
5 Press the [2
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
) button to select the setting or change the
value.
This can also be done by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
Entering Characters
When the character input dis-
play is opened, you can enter
characters. (Refer to “Entering
Characters” on page 178.)
34
65
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
184
6 To execute the setting, press the [3
ππ
ππ
] (ENTER) button. To cancel,
press the [3
] (CANCEL) button.
7 To actually apply all settings changed in the Internet Settings display,
press the [7
ππ
ππ
] (SAVE) button.
To cancel, press the [8
π†
] (CANCEL) button.
Browser
LAN
Both the wired LAN and wireless LAN need to be set in this display.
1
2
3
4
5
6
1 Encode
Selects the character code encoding for the browser.
2 Home Page
Shows and allows editing of the web page which is set as the home page.
3 Set current page as Home
For details, refer to “Changing the Home Page” on page 186.
4 Restore Default Home
Restores the home page setting.
5 Show images
Image data and pictures in the web page are shown in the browser when this is set
to on. Image data is not shown when this is set to off.
6 Time zone
This determines the time zone setting for the browser.
1
2
3
Make a written note of the settings here, in
case you have to enter them again.
Use DHCP
DNS server1
DNS server2
IP address
Subnet mask
Gateway
1 Use DHCP
Determines whether or not DHCP is used. If your router is compatible with DHCP,
select “ON.
2 DNS server 1/DNS server 2
These determine the addresses of the primary and secondary DNS servers. These
settings must be made when “Use DHCP” above is set to “ON (set DNS manu-
ally)” or “OFF.
3 IP address/Subnet mask/Gateway
These settings are available only when DHCP is not used. The settings here are: IP
address, subnet mask, and gateway server address. These settings must be made
when “Use DHCP” above is set to “OFF.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
185
Wireless LAN
These settings here are only necessary when using a USB wireless LAN adaptor.
For a wireless LAN setup, make sure to set both the LAN settings (page 184) and
the Wireless LAN settings below.
Others
The settings at left are not neces-
sary when using the Wireless
Game Adaptor.
1
2
3
4
5
Make a written note of the settings here, in
case you have to enter them again
SSID
Channel
Encryption
WEP key type
WEP key length
WEP key
1
Wireless Networks
Determines whether or not Wireless Networks are displayed.
2
SSID
Determines the SSID setting.
3 Channel
Determines the channel.
4 Encryption
Determines whether or not the data is encrypted.
5 WEP key type/WEP key length/WEP key
These settings are available only when Encryption above is enabled. These set the
type and length of the encryption key.
2
3
4
5
1
1 Proxy server/Proxy port/Non-proxy server
Determines the proxy server name, port number and the host name for the non-
proxy server. The settings here are only necessary when using a proxy server. When
using a non-proxy server, enter a separator (comma) between each server name.
2 Delete cookies
Deletes the information of all saved cookies.
3 Delete all bookmarks
Deletes all saved bookmarks.
4 Initialize setup
Restores all settings in the Internet Settings displays to their defaults. See “Initializ-
ing Internet Settings” on page 187.
5 Connection information
Shows detailed information on the current connection.
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
186
Changing the Home Page
In the default condition, the top page of the special website is automatically set to
be the Home page for the browser. However, you can specify any desired page on
the special website to be the Home page.
1
Open the page you wish to set as your new Home page.
2
Press the [5
] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Setting dis-
play.
3
Press the TAB [
] button to select the BROWSER tab.
4
Press the [1
] (
) button to select the setting “Set current page as
Home.”
5 Use the [2
ππ
ππ
]/[3
ππ
ππ
] (EDIT) buttons to actually set the selected
page as your new Home page.
6 To return to the browser, press the [7
ππ
ππ
] (SAVE) button.
To cancel, press the [8
π†
] (CANCEL) button.
45 6
3
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Operations in the Special Website
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
187
Initializing Internet Settings
The settings of the Internet function are not initialized when using the Initialize
operation of the instrument; Internet settings must be initialized separately, as
explained here. Initializing will reset to the default values not only the settings of
the browser, but also all settings you have made in the Internet Settings displays
(except for the cookies and bookmarks), including those related to Internet connec-
tion.
1 Press the [5
] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Settings dis-
play.
2 Press the TAB [
®
] button to select the OTHERS tab.
3 Press the [1
ππ
ππ
] (
ππ
ππ
/
) button to select “Initialize.”
4 Use the [2
ππ
ππ
]/ [3
ππ
ππ
] (EDIT) buttons to initialize the Internet set-
tings.
Sometimes cookies contain per-
sonal information.
3 4
Delete cookies/bookmarks
Cookies and bookmarks are still remain after executing the initialize oper-
ation above.
To delete the cookies or bookmarks, use the appropriate operations in the
OTHERS tab display (page 185).
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet
Glossary of Internet Terms
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
188
Glossary of Internet Terms
Broadband An Internet connection technology/service (such as ADSL and optical fiber) that allows for high-speed, high-
volume data communication.
Browser The software used to search for, access, and view web pages. For this instrument, this refers to the display
that shows the contents of the web pages.
Cookie A system that records certain information that the user transfers when visiting a website and using the Inter-
net. The function is similar to a preference file in a conventional computer program, in that it “remembers”
certain information such as your user name and password, so you don’t have to re-enter the information
each time you visit the site.
DHCP This is a standard or protocol by which IP addresses and other low-level network configuration information
can be dynamically and automatically assigned each time connection is made to the Internet.
DNS A system that translates names of computers connected to a network to their corresponding IP addresses.
Download Transferring data over a network, from a larger “host” system to a smaller “client” system’s hard drive or
other local storage device—much like copying files from your hard disk drive to a floppy disk. For this
instrument, this refers to the process of transferring Song and other data from a website to the instrument.
Gateway A system which links different networks or systems, and makes possible data transfer and conversion
despite differing communications standards.
Home page The first page shown when opening a browser and connecting to the Internet. This phrase is also used to
mean the “front screen” or top page of a website.
Internet A huge network made up of networks, the Internet allows high-speed data transfer among computers,
mobile phones and other devices.
IP address A string of numbers assigned to each computer connected to a network, and indicating the device’s location
on the network.
LAN Short for Local Area Network, this is a data-transfer network that connects a group of computers at a single
location (such as an office or home) by means of a special cable.
Link Location information in other sentences and images, etc. that are under buttons and character strings on a
web page. When the place with the link is clicked, the page selection jumps to the relevant link.
Modem
A device which connects and allows data transfer between a conventional telephone line and a computer. It
converts the digital signals from the computer to analog audio for sending over the phone line, and vice versa.
NTP
Short for Network Time Protocol, a standard for setting the internal system clock of the computer over a network.
For this instrument, the internal clock of the computer is used to specify the valid time/date for cookies and SSL.
Provider A communications business that offers Internet connection services. In order to connect to the Internet, it is
necessary to contract to a provider.
Proxy
A proxy server is a server that all computers on a local network have to go through before accessing informa-
tion on the Internet. It intercepts all or designated requests to the real server to see if it can fulfill the requests
itself. If not, it forwards the request to the real server. Proxy servers are used to improve performance and
speed, and to filter requests, usually for security and to prevent unauthorized access to an internal network.
Router
A device for connecting multiple computer networks. For example, a router is necessary when connecting several
computers in a house or office, and allow them to all access the Internet and share data. A router is usually con-
nected between a modem and a computer, although some modems have a built-in router.
Server A hardware system or computer used as a central point for a network, providing access to files and services.
Site
Short for “website,” this refers to the group of web pages that are opened together. For example, the collec-
tion of web pages whose addresses begin with “http://www.yamaha.com/” is referred to as the Yamaha site.
SSID This is an identification name for specifying a particular network over a wireless LAN connection. Commu-
nication is possible only between terminals with matching SSID names.
SSL Short for Secure Sockets Layer, a standard for transmitting confidential data such as credit card numbers
over the Internet.
Subnet mask A setting used to divide a large-scale network into several smaller networks.
URL Short for Uniform Resource Locator, a string of characters used to identify and link to specific websites and
pages on the Internet. A complete URL usually starts with the characters “http://.
Web page Refers to each individual page that makes up a website.
Wireless LAN A LAN connection that allows data transfer through a wireless, cable-free connection.
Wireless Game
Adaptor
(Wireless Ethernet
Converter or Bridge)
Device that allows easy wireless connection with digital consumer electronic devices, printers, and game
machines, etc. equipped with LAN ports.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
189
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
Using Headphones
(
1 [PHONES] jacks)
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the [PHONES]
jacks (standard 1/4" phone jacks) located on the leftward
underside of the instrument. For details, see page 17.
Connecting a Microphone or
Guitar (2 [MIC./LINE IN] jack)
By connecting a microphone to the [MIC./LINE IN] jack
(standard 1/4" phone jack) located on the left underside
of the instrument, you can enjoy singing along with
Song playback (KARAOKE) or with your own perfor-
mance. The instrument outputs your vocals or guitar
sounds through the built-in speakers. For instructions on
connecting, see page 54. Please note that when con-
necting devices of high output level, make sure to set
the [MIC. LINE] switch to “LINE.
Connecting Audio & Video
Devices (345)
n
Use audio cables and adaptor plugs having no (zero) resistance.
Using External Audio Devices for play-
back and Recording (3 [AUX OUT]
Jacks, [AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)] Jacks)
You can connect these jacks to a stereo system to
amplify the instrument’s sound or to a cassette tape
recorder or a digital audio device for recording your
performance. The microphone or guitar sound con-
nected to the instrument’s [MIC./LINE IN] jack) is output
at the same time. Refer to the diagrams below and use
audio cables for connection. These jacks are located on
the underside jacks panel of the instrument.
[AUX OUT] Jacks
(Standard phone jacks of [L/L+R] and [R])
When these are connected, you can use the instru-
ment’s [MASTER VOLUME] control to adjust the vol-
ume of the sound output to the external device.
Connect the instrument’s AUX OUT [L/L+R]/[R] jacks
and the input jacks of a pair of powered speakers using
appropriate audio cables. Use only the [L/L+R] jack for
connection with a monaural device.
CAUTION
Before connecting the instrument to other electronic
components, turn off the power of all the components.
Also, before turning any components on or off, make sure
to set all volume levels to minimum (0). Otherwise, elec-
trical shock or damage to the components may occur.
MIN MA X
INPUT
MIC.
MIC. LINE PHONES
VOLUME
LINE IN
2
1
345
6 8 9
)
7
P. 191 P. 194 P. 194 P. 195
P. 190 P. 190 P. 196P. 189
The front side
of the instru-
ment (the key-
board side)
The right side of the instrument
(near the higher keys)
The left side of the instrument
(near the lower keys)
CAUTION
When the instrument’s sound is output to an external
device, first turn on the power to the instrument, then to
the external device. Reverse this order when you turn the
power off.
Do not route the output from the [AUX OUT] [AUX OUT
(LEVEL FIXED)] jacks to the [AUX IN] jacks. If you make
this connection, the signal input at the [AUX IN] jacks is
output from the [AUX OUT] [AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)]
jacks. These connections could result in a feedback loop
that will make normal performance impossible, and may
even damage both pieces of equipment.
Instrument
Powered speakers
Input jack
Phone plug
(standard)
Phone plug (standard)
Audio cable
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
190
[AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)] Jacks
(RCA pin jacks of [L]and [R])
When these are connected (with RCA pin plug; LEVEL
FIXED), the sound is output to the external device at a
fixed level, regardless of the [MASTER VOLUME] con-
trol setting. Use these when controlling volume with an
external audio system, or recording the instrument’s
sound to an external audio system. Connect the instru-
ment’s AUX OUT [L]/[R] (LEVEL FIXED) jacks and the
AUX IN jacks of an external audio system using appro-
priate audio cables.
Playing External Audio Devices with the
Built-in Speakers (4 [AUX IN] Jacks)
The stereo outputs from another instrument can be con-
nected to these jacks, allowing the sound of an external
instrument to be reproduced via the instrument’s speak-
ers. Connect the output jacks (LINE OUT etc.) of an
external synthesizer or the tone generator module and
the instrument’s AUX IN [L/L+R]/[R] jacks using appro-
priate audio cables.
n
•Use only the [L/L+R] jack for connection with a monaural device.
•The instrument’s [MASTER VOLUME] setting affects the input
signal from the [AUX IN] jacks.
Showing the Instrument’s Display Con-
tents on an External Monitor
(5 [VIDEO OUT] Terminal, [RGB OUT]
Terminal)
Connect the instrument to an external monitor, and you
can have the current display contents, lyrics or text files
(for group sing-alongs and the like) displayed on the TV,
video, computer. For instructions on connecting, see
page 56.
CAUTION
When the sound of an external device is output to the
instrument, first turn on the power to the external device,
then to the instrument. Reverse this order when you turn
the power off.
Instrument
Stereo system
Audio cable
Pin plug
Pin plug
Instrument
Synthesizer
Tone generator
Phone plug (standard)
Audio cable
Pin plug
Settings
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [J] (UTILITY) TAB [
][
®
]
SCREEN OUT
2 Select the video equipment standard
“NTSC”, “PAL”, or “RGB” by using the
[1
ππ
ππ
]/ [2
ππ
ππ
] buttons. Select the con-
tents of the Screen Out signal—the current
display contents (LCD) or lyrics (LYRICS)/
text (TEXT) —by using the [3
ππ
ππ
]/[4
ππ
ππ
]
buttons.
n
• Set the NTSC or PAL to correspond to the standard used by
your video equipment.
• Set the RGB to computer monitor.
•When LYRICS/TEXT is selected as the contents of the Screen
Out signal, only the lyrics of the song or text files are output
via VIDEO OUT/RGB OUT, regardless of the display that is
called up on the instrument.
•Avoid looking at the television, video, or computer monitor
for prolonged periods of time since doing so could damage
your eyesight. Take frequent breaks and focus your eyes on
distant objects to avoid eyestrain.
Connecting Audio & Video Devices
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
191
Using the Footswitch or Foot
Controller
(6 [AUX PEDAL] jack)
By connecting a Foot Controller or Footswitch to the
[AUX PEDAL] jack, you can have convenient control
over various user-assignable functions. For example,
connecting the Foot controller FC7 and assigning it the
volume control function allows you to add expression
to your performance by controlling the volume level of
the notes you play. Or by connecting the FC4 or FC5
footswitch and assigning it to the Style playback start/
stop function, you can start and stop the Style with your
foot. (In this case, the pedal has the same function as
the panel STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.) The
assignable functions are listed following the instructions
below.
Assigning Specific Functions to Each
Foot Pedal
In addition to the footswitch or foot controller, the three
piano pedals installed to the instrument (Right, Center
and Left pedals) can also be assigned to various func-
tions here. The following explanations cover the related
operations and assignable functions (parameters).
1 Call up the operation display.
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [
]
PEDAL
2 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select one of the
three pedals or the AUX-connected pedal, to
which the function is to be assigned.
3 Use the [1
ππ
ππ
] button to select the functions to
be assigned to the pedal specified in step 2.
Details on the pedal functions are listed below.
4 Use the [2
ππ
ππ
]–[8
ππ
ππ
] buttons to set the
details of the selected functions.
The available parameters differ depending on the
function selected in step 3. Details on the parameters
are given below.
5 Check that the desired function is controllable
with the pedal by actually pressing the pedal.
n When you use a pedal to switch Registration Memory
settings (page 134), these settings are invalid.
CAUTION
Make sure to connect or disconnect the pedal only when
the power is off.
Foot Pedals
Footswitch FC4
(optional)
Footswitch FC5
(optional)
Foot Controller FC7
(optional)
Set the polarity of the pedal
Pedal on/off operation may differ depending on the partic-
ular pedal you’ve connected to the instrument. For exam-
ple, pressing down on one pedal may turn the selected
function on, while pressing a different make/brand of
pedal may turn the function off. If necessary, use this set-
ting to reverse the control. Press the [I] (AUX PEDAL
POLARITY) button to switch the polarity.
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
192
Details on the pedal functions are listed here. For functions indicated with “
*
“, use only the foot controller; proper
operation cannot be done with a footswitch.
Assignable Pedal Functions
VOLUME* Allows you to use a foot controller to control the volume. This function is available only
for the pedal connected to the instrument’s AUX PEDAL jack.
SUSTAIN Allows you to use a pedal to control the sustain. When you press and hold the pedal,
all notes played on the keyboard have a longer sustain. Releasing the pedal immedi-
ately stops (damps) any sustained notes.
SOSTENUTO Allows you to use the pedal as a sostenuto pedal. In other words, if you play a note or
chord on the keyboard and press the pedal while holding the note(s), the notes will sus-
tain as long as the pedal is held. However, all subsequent notes will not sustain. This
makes it possible to sustain a chord, for example, while other notes are played staccato.
SOFT Allows you to use a pedal to control the Soft effect. Pressing this pedal reduces the vol-
ume and changes the timbre of the notes you play. This is effective only for certain
appropriate Voices.
GLIDE When the pedal is pressed, the pitch changes, and then returns to normal pitch when
the pedal is released.
PORTAMENTO The portamento effect (a smooth slide between notes) can be produced while the pedal
is pressed. Portamento is produced when notes are played legato style (i.e., a note is
played while the preceding note is still held). Portamento Time can also be adjusted
from the Mixing Console (page 90). This function does not affect certain Natural Voices,
which would not sound appropriately with this function.
PITCH BEND* Allows you to bend the pitch of notes up or down by using the pedal.
MOD/S.ART1* Applies a vibrato effect to notes played on the keyboard. Moreover, various effects can
be added to the S. Articulation Voice (page 78). The effect becomes deeper when press-
ing down the foot controller. You can turn this function on/off for each keyboard part on
this display.
MOD/S.ART2 (ALT) As a variation on MOD/S.ART1, the effects (waveform) can be switched on/off by the
pedal/footswitch. The effects (waveform) is alternately turned on and off each time the
pedal/footswitch is pressed. You can turn this function on/off for each keyboard part on
this display.
S.ART SW When you use a S. Articulation voice that has an effect assigned to the pedal/foot-
switch, you can enable the effect by pressing the pedal/footswitch. You can turn this
function on/off for each keyboard part on this display.
DSP VARIATION Switches Voice Effect DSP VARIATION on and off.
VIBE ROTOR ON/OFF Switches the VIBRATE SW parameter on and off when the VIBE VIBRATE effect type is
selected.
HARMONY/ECHO Switches the HARMONY/ECHO Voice Effect on and off.
VOCAL HARMONY Switches the Vocal Harmony function on and off.
TALK Switches the MIC SETTING Talk function on and off.
SCORE PAGE+ While the song is stopped, you can turn to the next score page.
SCORE PAGE– While the song is stopped, you can turn to the previous score page.
LYRICS PAGE+ While the song is stopped, you can turn to the next lyrics page.
LYRICS PAGE– While the song is stopped, you can return to the last lyrics page.
TEXT PAGE+ You can turn to the next text page.
TEXT PAGE– You can return to the last text page.
SONG PLAY/PAUSE Same as the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.
STYLE START/STOP Same as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.
TAP TEMPO Same as the [TAP TEMPO] button.
SYNCHRO START Same as the [SYNC START] button.
SYNCHRO STOP Same as the [SYNC STOP] button.
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
193
n The Sostenuto and Portament functions will not affect the Organ Flute Voices, even they have been assigned to the Foot Pedals.
Adjustable Parameters for Each Function
The parameters below correspond to buttons [2
π†
]–[8
π†
], and their availability depends on the selected control
type. For example, if SUSTAIN is selected as the type, the parameters “HALF PEDAL POINT,” “RIGHT 1,” “RIGHT 2”
and “LEFT” automatically appear in the display.
INTRO1–3 Same as the [INTRO I–III] buttons.
MAIN A–D Same as the [MAIN VARIATION A–D] buttons.
FILL DOWN Plays a fill-in, which is automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the
immediate left.
FILL SELF Plays a fill-in.
FILL BREAK Plays a break.
FILL UP Plays a fill-in, which is automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the
immediate right.
ENDING1–3 Same as the [ENDING/rit. I–III] buttons.
FADE IN/OUT Switches Fade In /Fade Out function on and off.
FINGERED/FING ON BASS The pedal alternately switches between the Fingered and On Bass modes (page 107).
BASS HOLD While the pedal is pressed, the Accompaniment Style bass note will be held even if the
chord is changed during Style playback. If the fingering is set to “AI FULL KEYBOARD,
the function does not work.
PERCUSSION The pedal plays a percussion instrument selected by the [4
π†
]–[8
π†
] buttons. You
can use the keyboard to select the desired percussion instrument.
DUAL ON/OFF Same as the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button.
SPLIT ON/OFF Same as the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button.
OTS+ Calls up the next One Touch Setting.
OTS– Calls up the previous One Touch Setting.
SONG, STYLE, MIC, LEFT, RIGHT1,
RIGHT2
These specify the part(s) that will be affected by the pedal.
HALF PEDAL POINT* You can specify how far down you should press on the pedal until the damper or soft
effect (page 192) starts working.
DEPTH Determines the depth of the pedal effect.
UP/DOWN When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines whether the pitch change is
raised or lowered.
RANGE When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines the range of the pitch
change, in semitones. Linked to the Mixing Console Pitch Bend Range (page 90) set-
ting.
ON SPEED When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal
is pressed.
OFF SPEED When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal
is released.
KIT When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all available drum kits are shown here,
letting you select the particular drum kit used for the pedal.
PERCUSSION When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all sounds of the selected drum kit (in KIT
above) are shown here. This determines the particular instrument sound assigned to the
pedal.
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
194
Connecting External MIDI
Devices (7 [MIDI] Terminals)
Use the built-in [MIDI] terminals and standard MIDI
cables to connect external MIDI devices.
For a general overview of MIDI and how you can effec-
tively use it, refer to the following sections:
•What is MIDI?..............................................page 196
•What You Can Do With MIDI.......................page 199
MIDI Settings ...............................................page 200
Connecting a Computer, USB
Device, or Internet (789))
Connecting a Computer
(7 [MIDI] and 8 [USB TO HOST] Terminals)
By connecting a computer to the [USB TO HOST] or
[MIDI] terminals, you can transfer data between the
instrument and the computer via MIDI, and take advan-
tage of sophisticated computer music programs. Keep in
mind that you also need to install an appropriate USB-
MIDI driver.
The instructions below explain how to connect and use
the terminals.
n
If you are using a computer that has a USB interface, we recom-
mend that you connect the computer and the instrument by USB,
rather than by MIDI.
n
Driver
A driver is software that provides a data-transfer interface between
the computer’s operating system and a connected hardware
device. You need to install a USB-MIDI driver to connect the com-
puter and the instrument. Refer to the separate Installation Guide
(page 4).
This explanation is divided into two parts, covering the
two connections: connection to the [USB TO HOST]
terminal and connection to the [MIDI] terminal.
Connecting to the [USB TO HOST] terminal
When connecting the instrument to the computer via
USB, use a standard USB cable (having the USB logo)
to connect the [USB TO HOST] terminal on the
instrument to the USB terminal of the computer. Then,
install the USB-MIDI driver.
n
About the [USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE] terminals
There are two different types of USB terminals on the instrument:
[USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE]. Take care not to confuse
the two terminals and the corresponding cable connectors.
Be careful to connect the proper plug in the proper direction. Expla-
nations on the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal follow in the next section.
n
•The instrument will begin transmission a short time after the
USB connection is made.
•When using a USB cable to connect the instrument to your
computer, make the connection directly without passing
through a USB hub.
•For information on setting up your sequence software, refer to
the owner’s manual of the relevant software.
Connection by [MIDI] terminals
There are two ways to connect the instrument via MIDI
to a computer. If you have a MIDI interface built into
your computer, connect the MIDI OUT terminal of the
computer interface to the [MIDI IN] terminal of the
instrument, and connect the [MIDI OUT] terminal of
the instrument to the MIDI IN terminal of the interface.
MIDI IN Receives MIDI messages from an external
MIDI device.
MIDI OUT Transmits MIDI messages generated by the
instrument.
MIDI THRU Simply relays the MIDI messages received at
MIDI IN.
Instrument
USB cable
CAUTION
Precautions when using the [USB TO HOST] terminal
When connecting the computer to the [USB TO HOST] termi-
nal, make sure to observe the following points. Failing to do so
risks freezing the computer and corrupting or losing data. If the
computer or the instrument freezes, turn the power to the
instrument off and restart the computer.
• Use an AB type USB cable of less than about 3 meters.
• Before connecting the computer to the [USB TO HOST] ter-
minal, exit from any power-saving mode of the computer
(such as suspended, sleep, standby), and quit any open appli-
cation software, also turns off the power to the instrument.
• Execute the following before turning the power to the instru-
ment off or unplugging the USB cable to/from the instrument/
computer.
- Quit any open application software on the computer.
-Make sure that data is not being transmitted from the
instrument. (Data is transmitted only by playing notes on
the keyboard or playing back a song.)
•While a USB device is connected to the instrument, you
should wait for six seconds or more between these
operations: When turning the power of the instrument
off then on again, or when alternately connecting/dis-
connecting the USB cable.
Instrument
MIDI cable
[MIDI IN]
terminal
[MIDI OUT]
terminal
Computer with MIDI
interface installed
[MIDI OUT]
terminal
[MIDI IN]
terminal
Connecting external MIDI devices ([MIDI] terminals)/Connecting a Computer or USB Device
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
195
The second connection possibility involves a separate,
external MIDI interface connected to the computer via a
USB port or a serial port (modem or printer terminal).
Using standard MIDI cables, connect the MIDI OUT ter-
minal of the external interface to the [MIDI IN] terminal
of the instrument, and connect the [MIDI OUT] terminal
of the instrument to the MIDI IN terminal of the interface.
n
Make sure to use the appropriate MIDI interface for your computer.
Connecting to a USB-type LAN Adaptor
and USB Storage Device
(9 via the [USB TO DEVICE] Terminal)
There are two ways of using the [USB TO DEVICE] ter-
minal.
By connecting the USB-type LAN adaptor, you can
directly access special Internet websites for down-
loading music data (page 176).
By connecting the instrument to a USB storage
device with a standard USB cable, you can save data
you’ve created to the connected device, as well as
read data from the connected device.
n
About the [USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE] terminals
There are two different types of USB terminals on the instrument:
[USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE]. Take care not to confuse
the two terminals and the corresponding cable connectors.
Be careful to connect the proper plug in the proper direction.
Explanations on the [USB TO HOST] terminal can be found in the
previous section.
Using USB Storage Devices
This type is used to connect the instrument to a USB
storage device, and allows you to save data you’ve cre-
ated to the connected device, as well as read data from
the connected device. The following description gener-
ally explains about how to connect and use them.
Before using a USB storage device, be sure to read
“Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash Mem-
ory/Floppy Disk, etc)” on page 22.
1 Connect the USB storage device to the [USB TO
DEVICE] terminal with a standard USB cable.
2 After that, exit once from the selection display
then return to the display (or press the Tab
switch buttons [
] and [
®
] simultaneously from
the selection display). The USB tabs (USB 1, USB
2, etc.) are automatically called up, allowing you
to save files and play back music data from the
devices.
n
Checking remaining memory on the USB storage device
You can check this in the display called up by the following oper-
ation:
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
] MEDIA
Select the device by using the [A]/[B] buttons in this display and
press [F] (PROPERTY).
n
Even with a computer connected to the [USB TO HOST] terminal
and a USB storage device connected to the [USB TO DEVICE] ter-
minal, you cannot access the USB storage device from the com-
puter via the instrument.
Instrument
MIDI cable
[MIDI IN]
terminal
[MIDI OUT]
terminal
MIDI interface
Computer
USB port or serial
port (modem or
printer terminal)
Formatting USB storage media
For details, see page 68.
CAUTION
Formatting a USB storage media completely erases all
data on the media. Make sure that the USB storage media
you’re formatting does not contain important data!
Backing up your data to a computer
Backing up the instrument data to a computer
Once you’ve saved data to a USB storage device, you can
copy the data to the hard disk of your computer, then
archive and organize the files as desired. Simply recon-
nect the device as shown below.
Instrument
Instrument
Computer
Computer
USB storage device
USB storage device
USB TO DEVICE terminal
Saves internal data to a USB storage device.
Disconnect the USB storage device from the instrument and
connect it to the computer
Backing up data to a computer and organizing files/folders
Connecting a Computer or USB Device
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
196
Connect to the Internet () [LAN] Port)
There are three ways to use the [LAN] port (located on
the bottom left of the instrument) to access special Inter-
net websites, and download song data, etc.
See page 176 for instructions on connecting.
What is MIDI?
Put simply, MIDI is a data transfer standard that allows
easy and comprehensive control among electronic/digi-
tal music instruments and other devices. To get a better
idea of what MIDI does, let’s first consider acoustic
instruments, such as a grand piano and a classical gui-
tar. With the piano, you strike a key, and a hammer
inside hits some strings and plays a note. With the gui-
tar, you directly pluck a string and the note sounds.
But how does a digital instrument go about playing a
note?
As shown in the illustration above, in an electronic
instrument the sampling note (previously recorded
note) stored in the tone generator section (electronic
circuit) is played based on information received from
the keyboard.
Now, let’s examine what happens when we playback a
recording. When you play back a music CD (for exam-
ple, a solo piano recording), you’re hearing the actual
sound (vibration in air) of the acoustic instrument. This
is called audio data, to distinguish it from MIDI data.
In the above example, the actual acoustic sounds of the
pianist’s performance are captured in the recording as
audio data, and this is recorded to CD. When you play
back that CD on your audio system, you can hear the
actual piano performance. The piano itself is not neces-
sary, since the recording contains the actual sounds of
the piano, and your speakers reproduce them.
Copying files from a computer hard disk to a
USB storage device
Files contained on the hard disk of a computer can be
transferred to the instrument by first copying them to the
storage media, then connecting/inserting the media to the
instrument.
Not only files created on the instrument itself but also
Standard MIDI files and Style File-formatted Style files cre-
ated on other devices can be copied to a USB storage
device from the hard disk of the computer. Once you’ve
copied the data, connect the device to the [USB TO
DEVICE] terminal of the instrument, and play back the
data on the instrument.
Copying the files of the hard disk of the computer to the USB
storage device
Computer
USB storage device
Instrument
Instrument
Computer
USB storage device
Reading files on the USB storage device from the instrument
[USB TO DEVICE] terminal
Disconnect the USB storage
device from the computer an
d
connect it to the instrument
RL
Internal amp
Playing the key board
Internal amp
Tone generator
(Electric circuit)
Acoustic guitar note
production
Digital instrument note pro-
duction
Pluck a string and the
body resonates the
sound.
Based on playing information
from the keyboard, a sampling
note stored in the tone generator
is played through the speakers.
Recording Playback
Recording and playing back the performance of an
acoustic instrument (audio data)
Connecting a Computer or USB Device
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
197
n
In the case of digital instruments, the audio signals are sent
through output jacks (such as [AUX OUT]) on the instrument.
The “controller” and “tone generator” in the illustration
above are equivalent to the piano in our acoustic exam-
ple. Here, the player’s performance on the keyboard is
captured as MIDI song data (see illustration below). In
order to record the audio performance on an acoustic
piano, special recording equipment is needed. How-
ever, since the instrument features a built-in sequencer
that lets you record performance data, this recording
equipment is unnecessary. Instead, your digital instru-
ment—the Clavinova—allows you to both record and
play back the data.
However, we also need a sound source to produce the
audio, which eventually comes from your speakers. The
tone generator of the instrument fills this function. The
recorded performance is reproduced by the sequencer,
playing back the song data, using a tone generator
capable of accurately producing various instrument
sounds—including that of a piano. Looked at in another
way, the relation of the sequencer and the tone genera-
tor is similar to that of the pianist and the piano—one
plays the other. Since digital instruments handle play-
back data and the actual sounds independently, we can
hear our piano performance played by another instru-
ment, such as guitar or violin.
n
Even though it is a single musical instrument, the instrument can
be thought of as containing several electronic components: a con-
troller, a tone generator, and a sequencer.
Finally, we’ll take a look at the actual data that gets
recorded and that serves as the basis for playing the
sounds. For example, let’s say you play a “C” quarter
note using the grand piano sound on the instrument’s
keyboard. Unlike an acoustic instrument that puts out a
resonated note, the electronic instrument puts out infor-
mation from the keyboard such as “with what voice,
“with which key,” “about how strong,” “when was it
pressed” and “when was it released.Then each piece
of information is changed into a number value and sent
to the tone generator. Using these numbers as a basis
for sound generation, the tone generator plays the
stored sampled note.
Example Keyboard Data
Panel operations on the instrument, such as playing the
keyboard and selecting voices, are processed and
stored as MIDI data. The auto accompaniment Styles
and Songs also consist of MIDI data.
MIDI is an acronym that stands for Musical Instrument
Digital Interface, which allows electronic musical
instruments to communicate with each other, by send-
ing and receiving compatible Note, Control Change,
Program Change and various other types of MIDI data,
or messages.
The instrument can control a MIDI device by transmit-
ting note related data and various types of controller
data. The instrument can be controlled by incoming
MIDI messages which automatically determine the tone
generator mode, select MIDI channels, voices and
effects, change parameter values and of course play the
voices specified for the various parts.
n
MIDI data has the following advantages over audio data:
•The amount of data is much less.
•The data can be effectively and easily edited, even to the point
of changing voices and transforming the data.
MIDI messages can be divided into two groups: Chan-
nel messages and System messages.
Channel Messages
The instrument is an electronic instrument that can han-
dle 16 MIDI channels (or reception of 32 channels for
MIDI data reception when using the [USB] terminal).
This is usually expressed as “it can play 16 instruments
at the same time.” Channel messages transmit informa-
tion such as Note ON/OFF, Program Change, for each
of the 16 channels.
Sequencer
Tone Generator
Recording and play back the performance of a digital
instrument (MIDI data)
Controller (keyboard, etc.)
Recording Playback
USB storage
device
USB storage
device
Tone generator
Sequencer
Keyboard performance (MIDI data)
Voice number (with what voice) 01 (grand piano)
Note number (with which key) 60 (C3)
Note on (when was it pressed)
and
note off (when was it released)
Timing expressed
numerically
(quarter note)
Velocity
(strength at which it was played)
120 (strong)
Connecting a Computer or USB Device/What is MIDI
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
198
What is MIDI?
n
The performance data of all Songs and Styles is handled as MIDI
data.
MIDI Channels
MIDI performance data is assigned to one of sixteen
MIDI channels. Using these channels, 1–16, the perfor-
mance data for sixteen different instrument parts can be
simultaneously sent over one MIDI cable.
Think of the MIDI channels as TV channels. Each TV
station transmits its broadcasts over a specific channel.
Your home TV set receives many different programs
simultaneously from several TV stations and you select
the appropriate channel to watch the desired program.
MIDI operates on the same basic principle. The trans-
mitting instrument sends MIDI data on a specific MIDI
channel (MIDI Transmit Channel) via a single MIDI
cable to the receiving instrument. If the receiving instru-
ment’s MIDI channel (MIDI Receive Channel) matches
the Transmit Channel, the receiving instrument will
sound according to the data sent by the transmitting
instrument.
n
The instrument’s keyboard and internal tone generator are also
connected by MIDI. LOCAL CONTROL (page 202)
For example, several parts or channels can be transmit-
ted simultaneously, including the Style data (as shown
below).
Example: Recording a performance with the auto accompa-
niment (Style playback) sound of the instrument to an exter-
nal sequencer
As you can see, it is essential to determine which data is
to be sent over which MIDI channel when transmitting
MIDI data (page 202).
The instrument also allows you to determine how the
received data is played back (page 203).
System Messages
This is data that is used in common by the entire MIDI
system. These include System Exclusive messages for
transferring data unique to each instrument manufac-
turer and Realtime messages for controlling the MIDI
device.
The messages transmitted/received by the instrument
are shown in the MIDI Data Format and MIDI Imple-
mentation Chart in the separate Data List.
Message Name Operation/Panel Setting
Note ON/OFF Messages which are generated when
the keyboard is played. Each mes-
sage includes a specific note num-
ber which corresponds to the key
which is pressed, plus a velocity
value based on how hard the key is
played.
Program Change For selecting Voices (with control
change bank select MSB/LSB set-
tings)
Control Change Volume, panpot (Mixing Console),
etc.
1
2
2
NEWS
Weather report
NEWS
MIDI Transmit channel 2 MIDI Receive channel 2
MIDI
cable
Message Name Operation/Panel Setting
System Exclusive
Message
Effect type settings (Mixing Console),
etc.
Realtime Messages Clock setting,
Start/stop operation
MIDI cable
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 3
Channel 4
Channel 5
Channel 6
Channel 7
Channel 8
Channel 9
Channel 10
Channel 11
Tra ck 1
Tra ck 2
Tra ck 3
Tra ck 4
Tra ck 5
Tra ck 6
Tra ck 7
Tra ck 8
Tra ck 9
Tra ck 10
Tra ck 11
RIGHT 1
RIGHT 2
LEFT
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
STYLE instrument
Clavinova track (channnel)
External sequencer
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
199
What You Can Do With MIDI
What You Can Do With MIDI
Record your performance data (1–16 channels) using
the instrument’s auto accompaniment features on an
external sequencer (or computer with sequencer
software). After recording, edit the data with the
sequencer, then play it back on the instrument.
When you want to use the instrument as an XG-com-
patible multi-timbral tone generator, set the receive part
for MIDI channels 1–16 to “SONG” in MIDI/USB 1 in
MIDI Receive (page 203).
Controlling from an external MIDI keyboard
MIDI Data Compatibility
This section covers basic information on data compati-
bility: whether or not other MIDI devices can playback
the data recorded by CVP-409/407, and whether or not
the CVP-409/407 can playback commercially available
song data or song data created for other instruments or
on a computer. Depending on the MIDI device or data
characteristics, you may be able to play back the data
without any problem, or you may have to perform some
special operations before the data can be played back.
If you run into problems playing back data, please refer
to the information below.
Sequence Formats
Song data is recorded and stored in a variety of different
systems, referred to as “sequence formats.
Playback is only possible when the sequence format of
the Song data matches that of the MIDI device. The
CVP-409/407 is compatible with the following formats.
SMF (Standard MIDI file)
This is the most common sequence format. Standard
MIDI Files are generally available as one of two types:
Format 0 or Format 1. Many MIDI devices are compati-
ble with Format 0, and most commercially available
software is recorded as Format 0.
•The CVP-409/407 is compatible with both Format 0
and Format 1.
• Song data recorded on the CVP-409/407 is automati-
cally saved as SMF Format 0.
ESEQ
This sequence format is compatible with many of
Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series
instruments. This is a common format used with various
Yamaha software.
•The CVP-409/407 is compatible with ESEQ.
XF
The Yamaha XF format enhances the SMF (Standard
MIDI File) standard with greater functionality and open-
ended expandability for the future. The instrument is
capable of displaying lyrics when an XF file containing
lyric data is played. (SMF is the most common format
used for MIDI sequence files. The instrument is compat-
ible with SMF Formats 0 and 1, and records “song” data
using SMF Format 0.)
Style File
The Style File Format combines all of Yamaha’s auto
accompaniment know-how into a single unified format.
Voice Allocation Format
With MIDI, Voices are assigned to specific numbers,
called “program numbers.The numbering standard
(order of voice allocation) is referred to as the “voice
allocation format.
Voices may not play back as expected unless the voice
allocation format of the song data matches that of the
compatible MIDI device used for playback. The instru-
ment is compatible with the following formats.
n
Even if the devices and data used satisfy all the conditions above,
the data may still not be completely compatible, depending on the
specifications of the devices and particular data recording meth-
ods.
GM System Level 1
This is one of the most common voice allocation for-
mats.
Many MIDI devices are compatible with GM System
Level 1, as is most commercially available software.
GM System Level 2
“GM System Level 2” is a standard specification that
enhances the original “GM System Level 1” and
improves Song data compatibility. It provides for
increased polyphony, greater voice selection, expanded
voice parameters, and integrated effect processing.
XG
XG is a major enhancement of the GM System Level 1
format, and was developed by Yamaha specifically to
provide more Voices and variations, as well as greater
expressive control over Voices and effects, and to
ensure compatibility of data well into the future.
Song data recorded on the CVP-409/407 using Voices
in the XG category is XG-compatible.
DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection)
This voice allocation format is compatible with many of
Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series
instruments.
GS
GS was developed by the Roland Corporation.
In the same way as Yamaha XG, GS is a major enhance-
ment of the GM specifically to provide more Voices and
Drum kits and their variations, as well as greater expres-
sive control over Voices and effects.
MIDI IN MIDI OUT
MIDI OUT MIDI IN
Instrument
MIDI receive
MIDI transmit Computer or
Sequencer
MIDI IN MIDI OUT
Instrument
MIDI receive
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
200
MIDI Settings
MIDI Settings
In this section, you can make MIDI-related settings for
the instrument. The instrument gives you a set of ten
pre-programmed templates that let you instantly and
easily reconfigure the instrument to match your particu-
lar MIDI application or external device. Also, you can
edit the pre-programmed templates and save up to ten
of your original templates to the USER display. You can
then save all these original templates as a single file to
USB storage devices, in the MIDI SETUP selection dis-
play (called up by pressing [FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY
TAB [
®
] SYSTEM RESET).
Basic Operation
1 Call up the operation (MIDI template selection)
display.
Function
[I] MIDI
2 To use the pre-programmed templates or to edit
them
Press the TAB [
] button to select the PRESET dis-
play. Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a MIDI
template.
To use the templates already saved to the USER
display or to edit them
Press the TAB [
®
] button to select the USER display.
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a MIDI tem-
plate.
3 To edit a template, press the [8
] (EDIT) but-
ton to call up the MIDI display for editing.
The individual parameters settings are shown for the
selected template. Here you can edit each parame-
ter.
4 Use the TAB [
]/[
®
] buttons to call up the rele-
vant setting display.
5 When you’ve finished editing, press the [EXIT]
button to return to the MIDI template selection
display (PRESET or USER).
6 Select the USER tab display to save the data by
using the TAB [
][
®
] buttons (page 69).
SYSTEM display MIDI System Settings (page 202)
TRANSMIT display MIDI Transmission Settings
(page 202)
RECEIVE display MIDI Reception Settings (page 203)
BASS display Settings for the bass note of chord
for Style playback via MIDI recep-
tion data (page 203)
CHORD DETECT
display
Settings for the chord type for Style
playback via MIDI reception data
(
page 204)
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
201
MIDI Settings
Pre-Programmed MIDI Templates
Template name Description
All Parts Transmits all parts including the keyboard parts (RIGHT1, 2,and LEFT), with the excep-
tion of Song parts.
KBD & STYLE Basically the same as “All Parts” with the exception of how keyboard parts are man-
aged. The right-hand parts are handled as “UPPER” instead of RIGHT 1 and 2 and the
left-hand part is handled as “LOWER.
Master KBD In this setting, the instrument functions as a “master” keyboard, playing and controlling
one or more connected tone generators or other devices (such as a computer/
sequencer).
Song All transmit channels are set to correspond to Song channels 1–16. This is used to play
Song data with an external tone generator and to record Song data to an external
sequencer.
Clock Ext Playback (Song or Style) synchronizes with an external MIDI clock instead of the instru-
ment’s internal clock. This template should be used when you wish to set the tempo on
the MIDI device connected to the instrument.
MIDI Accord 1 MIDI accordions allow you to transmit MIDI data and play connected tone generators
from the keyboard and bass/chord buttons of the accordion. This template lets you play
melodies from the keyboard and control Style playback on the instrument with the left-
hand buttons.
MIDI Accord 2 Basically the same as “MIDI Accord1” above, with the exception that the chord/bass
notes you play with your left hand on the MIDI Accordion are recognized also as MIDI
note events.
MIDI Pedal 1 MIDI pedal units allow you play connected tone generators with your feet (especially
convenient for playing single note bass parts). This template lets you play/control the
chord root in Style playback with a MIDI pedal unit.
MIDI Pedal 2 This template lets you play the bass part for Style playback by using a MIDI pedal unit.
MIDI OFF No MIDI signals are sent or received.
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
202
MIDI Settings
MIDI System Settings
The explanations here apply to the SYSTEM display to
be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on
page 200.
LOCAL CONTROL
Turns the Local Control for each part on or off. When
Local Control is set to “ON,” the keyboard of the instru-
ment controls its own (local) internal tone generator,
allowing the internal voices to be played directly from the
keyboard. If you set Local to “OFF,” the keyboard and
controllers are internally disconnected from the instru-
ment’s tone generator section so that no sound is output
when you play the keyboard or use the controllers. For
example, this allows you to use an external MIDI
sequencer to play the instrument’s internal voices, and
use the instrument keyboard to record notes to the exter-
nal sequencer and/or play an external tone generator.
Clock setting, etc.
CLOCK
Determines whether the instrument is controlled by its
own internal clock or a MIDI clock signal received from
an external device. INTERNAL is the normal Clock setting
when the instrument is being used alone or as a master
keyboard to control external devices. If you are using the
instrument with an external sequencer, MIDI computer,
or other MIDI device, and you want to synchronize it to
that device, set this parameter to the appropriate setting:
MIDI, USB 1, or USB 2. In this case, make sure that the
external device is connected properly (e.g., to the instru-
ment’s MIDI IN terminal), and that it is properly transmit-
ting a MIDI clock signal. When this is set for control by
an external device (MIDI, USB 1 or USB 2), the Tempo is
indicated as “Ext.” in the Main display.
TRANSMIT CLOCK
Turns MIDI clock (F8) transmission on or off. When set
to OFF, no MIDI clock or Start/Stop data is transmitted
even if a Song or Style is played back.
RECEIVE TRANSPOSE
Determines whether or not the instrument's transpose
setting (page 58) is applied to the note events received
by the instrument via MIDI.
START/STOP
Determines whether incoming FA (start) and FC (stop)
messages affect Song or Style playback.
MESSAGE SW
SYS/EX.
The “Tx” setting turns MIDI transmission of MIDI Sys-
tem Exclusive messages on or off. The “Rx” setting turns
MIDI reception and recognition of MIDI System Exclu-
sive messages generated by external equipment on or
off.
CHORD SYS/EX.
The “Tx” setting turns MIDI transmission of MIDI chord
exclusive data (chord detect. root and type) on or off.
The “Rx” setting turns MIDI reception and recognition
of MIDI chord exclusive data generated by external
equipment on or off.
MIDI Transmit Settings
The explanations here apply to the TRANSMIT display
to be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on
page 200. This determines which parts will be sent as
MIDI data and over which MIDI channel the data will
be sent.
Operation
Select the part to be transmitted and the channel via
which the selected part will be transmitted. You can also
determine the types of data to be sent.
With the exception of the two parts below, the
configuration of the parts is the same as those
already explained elsewhere in this manual.
UPPER
The keyboard part played on the right side of the key-
board from the Split Point for the Voices (RIGHT1 and/
or 2).
LOWER
The keyboard part played on the left side of the keyboard
from the Split Point for the Voices. This is not affected by
the on/off status of the [ACMP ON/OFF] button.
Tx MONITOR
The dots corresponding to each channel (1–16) flash
briefly whenever any data is transmitted on the chan-
nel(s).
SYSTEM display
TRANSMIT display
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
203
MIDI Settings
n
When different parts are assigned to the same transmit channel
If the same transmit channel is assigned to several different parts,
the transmitted MIDI messages are merged to a single channel—
resulting in unexpected sounds and possible glitches in the con-
nected MIDI device.
n
About the protected Songs
Write-protected Songs cannot be transmitted even if the proper
Song channels 1–16 are set to be transmitted.
MIDI messages which can be transmitted or
received (recognized)
The following MIDI messages can be set on the TRANS-
MIT/RECEIVE display.
Note (Note events).......................................page 164
CC (CONTROL CHANGE) ..........................page 164
PC (PROGRAM CHANGE)...........................page 164
PB (Pitch Bend)............................................page 164
•AT (Aftertouch).............................................page 164
MIDI Receive Settings
The explanations here apply to the RECEIVE display to be
called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on page 200.
This determines which parts will receive MIDI data and
over which MIDI channels the data will be received.
Operation
Select the channel to be received and the part via which
the selected channel will be received. You can also
determine the types of data to be received.
The instrument can receive MIDI messages over
32 channels (16 channels x 2 ports) by USB con-
nection.
With the exception of the two parts below, the
configuration of the parts is the same as those
already explained elsewhere in this manual.
KEYBOARD
The received note messages control the instrument’s
keyboard performance.
EXTRA PART 1–5
There are five parts specially reserved for receiving
and playing MIDI data. Normally, these parts are not
used by the instrument itself. The instrument can be
used as a 32-channel multi-timbral tone generator by
using these five parts in addition to the general parts
(except for the microphone sound).
Rx MONITOR
The dots corresponding to each channel (1–16) flash
briefly whenever any data is received on the channel(s).
n Parameter Lock
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split
point, etc.) to make them selectable only via the panel
controls (page 132).
MIDI transmission/reception via the USB ter-
minal and MIDI terminals
The relationship between the [MIDI] terminals and the
[USB] terminal which can be used for transmitting/
receiving 32 channels (16 channels x 2 ports) of the
MIDI messages is as follows:
Setting the Bass Note for Style Playback
via MIDI Receive
The explanations here apply to the BASS display to be
called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on
page 200.
These settings let you determine the bass note for Style
playback, based on the note messages received via
MIDI. The note on/off messages received at the chan-
nel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the bass note of the
chord of Style playback. The bass note will be detected
regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] or split point set-
tings. When several channels are simultaneously set to
“ON,” the bass note is detected from merged MIDI data
received over the channels.
Operation
Select the channel and set the “ON/OFF” for that chan-
nel. Use the All OFF item to set all channels to OFF.
RECEIVE display
MIDI/USB1
01–16
USB2
01–16
USB2USB1
MIDI/USB 01–16
[MIDI IN] jack
MIDI reception MIDI transmission
[USB TO
HOST] jack
[MIDI OUT] jack
[USB TO
HOST] jack
Port
handling
Merge
Merge
BASS display
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
204
MIDI Settings
Setting the Chord Type for Style Play-
back via MIDI Receive
The explanations here apply to the CHORD DETECT
display to be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Opera-
tion” on page 200.
These settings let you determine the chord type for Style
playback, based on the note messages received via
MIDI. The note on/off messages received at the chan-
nel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the notes for
detecting chords in Style playback. The chords to be
detected depend on the fingering type. The chord type
will be detected regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] or
split point settings. When several channels are simulta-
neously set to “ON,” the chord type is detected from
merged MIDI data received over the channels.
The operation procedure is basically the same as that of
the BASS display above.
CHORD DETECT display
Displaying the Voice Program Change Number
Determines whether or not the Voice bank and number
are shown in the Voice selection display. This is useful
when you want to check which bank select MSB/LSB val-
ues and program change number you need to specify
when selecting the Voice from an external MIDI device.
You can set this in the display called up by the following
operations: [FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [
][
®
]
CONFIG 2. Switch the DISPLAY VOICE NUMBER menu
ON and OFF.
n
•The numbers displayed here start from “1.” Accordingly the
actual MIDI program change numbers are one lower, since
that number system starts from “0.
For the GS Voices, this feature is not available (the program
change numbers are not shown).
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
205
Appendix
Troubleshooting
The instrument does not turn on.
Securely insert the female plug into the socket on the
instrument, and the male plug into a proper AC outlet.
A click or pop is heard when the power is turned on
or off.
Electrical current is being applied to the instrument. This
is normal.
Noise is heard from the instrument’s speakers.
Noise may be heard if a mobile phone is used near the
instrument or if the phone is ringing. Turn off the mobile
phone, or use it further away from the instrument.
The letters in the display cannot be read, because the
display is too bright (or dark).
Use the [LCD CONTRAST] knob to adjust for optimum
visibility.
Adjust the brightness of the display (page 19).
The overall volume is too low, or, no sound is heard.
•The master volume may be set too low. Set it to an
appropriate level with the [MASTER VOLUME] dial.
•The volume of the individual parts may be set too low.
Raise the volume in the BALANCE display (page 40).
Make sure the desired channel is set to ON (page 109).
Headphones are connected, disabling the speaker out-
put. (This happens when the speaker setting is set to
“HEADPHONE SW”; page 17.) Unplug the headphones.
Make sure the speaker setting is set to ON (page 17).
•The Fade-In and Fade-Out function is on, muting the
sound. To turn it off, press the pedal to which you
assigned the Fade In/Out function.
Make sure the Local Control function is set to ON
(page 202).
Not all simultaneously played notes sound.
•You are probably exceeding the maximum polyphony
(page 217) of the instrument. When the maximum
polyphony is exceeded, the earliest played notes will
stop sounding, letting the latest played notes sound.
The keyboard volume is lower than the Song/Style
playback volume.
•The volume of the keyboard parts may be set too low.
Raise the volume in the BALANCE display (page 40).
Keys do not sound at the proper pitch.
Make sure the Performance Assistant function is off on
the operation display (page 43).
Certain notes sound at the wrong pitch.
The Scale parameter has probably been set to some-
thing other than “Equal,” changing the tuning system of
the keyboard. Make sure “Equal” is selected as the
Scale in the Scale Tune display (page 84).
- There is a slight difference in sound quality among
different notes played on the keyboard.
- Some Voices have a looping sound.
- Some noise or vibrato is noticeable at higher
pitches, depending upon the voice.
•This is normal and is a result of the instrument’s sam-
pling system.
Some Voices will jump an octave in pitch when played
in the upper or lower registers.
•This is normal. Some voices have a pitch limit which,
when reached, causes this type of pitch shift.
The Main display does not appear even when turning
the power on.
•This may occur if a USB storage device has been
installed to the instrument. Installation of some USB stor-
age device may result a long interval between turning
the power on and appearance of the Main display. To
avoid this, turn the power on after disconnecting the
device.
The main background image from the CD-ROM is not
displayed.
•This is because the Main display is loaded prior to load-
ing of the image from the CD-ROM. To remedy this,
copy the image data from the CD-ROM to the User dis-
play, then set it as the main background image (page 19).
The damper, sostenuto and soft functions do not
work for the relevant pedals.
•The pedal cord plug is not connected. Securely insert the
pedal cord plug into the proper jack (page 211, 214).
Each pedal has been assigned to a different function.
Make sure that each pedal is properly assigned to SUS-
TAIN, SOSTENUTO, and SOFT (page 191).
Make sure the Registration Sequence function is set to
OFF (page 135).
Some characters of the file/folder name are garbled.
•The language settings have been changed. Set the appro-
priate language for the file/folder name (page 18).
An existing file is not shown.
•The file extension (.MID, etc.) may have been changed
or deleted. Manually rename the file, adding the appro-
priate extension, on a computer.
The data contained in the USB storage device is not
shown on the instrument itself.
Data files with names of more than 50 characters cannot
be handled by the instrument. Rename the file, reducing
the number of characters to 50 or less.
Overall
Pedals
Files/Folders
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
206
Appendix
How can I stop the demo?
Press the [EXIT] button.
The Voice selected from the Voice Selection display
does not sound.
Check whether or not the selected part is turned on
(page 79).
•To select the Voice for the right-hand key range, make
sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)]
buttons are off. For the Voice to be layered in the right-
hand range, press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]
button. To select the Voice for the left-hand key range,
press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button.
A strange “flanging” or “doubling” sound occurs. The
sound is slightly different each time the keys are played.
•The RIGHT 1 and RIGHT 2 parts are set to “ON,” and
both parts are set to play the same Voice. Turn off the
RIGHT 2 part or change the Voice of one of the parts.
The sound seems strange or different than expected
when changing a rhythm Voice (drum kit, etc.) of the
Style or Song from the Mixer.
When changing the rhythm/percussion Voices (drum
kits, etc.) of the Style and Song from the VOICE parame-
ter, the detailed settings related to the drum voice are
reset, and in some cases you may be unable to restore
the original sound. In the case of Song playback, you
can restore the original sound by returning to the begin-
ning of the Song and playing back from that point. In the
case of Style play, you can restore the original sound by
selecting the same Style again.
Tremolo/Trill cannot be applied to the Organ Flute
Voice.
•This is normal; Tremolo and Trill settings in the Harmony/
Echo display are not effective for Organ Flute Voices.
The Harmony function does not operate.
Harmony cannot be used with the AI Fingered or AI Full
Keyboard fingering modes. Select an appropriate finger-
ing mode (page 107).
When a Voice is changed, the previously selected
effect is changed.
Each Voice has its own suitable preset settings, which are
automatically recalled when the corresponding Voice
Set parameters are turned on (page 106).
The Voice produces excessive noise.
Certain Voices may produce noise, depending on the
Harmonic Content and/or Brightness settings in the FIL-
TER page of the Mixing Console display (page 90).
The sound is distorted or noisy.
•The volume may be turned up too high. Make sure all
relevant volume settings are appropriate.
•This may be caused by certain effects. Try canceling all
unnecessary effects, especially distortion-type effects
(page 92).
Adjust the sound using the [8
π†
] (TOTAL GAIN ADJ.)
buttons from the display shown in step 6 of “Editing and
Saving the selected EQ” (page 95) , if you are using the
Master EQ.
Some filter resonance settings in the VOICE SET display
(page 101) can result in distorted sound. Adjust these
settings if necessary.
Noise may occur depending on the settings made in the
Filter display of the Mixing Console. Adjust the Har-
monic Content or Brightness controls in the Filter display
(page 90).
The sound does not change when replacing Voices
with the Song Auto Revoice feature.
Depending on the particular Song data, there are some
instances where Song Auto Revoice has no effect, even
when replacing Voices.
The sound of the Voice doesn’t change, even when
editing the Voice.
•Keep in mind that adjustments made to the parameters
may not make much change in the actual sound depend-
ing on the original settings of the Voice.
Voices other than those in the Preset display cannot
be selected for Step recording.
•This is normal.
Style playback does not start.
Make sure to press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP]
button.
MIDI Clock may be set to “EXTERNAL.” Make sure this is
set to “INTERNAL” (page 202).
Only the rhythm channel plays.
Make sure the Auto Accompaniment function is turned
on; press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button.
•You may be playing keys in the right hand range of the
keyboard. Make sure to play keys in the chord range of
the keyboard.
Styles cannot be selected.
If the size of the Style data is large (about 120 KB or
greater), the Style cannot be selected because the data is
too large to be ready by the instrument.
The desired chord is not recognized or output by the
auto accompaniment.
•You may not be playing the correct keys for indicating
the chord. Refer to “Chord Types Recognized in the Fin-
gered Mode” of the separate Data List.
•You may be playing the keys according to a different fin-
gering mode, and not the one currently selected. Check
the accompaniment mode, and play the keys according
to the selected mode (page 108).
Synchro Stop cannot be turned on.
Synchro Stop cannot be turned on when the fingering
mode is set to “Full Keyboard” or “AI Full Keyboard,” or
when Style On/Off is set to off. Make sure the fingering
mode is set to something besides “Full Keyboard” or “Al
Full Keyboard” and set Style On/Off to on.
Demo
Voice
Style
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
207
Appendix
Auto accompaniment chords are recognized regard-
less of the split point or where chords are played on
the keyboard.
•This is normal if the fingering mode is set to “Full Key-
board” or “AI Full Keyboard.” If either of these is
selected, chords are recognized over the entire range of
the keyboard, irrespective of the split point setting. If
desired, select a different fingering mode (page 108).
When playing back one Style and selecting another,
the newly selected Style doesn’t play at the proper
Tempo.
•You can select whether the appropriate tempo will be
called up automatically or not by using the TEMPO
parameter in the STYLE CHANGE BEHAVIOR function.
Starting a Song while playing back a Style stops Style
playback.
This is because Song playback has priority. The two ways
shown below let you play back a Style and Song simulta-
neously.
Set the Song to Synchro Start standby, then start the
Style.
Start the Style playback after playing back a Song.
The level balance of the various Parts becomes wrong
or unexpected sounds are output when selecting a
Style or a Voice after selecting a Song.
•The level balance of the Parts can change and unex-
pected sounds can be produced because of the effects
applied to each Part.
The “Off” setting is not shown for the Play Type
parameter in the Assembly (Style Creator) feature.
•The selected section is set to record enable. Release the
recording assignment by pressing the appropriate [1
]–
[8
] button in the recording channel display (TAB [
]
button BASIC tab [F] REC CH).
The channels BASS-PHR2 cannot be edited in Channel
Edit.
•This is normal; BASS-PHR2 channels of the Preset Styles
cannot be edited.
The Song/Style registered to the Registration Mem-
ory cannot be called up.
If the registered Song/Style is contained on USB storage
device and the USB storage device is not inserted or
connected to the instrument, the Song/Style cannot be
called up. Insert or connect the appropriate USB storage
device containing the Song/Style data.
The order for calling up Registration Memory settings
is not shown on the Registration Sequence setting
display.
•The bank containing the Registration has not been
selected. Select the appropriate bank (page 132).
When using the Freeze function of the Registration
Memory, the On/Off setting of the Left Part does not
change even when changing the Registration Mem-
ory setting.
•The Left Part On/Off setting is included in the Style
group. Remove the checkmark from “STYLE” in the
Freeze setting display (page 133).
Even though a Registration Memory setting contain-
ing a User/USB voice is selected, the File Selection dis-
play shows a Preset Voice.
•This is normal; even with the Preset Voice shown, the
actual sounding Voice is the selected User/USB Voice.
When a User/USB Voice is saved to the User/USB drive,
the actual data is divided into two separate types: 1) the
source Preset Voice itself, and 2) the parameter settings
as set in the Sound Creator. When you recall a Registra-
tion Memory setting containing a User/USB Voice, the
instrument selects the Preset voice (on which the User/
USB Voice is based), then applies the relevant parameter
settings to it—so that your original User/USB Voice is
sounded.
Songs cannot be selected.
•This may be because the language settings have been
changed. Set the appropriate language for the Song file
name.
If the size of the Song data is large (about 300 KB or
greater), the Song cannot be selected because the data is
too large to be read by the instrument.
Song playback does not start.
“New Song” (a blank Song) has been selected. Make
sure to select an appropriate Song in the Song Selection
display (page 35).
Make sure to press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.
•The Song has been stopped at the end of the Song data.
Return to the beginning of the Song by pressing the
SONG [STOP] button.
In the case a Song to which write-protect has been
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the
Song name), the original file may not be in the same
folder. It cannot be played back unless the original file
(showing “Prot.2 Orig” at the upper left of the Song
name) is in the same folder.
In case of a Song to which write-protect has been
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the
Song name), the original file name may have been
changed. Rename the file with the original file name (so
that “Prot.2 Orig” is shown at the upper left of the Song
name).
In case of a Song to which write-protect has been
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the
Song name), the file icon may have been changed. Songs
to which write-protect has been applied cannot be
played back when the file icon of the original has been
changed.
MIDI Clock may be set to “EXTERNAL.” Make sure this is
set to “INTERNAL” (page 202).
Registration memory
Song
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
208
Appendix
Song playback stops before the Song is finished.
•The Guide function is turned on. (In this case, playback
is “waiting” for the correct key to be played.) Press the
[GUIDE] button to turn off the guide function.
The Song last selected before turning off the power is
no longer available.
If the Song last selected before turning off the power is
contained in USB storage device, you’ll need to reinsert/
reconnect the same USB storage device to call up the
Song again.
The measure number is different from that of the
score in the Song Position display, shown by pressing
the [REW]/[FF] buttons.
•This happens when playing back music data for which a
specific, fixed tempo is set.
In the AB Repeat function, the B point cannot be set.
•The A point has not been set. Set the B point only after
setting the A point.
When playing back a Song, some channels do not
play.
Playback of these channels may be set to “OFF.Turn
playback on for those channels that are set to “OFF”
(page 143).
A Song to which write-protect has been applied
(“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the Song
name) cannot be moved to external media such as a
SmartMedia card or floppy disk.
•A Song to which write-protect has been applied cannot
be moved to an external media such as SmartMedia/
floppy disk, etc. Use the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal to
move the song to a USB flash memory device connected
to this instrument.
The Tuning Curve of the piano Voice does not quite
match that of other instruments’ Voices.
•The Tuning Curve designed especially for piano Voices
may not sound with the appropriate pitches when used
with other instrument Voices. Set the Tuning Curve to
“FLAT” (page 100).
The melody still plays back, even when specifying Track
1 as the part to be muted for one-handed practice.
•A part other than the melody part has been assigned to
Track 1. Reassign the channel containing the melody to
Track 1 (page 142).
The Guide lamps do not light during Song playback,
even after pressing the [GUIDE] button.
Make sure to turn on the Guide lamps (page 141).
•Any notes outside of the 88-key range cannot be indi-
cated by the Guide lamps.
The Guide lamps light an octave or two lower/higher
than the actual pitch.
•The Guide lamps sometimes light an octave or two
lower/higher than the actual pitch depending on the
selected Voice.
The lamps in the chord section of the keyboard light.
•The Guide function for chords (page 50) has been
enabled. Turn the Style off by pressing the [ACMP ON/
OFF] button.
The Guide lamps do not indicate how to play chords.
Make sure that the Guide Mode is set to “FollowLights”
(page 50).
•You cannot check how to play chords with the Guide
lamps if the chord fingering method is set to “Single Fin-
ger,” “Full Keyboard” or “AI Full Keyboard.” Select
another fingering method (page 108).
When displaying the music score, long notes that
have been entered, such as whole notes and ties, are
not displayed correctly.
Long notes, such as whole notes and ties, may not be
shown in the music score display exactly as they were
entered. Selecting “Tenuto” by pressing the [H] button
before inputting each note in the Step Record display
(page 149) may solve the problem.
The tempo, beat, measure and music notation is not
displayed correctly.
Some Song data for the instrument has been recorded
with special “free tempo” settings. For such Song data,
the tempo, beat, measure and music notation will not be
displayed correctly.
The note name partially obscures the note in the dis-
play.
When several notes occur close to each other, the note
name may obscure the note at left.
The music score of the right-hand/left-hand part is
not displayed.
•The appropriate channels have not been assigned to the
right-hand and left-hand parts. Set RIGHT and LEFT to
the appropriate channels (page 39).
The notation in the display is cut off, with the middle
of a measure starting on the next line.
When all the notes of a measure cannot fit on one line,
the remaining notes in the measure are carried over to
the next line.
Dotted notes are indicated as rests.
•This is normal; sometimes dotted notes are indicated as
rests.
Chords are not displayed.
If the selected Song does not contain chord data, chords
are not displayed.
Guide
Score
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
209
Appendix
Lyrics are not displayed.
If the selected Song does not contain lyric data, lyrics are
not displayed.
Some of the lyrics overlap each other.
•This happens for Songs containing many lyrics.
The Lyrics Background setting cannot be changed.
When the background color is specified in the song
data, the Lyrics Background setting cannot be changed.
Performance assistant technology does not work
appropriately.
Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop Song playback,
then set the [ACMP ON/OFF] and PART ON/OFF [LEFT]
to off. Finally, restart the Song.
The instrument display contents cannot be sent via
video out/RGB out and do not show on an external
monitor.
Make sure that the NTSC/PAL/RGB setting corresponds
to the standard of your particular equipment (page 56).
Some flashing parallel lines appear in the TV, video,
or computer monitor.
Occasionally some flashing parallel lines may appear in
the television, video, or computer. This does not neces-
sarily indicate that the monitor is malfunctioning. For
optimum results, try adjusting the color settings on the
monitor itself.
The monitor you are using may not show the instru-
ment's display contents as expected.
•Keep in mind that even after adjusting all settings as rec-
ommended, the monitor you are using may not show the
instrument's display contents as expected (e.g., the dis-
play contents may not fit on the screen, the characters
may not be completely clear, or the colors may be incor-
rect).
The microphone input signal cannot be recorded.
•The microphone input signal cannot be recorded by
Song/Style recording. Use the USB Audio Recorder func-
tion (page 60). Furthermore, you can connect a recorder
to the output terminals [AUX OUT, AUX OUT (LEVEL
FIXED) and record the microphone signal.
Harmony can be heard in addition to the microphone
sound.
•Vocal Harmony is set to “ON.Turn Vocal Harmony off
(page 57).
The Vocal Harmony effect sounds distorted or out-of-
tune.
Your vocal microphone may be picking up extraneous
sounds, such as the Style sound from the instrument. In
particular, bass sounds can cause mistracking of the Vocal
Harmony. To remedy this:
Sing as closely to the microphone as possible.
Use a directional microphone.
•Turn down the Master volume, Style volume, or Song
volume control (page 40).
Separate the microphone from the external speakers as
much as possible.
Cut the Low band via the 3 Band EQ function in the
MICROPHONE SETTING display (page 171).
Raise the microphone input level (TH) via the Com-
pressor function in the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-
play (page 172).
Appropriate harmony notes are not produced by the
Vocal Harmony feature.
Make sure you are using the appropriate method to
specify the harmony notes for the current Vocal Har-
mony mode (page 173).
The message “This drive is busy now.” appeared, and
then the recording was aborted.
Make sure to use a compatible USB flash memory
(page 22).
Make sure that the USB flash memory has enough mem-
ory (page 195).
If you are using a USB flash memory to which data has
already been recorded, check first that no important data
remains on the device, then format it (page 68) and try
recording again.
Lyrics (Karaoke)
Performance assistant technology
Video out/RGB out
Microphone/Vocal harmony
USB Audio Recorder
Appendix
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
210
CVP-409 grand piano type: Keyboard Stand Assembly
CAUTION
Be careful not to confuse parts, and be sure to install all
parts in the correct orientation. Please assemble in accor-
dance with the sequence given below.
Assembly should be carried out by at least two persons.
Be sure to use the correct screw size, as indicated below.
Use of incorrect screws can damage the stand.
Be sure to tighten all screws upon completing the assem-
bly of each unit.
•To disassemble, reverse the assembly sequence given
below.
The CVP-409 grand piano type features an iAFC (Instru-
mental Active Field Control) effect. This produces sound
from the speaker located on the bottom face of the
Clavinova, enhancing the reverberation and spacious-
ness of the sound when you open the lid with the longer
stay (page 16).
In order to optimize the iAFC effect, please observe the
following:
•Perform the automatic adjustment after you turn on
the power of the Clavinova for the first time, and after
each time you re-locate the Clavinova. (page 176)
• Do not block the speaker located on the bottom face
of the Clavinova.
1 Remove all parts from the box. Confirm that all
parts shown in the illustration are included.
How to position the main unit
Spread a large soft cloth, such as a blanket, on the floor.
Place the unit on the cloth with the key cover closed
and the keyboard side on the bottom and lean the unit
against the wall so that the unit will not fall or slip.
Place a soft cloth against the wall to protect the instru-
ment and the wall from scratches.
Have a Phillips-head (+) screwdriver ready.
TIP
Lean the unit against the
wall as shown at right.
Legs Pedal box 6 × 40 mm fixing
screws × 12
AC power cord Cord holder 6 × 20 mm fixing
screws × 4
Main unit
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
CAUTION
Do not place the main unit with
the rear side facing down.
CAUTION
Do not lay the main unit upside
down on the floor.
CAUTION
Do not position the main unit so
that its bottom is in contact
with floor.
Be sure to position the keyboard side on the bottom.
Incorrect
Incorrect
Incorrect
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
211
Appendix
2 Attach two front legs and a rear leg.
Refer to the diagram below to verify the orientation
of the legs.
Install and tighten four 6 x 40 mm screws on each
leg, starting with one of the front legs.
3 Install the pedal box.
1 Remove the twist tie that affixes the pedal cord to
the upper portion of the pedal box.
2 Align the cord with the groove on the unit, and
attach the pedal box using four 6 x 20 mm
screws.
3 Insert the pedal cord plug into the pedal
connector. Insert the plug so the arrow side faces
front (toward the keyboard).
If the plug will not go in easily, do not force it.
Double-check the orientation of the plug, then try
again.
4 Attach the cord holder on the unit as shown in the
illustration below, then use the cord holder to
affix the pedal cord.
4 Raising the unit to the standing position.
Use the front legs as support to raise the unit.
Rear leg
Front leg Front leg
Twist tie
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
•When you raise the unit, do not hold the key cover.
4
3
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
212
Appendix
5 Connect the power cord.
Insert the AC power cord plug into the [AC INLET].
6 Set the adjuster.
Rotate the adjuster until it comes in firm contact with
the floor surface.
After completing the assembly, please check the follow-
ing.
Voltage Selector
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the set-
ting of the voltage selector which is provided in
some areas. To set the selector for 110V, 127V, 220V
or 240V main voltages, use a “minus” screwdriver to
rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for
your region appears next to the pointer on the panel.
The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is
initially shipped.
After the proper voltage has been selected, connect
the AC power cord to the [AC INLET] and an AC wall
outlet. A plug adaptor may be also provided in some
areas to match the pin configuration of the AC wall
outlets in your area.
WARNING
An improper voltage setting can cause serious damage to
the Clavinova or result in improper operation.
240
127
110
220
For models that feature
a voltage selector:
Set the voltage selector to an
appropriate voltage.
Right leg on the bottom of the main unit, when
viewed from front
Are there any parts left over?
Review the assembly procedure and correct any
errors.
Is the Clavinova clear of doors and other
movable fixtures?
Move the Clavinova to an appropriate location.
Does the Clavinova make a rattling noise
when you shake it?
Tighten all screws.
Does the pedal box rattle or give way
when you step on the pedals?
Turn the adjuster so that it is set firmly against
the floor.
Are the pedal and power cords inserted
securely into the sockets?
Check the connection.
If the main unit creaks or is otherwise
unsteady when you play on the keyboard,
refer to the assembly diagrams and
retighten all screws.
When moving the instrument after assembly, always
hold the bottom of the main unit.
CAUTION
Do not hold the key cover or top portion. Improper han-
dling can result in damage to the instrument or personal
injury.
Top portion
Key cover
Do not hold here.
Do not hold here.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
213
Appendix
CVP-409/407: Keyboard Stand Assembly
CAUTION
Be careful not to confuse parts, and be sure to install all
parts in the correct direction. Please assemble in accor-
dance with the sequence given below.
Assembly should be carried out by at least two persons.
Be sure to use the correct screw size, as indicated below.
Use of incorrect screws can cause damage.
Be sure to tighten up
all screws upon com-
pleting assembly of
each unit.
•To disassemble,
reverse the assembly
sequence given below.
1 Remove all parts from the box. Confirm that all
parts shown in the illustration are provided.
2 With the key cover closed and the keyboard side
on the bottom, lean the unit against the wall.
Spread a large soft cloth, such as a blanket, on the floor.
Place the unit on the cloth with the keyboard side on
the bottom and lean the unit against the wall so that the
unit will not fall or slip. Place a soft cloth against the
wall to protect the instrument and wall from scratches.
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
The top part of the music rest is not fixed. When you lean
the unit against the wall, support the music rest with your
hand so that the music rest will not fall.
CAUTION
Do not place the main unit
with the rear side facing
down.
Do not lay the main unit
upside-down on the floor.
3 Attach the front legs.
4 Attach the rear leg.
5 Raising the unit to the standing position.
Use the front legs as support to raise the unit.
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
•When you raise the unit, do not hold the key cover.
Have a Phillips-head (+) screw-
driver ready.
Rear legFront leg (left)
AC power cord
Front leg (right)
Pedal box
5x18 mm fixing
screws × 14
Bundled pedal
cord inside
CAUTION
To prevent the
key cover from
accidentally
opening during
assembly, press
down on the
key cover, mak-
ing sure that
the sheet
(shown) remain
in place.
Be sure to position the keyboard side on the bottom.
CAUTION
Please do not touch the speaker
net. Doing so may damage the
speaker inside.
Incorrect
Incorrect
Front leg (right) Front leg (left)
1 Fix the front right
leg to the bottom
surface of the unit
using two screws.
2 Fix the front right leg
to the speaker box
using two screws.
3 Fix the front left leg in the same way.
If the screw holes do not align, loosen the other screws and
adjust the position of the front leg.
2 Fix the rear legs to the
speaker box using two
screws.
1 Fix the rear legs to
the bottom surface
of the unit using
two screws.
If the screw holes do not align, loosen the other screws and
adjust the position of the rear legs.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
214
Appendix
6 Installing the pedal box.
7 Connect the pedal cord.
8 Set the voltage selector and connect the power
cord.
Voltage Selector
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the setting of the volt-
age selector which is provided in some areas. To set the selector
for 110V, 127V, 220V or 240V main voltages, use a “minus” screw-
driver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for your
region appears next to the pointer on the panel. The voltage selec-
tor is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped.
After the proper voltage has been selected, connect the AC
power cord to the AC INLET and an AC wall outlet. A plug adap-
tor may be also provided in some areas to match the pin config-
uration of the AC wall outlets in your area.
WARNING
An improper voltage setting can cause serious damage to
the instrument or result in improper operation.
9 Set the adjuster.
Rotate the adjuster until it
comes in firm contact with
the floor surface.
After completing the assembly, please check
the following.
1 Remove the
plastic cover from
the rear legs.
2 Untie and straighten
out the bundled
cord attached to the
bottom of the pedal
box.
3 Pass the pedal
cord between
the pedal box
and the rear leg.
4 Make sure that the pedal box lays flat, with no
gap between itself and the floor, then affix the
pedal box using two screws.
1 Insert the
pedal cord
plug into the
pedal connec-
tor.
Insert the plug
with the
arrow-printed side facing front
(toward the keyboard side).
If the plug will not go in easily,
do not force it. Double-check
the orientation of the plug,
then try again.
2 Align the pedal cord into
the groove on the rear leg,
and install the plastic cover
onto the groove. Be careful
not to insert the cover’s
attachment strip between
the groove wall and the leg.
Correct
Incorrect
240
127
110
220
(the bottom of the right side
as seen from the front)
Are there any parts left over?
Review the assembly procedure and correct any
errors.
Is the instrument clear of doors and other
movable fixtures?
Move the instrument to an appropriate location.
Does the instrument make a rattling noise when
you shake it?
Tighten all screws.
Does the pedal box rattle or give way when you
step on the pedals?
Turn the adjuster so that it is set firmly against the
floor.
Are the pedal and power cords inserted securely
into the sockets?
Check the connection.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
215
Appendix
When moving the instrument after assembly, always
hold the bottom of the main unit.
CAUTION
Do not hold the key cover or top portion. Improper handling
can result in damage to the instrument or personal injury.
Top portion
Key cover
Do not hold here.
Hold here.
Do not
hold here.
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
216
Appendix
Installing the Floppy Disk Drive (Optional)
The floppy disk drive can be installed to the bottom of
the instrument by using the included floppy disk drive
case and screws. For a list of optional floppy disk drives
available for this instrument, see “Optional Accesso-
ries” (page 218).
1 Remove the three backing papers from the
adhesive tape in the case, and fit the floppy disk
drive into the case.
2 Fold the USB cable inside the case as shown.
3 Attach the drive and case assembly to the left
underside of the instrument, using the included
four screws (4 mm x 10 mm).
4 Connect the USB cable to the [USB TO DEVICE]
terminal.
Have a Phillips-head (+) screwdriver ready.
Insert the drive to the case, with the side
having the rubber stoppers facing the case.
Dual-sided adhesive tape
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
217
Appendix
Specifications
CVP-409GP
(grand piano type)
CVP-409 CVP-407
Sound Source AWM Dynamic Stereo Sampling
Keyboard
NW (Natural Wood)
with Synthetic ivory keytops
(Wood is used for the white keys)
NW (Natural Wood)
Keyboard
(Wood is used for the white
keys)
Number of keys 88
Display 640 480 dots VGA color 7.8 inch LCD
Music Score, Lyrics, and
Tex t
YES
Wallpaper Customize YES
Voice
Polyphony (max) 128 + 128
Voice Selection
590 voices + 480 XG Voices
19 Drum/SFX Kits + GM2 + GS (GS Voices for GS Song playback)
Natural! Voice 38
S.
Articulation!
Voice
38
Mega Voice 18
Live! Voice 56
Cool! Voice 39
Sweet! Voice 23
Organ Flutes! 10
Regular Voice 368
Sound Creator YES
Effects
Effect
Blocks
Reverb/
Chorus/DSP/
Master
Compressor
9
Microphone 1
Effect
Types
Reverb/
Chorus/DSP
Reverb: 34 Preset + 3 User
Chorus: 30 Preset + 3 User
DSP 1: 191 Preset + 3 User
DSP 2–6: 191 Preset + 10 User
Master EQ 5 Preset + 2 User
Master
Compressor
5 Preset + 5 User
Part EQ 27 Parts
Vocal Harmony 60 Preset + 10 User
Accompani
ment Style
Accompaniment Styles 408
Pro Styles 334
Session
Styles
38
Pianist Styles 36
Mega Voice Styles YES
Fingering
Single Finger, Fingered, Fingered On Bass, Multi Finger, AI Fingered,
Full Keyboard, AI Full Keyboard
Style Creator YES
OTS
(One Touch Setting)
4 for Each Style
OTS Link YES
Music
Finder
Preset YES
Edit YES
Song
Preset Songs 120
Guide Follow Lights, Any Key, Karao-Key, Vocal CueTIME
Guide Lamp YES
Performance assistant
technology
YES
Recording Quick Recording, Multi Recording, Step Recording, Song Editing
Record
Channels
16
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
218
Appendix
* Specifications and descriptions in this owner’s manual are for information purposes only. Yamaha Corp. reserves the right to
change or modify products or specifications at any time without prior notice. Since specifications, equipment or options
may not be the same in every locale, please check with your Yamaha dealer.
USB Audio Recorder YES
Internet Direct Connection
LAN Port, Wireless Game Adaptor (LAN Port),
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)
Memory
Device
USB Flash Memory YES
Floppy Disk (2HD, 2DD) External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)
Hard Disk External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)
Flash Memory (Internal) about 3.2 MB
Memory Card
(SmartMedia, etc.)
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)
Tempo
Tempo Range 5–500, Tap Tempo
Metronome YES
Sound Bell on/off, Human Voices (5 Languages)
Registration
Memory
Buttons 8
Regist. Sequence/
Freeze
YES
Others
Demo YES
Language for Display 6 Languages (English, Japanese, German, French, Spanish, Italian)
Direct Access YES
Piano Reset Button
(incl. Piano Lock)
YES
Transpose Keyboard/Song/Master
Scale Type 9
USB
Connection
USB to HOST
(Computer)
YES
USB TO DEVICE
(left side of front panel)
YES
USB TO DEVICE
(bottom left panel of the
instrument)
YES
Other Connectors
PHONES x 2, MIDI (THRU, OUT, IN), AUX PEDAL, AUX IN (L/L+R, R),
AUX OUT (L/L+R, R), AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED) (L, R),
MIC (INPUT VOLUME, MIC./LINE IN), VIDEO OUT, RGB OUT, LAN
Pedals Functions
VOLUME, SUSTAIN, SOSTENUTO, SOFT, GLIDE, S. Articulation,
SONG PLAY/PAUSE, STYLE START/STOP, etc.
Amplifiers/
Speakers
iAFC YES
Amplifiers 60 W 2 + 20 W 2
Speakers (16 cm + 5 cm + 3 cm (dome)) 2 + 10 cm 2
Dimensions [W D H]
(CVP-409 grand piano type: Lid up)
(CVP-409 and CVP-407: with the Music
Rest)
1435 mm 1147 mm 905 mm
[56-5/8" 45-1/4" 35-3/4"]
(1435 mm 1147 mm 1555 mm)
[56-5/8" 45-1/4" 61-3/8"]
1430 mm 609 mm 890 mm
[56-1/2" 24" 35-1/8"]
(1430 mm 609 mm 1047 mm)
[56-1/2" 24" 41-3/8"]
1430 mm 609 mm 885 mm
[56-1/2" 24" 34-7/8"]
(1430 mm 609 mm 1042 mm)
[56-1/2" 24" 41-1/8"]
Weight 108 kg (238 lbs., 1-1/2 oz) 86 kg (189 lbs., 9-1/2 oz) 84 kg (185 lbs., 3 oz)
Optional
Accessories
Headphones HPE-160
FootSwitch FC 4/FC 5
Foot Controller FC 7
USB-FDD Unit UD-FD01
CVP-409GP
(grand piano type)
CVP-409 CVP-407
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
219
Appendix
-For information on the panel controls, see “Panel
Controls” on page 12.
-For information on the jacks and connectors
located on the bottom of the instrument, see “Using
Your Instrument with Other Devices” on page 189.
-For Internet-related terms, see “Glossary of Internet
Terms” on page 188.
-For information on the parameters in the tab dis-
plays, refer to the tab names in this index.
Index
Symbols
®
.................................................................................65
.................................................................................65
Numerics
1–16 .................................................................. 148, 158
A
A-B Repeat ...................................................................41
AI
...............................................................................108
AI FINGERED
.............................................................108
AI FULL KEYBOARD
..................................................108
Any key
......................................................................142
ARABIC
........................................................................85
Assembly
........................................................... 210, 213
ASSEMBLY (Style)
.......................................................122
Audio Recorder
............................................................60
Auto Accompaniment Feature
......................................44
AUTO REVOICE SETUP
...............................................91
B
Background (Lyrics) ......................................................55
Backup
.........................................................................76
BASIC
.........................................................................118
BASS
..........................................................................203
BOOKMARK
..............................................................180
Brightness
.....................................................................19
Browser
......................................................................184
C
Calibrating the iAFC settings .........................................83
Chain Playback
..........................................................138
CHANNEL
......................................................... 126, 158
CHANNEL ON/OFF
...................................................109
Characters
....................................................................73
CHORD
............................................................ 148, 158
CHORD DETECT
.......................................................204
CHORD FINGERING
.................................................107
Chord Tutor function
....................................................49
CMP
.............................................................................91
COMMON
.................................................................100
CONFIG 1
............................................31, 47, 109, 132
CONFIG 2
.....................................................17, 19, 204
Contrast
........................................................................18
CONTROLLER
............................................................100
Cool!
............................................................................78
COPY
...........................................................................70
CUT
.............................................................................71
D
Damper Pedal ..............................................................30
DELETE
........................................................................71
Demo
...........................................................................23
Demo (Voice)
...............................................................34
Direct Access
...............................................................64
DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection)
...............................199
Drums
..........................................................................78
DSP
..............................................................................86
DSP/DSP VARIATION
..................................................86
DUAL
...........................................................................79
DYNAMIC DAMPER Effect
...........................................82
E
EDIT ...........................................................................121
Edit (Bookmarks)
........................................................ 182
Edit (Effect)
...................................................................93
Edit (EQ)
.......................................................................95
Edit (Lyrics)
.................................................................158
Edit (Master Compressor)
..............................................98
Edit (Music Finder)
..................................................... 114
Edit (OTS)
.....................................................................51
Edit (Song)
.................................................................. 158
Edit (Style)
..................................................................123
Edit (Vocal Harmony)
................................................. 167
Edit (Voice)
...................................................................99
EFFECT
.........................................................................90
Effect (microphone)
......................................................56
Effect (Voice)
................................................................ 86
Effect Return Level
........................................................94
Effect Type
................................................................... 92
EFFECT/EQ
................................................................. 102
Entering characters
....................................................... 73
Entering Characters (Internet Direct Connection)
........ 178
EQ (Equalizer)
..............................................................91
EQUAL TEMPERAMENT
.............................................. 85
ESEQ
.......................................................................... 199
EXIT
............................................................................. 67
F
F ...................................................................................65
Factory Reset
................................................................74
Factory-programmed Settings
.......................................74
FADE IN/OUT (Song)
................................................. 137
Fade In/Out time
........................................................137
FADE IN/OUT/HOLD TIME
........................................109
Fast forward
............................................................... 138
Favorite
...................................................................... 114
File
...............................................................................66
File Selection Display
............................................ 26, 68
File Selection Display Basic Operation
.........................67
File Selection Display Configuration
.............................66
File/Folder Operations
..................................................68
FILTER
................................................................. 90, 165
FINGERED
................................................................. 108
FINGERED ON BASS
................................................. 108
FOLDER
....................................................................... 72
Folder
...........................................................................66
Follow lights
...............................................................142
Foot Controller
............................................................. 30
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
220
Appendix
FOOTAGE ......................................................... 104, 105
Footage
......................................................................105
Footswitch
....................................................................30
Format
..........................................................................68
FREEZE
.......................................................................133
FULL KEYBOARD
.......................................................108
Function display
...........................................................27
G
GM System Level 1 ....................................................199
GM System Level 2
....................................................199
GROOVE
...................................................................124
GS
..............................................................................199
Guide
.........................................................................141
Guide Lamp
.................................................................39
GUIDE LAMP ON/OFF
...............................................141
GUIDE LAMP TIMING
...............................................142
H
H ..................................................................................65
HARMONY
................................................................103
HARMONY/ECHO
.......................................................86
Headphone Hanger
......................................................17
Headphones
.................................................................17
Home Page
................................................................186
Hz
................................................................................84
I
iAFC .............................................................................82
ICON
...........................................................................72
Initialize
.......................................................................74
Initializing Internet Settings
........................................187
Internet Direct Connection
.........................................176
Internet Settings
..........................................................183
K
Karaoke ........................................................................54
Karao-key
...................................................................142
key cover
.....................................................................14
Keyboard Parts
.............................................................79
KEYBOARD/PANEL
............................................... 29, 58
KIRNBERGER
...............................................................85
L
LAN ...........................................................................184
LAN port
........................................................... 176, 196
Language
......................................................................18
Left
...............................................................................79
Left Pedal
.....................................................................30
Lid (CVP-409 grand piano type)
...................................16
Live!
.............................................................................78
Live!Drums
...................................................................78
Live!SFX
.......................................................................78
LYRICS
.......................................................................158
Lyrics
...........................................................................55
M
Main Display ......................................................... 25, 65
MAIN PICTURE
............................................................19
Master Compressor
.......................................................97
MASTER TUNE
.............................................................84
MEAN-TONE
............................................................... 85
MEDIA
........................................................68, 140, 195
Mega Voice
..................................................................78
MELODIC MINOR
.....................................................129
Messages
......................................................................63
microphone
..................................................................54
MICROPHONE SETTING
........................................... 170
MIDI
.......................................................................... 196
MIDI Settings
..............................................................200
MIDI Templates
..........................................................201
MIXING CONSOLE
......................................................88
MONO/POLY
.............................................................. 86
MULTI FINGER
..........................................................108
Multi track recording
..................................................143
Music Finder
................................................................52
Music Rest
....................................................................16
N
NAME ..........................................................................72
Natural!
........................................................................78
Notation
.......................................................................38
NW (Natural Wood)
.....................................................10
O
One Touch Setting ....................................................... 50
One-Handed Practice
...................................................39
Organ Flutes
...............................................................103
Organ Flutes!
............................................................... 78
Others
........................................................................ 185
OTS Link
...................................................................... 51
OTS Link Timing
........................................................110
OVERALL SETTING
....................................................171
OWNER
..........................................................18, 19, 20
Owner Name
...............................................................20
P
PANEL PART ................................................................ 89
PARAMETER
.............................................................. 127
Part
.............................................................................. 79
PASTE
................................................................... 70, 71
Pause
......................................................................... 138
PEDAL
........................................................................191
pedal polarity
............................................................. 191
pedals
.......................................................................... 30
percussion sounds
........................................................ 34
performance assistant technology
.................................43
Phrase Mark
...............................................................138
PHRASE MARK REPEAT
.............................................138
Pianist
........................................................................107
PIANO
.......................................................................100
Piano Lock
...................................................................29
Portamento
...................................................................86
Portamento Time
........................................................100
Practice Function
....................................................... 141
PRESET
.........................................................................26
Pro
.............................................................................107
PROPERTY
................................................................. 195
Prot. 1
..........................................................................70
Prot. 2 Edit
................................................................... 70
Prot. 2 Orig
..................................................................70
Punch In/Out Recording
.............................................159
PURE MAJOR
...............................................................85
PURE MINOR
.............................................................. 85
PYTHAGOREAN
.......................................................... 85
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
221
Appendix
-For information on the panel controls, see “Panel
Controls” on page 12.
-For information on the jacks and connectors
located on the bottom of the instrument, see “Using
Your Instrument with Other Devices” on page 189.
-For Internet-related terms, see “Glossary of Internet
Terms” on page 188.
-For information on the parameters in the tab dis-
plays, refer to the tab names in this index.
Q
QUANTIZE ................................................................126
Quick Recording
........................................................143
QUICK START
............................................................139
R
RANDOM ..................................................................138
Realtime Recording
....................................................118
REC
..............................................................................65
REC MODE
................................................................158
RECEIVE
.....................................................................203
Record (Song)
...................................................... 42, 143
Record (Style)
.............................................................118
REGISTRATION MEMORY
.........................................131
REGISTRATION SEQUENCE
......................................134
REPEAT MODE
................................................... 36, 138
Repeat Playback
.........................................................138
Repeat Playback Function
............................................41
Repertoire
....................................................................53
Revoice
........................................................................91
Rewind
.......................................................................138
[RGB OUT] Terminal
.................................................190
Right 1
.........................................................................79
Right 2
.........................................................................79
S
S. Articulation! .............................................................78
SAVE
............................................................................69
Save (Music Finder)
....................................................115
SCALE TUNE
................................................................84
Score
............................................................................38
Search (Music Finder Records)
....................................112
Section Set
.................................................................110
Session
.......................................................................107
Set the polarity of the pedal
........................................191
SFX
...............................................................................78
Sheet Music Braces
......................................................16
SINGLE FINGER
.........................................................108
SMF (Standard MIDI file)
............................................199
Song
.............................................................................35
SONG CH 1-8/9-16
.....................................................89
Song channels
............................................................147
Sostenuto Pedal
............................................................30
SOUND
.....................................................................101
Sound Creator
..............................................................99
sound effects
................................................................34
SPATIAL ENSEMBLE Effect
...........................................83
Speaker setting
.............................................................17
SPLIT
............................................................................79
SPLIT POINT
..............................................................111
Step Recording
.................................................. 118, 143
Stop ACMP
.................................................................110
Style
.............................................................................44
Style Assembly
...........................................................118
Style Change Behavior
...............................................110
Style Creator
...............................................................117
Style File
....................................................................199
STYLE PART
.................................................................89
Style parts
...................................................................147
STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT
....................................109
Style Structure
............................................................117
Style Touch
................................................................110
Sweet!
.......................................................................... 78
Synchro Start (Song)
................................................... 137
Synchro Start (Style)
......................................................47
Synchro Stop
................................................................ 48
Synchro Stop Window
................................................110
Synthetic ivory keytops
.................................................10
SYS/EX.
.......................................................................158
SYSTEM
......................................................................202
SYSTEM RESET
............................................................. 75
T
TALK ............................................................................ 59
TALK SETTING
...........................................................174
Tap function
...............................................................137
Text
..............................................................................55
Threshold
..................................................................... 98
Top
............................................................................ 138
TRANSMIT
................................................................. 202
Transpose
........................................................56, 58, 84
TUNE
........................................................................... 90
U
UP ................................................................................67
USB Audio Recorder
....................................................60
[USB TO DEVICE] Terminal
.......................................195
USER
............................................................................26
V
Vibrato ....................................................................... 102
VIDEO OUT
.................................................................56
Vocal CueTIME
..........................................................142
VOCAL HARMONY EDIT
................................. 168, 169
VOCAL HARMONY TYPE
..........................................167
Voice
..............................................................28, 32, 78
VOICE EFFECT
.............................................................86
Voice Program Change Number
.................................204
VOICE SET
...................................................................99
VOL/ATTACK
.............................................................105
VOL/VOICE
..................................................................90
W
WERCKMEISTER .......................................................... 85
Wireless Game Adaptor
.................................... 176, 188
Wireless LAN
.............................................................185
X
XF .............................................................................. 199
XG
............................................................................. 199
Appendix
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
222
Panel Button Chart
The position of the button on the panel can be confirmed by the Panel Control (page 12).
Symbol
[–] [+] (TEMPO) ............................................................. 8
[–] [+] (TRANSPOSE) ..................................................... 6
Number
[1]–[4] (ONE TOUCH SETTING) ................................... n
[1]–[8] (REGISTRATION MEMORY)............................... k
[1
π†
]–[8
π†
] ................................................................... O
A
[ACMP ON/OFF] ........................................................... 0
[AUTO FILL IN] ............................................................. A
[A]–[J]............................................................................ K
B
[BREAK]................................................................................. D
C
[CHANNEL ON/OFF].......................................................... N
D
Damper pedal....................................................................... s
[DATA ENTRY]..................................................................... R
[DEMO]......................................................................... 4
[DIRECT ACCESS]................................................................ L
Drum Kit icons ..................................................................... p
[DUAL (RIGHT2)] ................................................................ V
E
ENDING/rit. [I]/[II]/[III]........................................................ E
[ENTER]................................................................................. S
[EXIT]..................................................................................... Q
[EXTRA TRACKS] ................................................................. a
F
[FUNCTION]........................................................................ X
G
[GUIDE] ................................................................................ f
I
[INTERNET] .......................................................................... Y
INTRO [I]/[II]/[III] ................................................................. B
K
Keyboard guide lamps......................................................... t
L
[LCD CONTRAST] ............................................................... J
Left pedal .............................................................................. q
[LYRICS/TEXT] button.......................................................... e
M
MAIN VARIATION [A]/[B]/[C]/[D] ..................................... C
[MASTER VOLUME]............................................................. 3
[MEMORY]............................................................................ j
Mic signal/over lamps.................................................... u
[MIXING CONSOLE] ........................................................... M
[MUSIC FINDER].................................................................. I
O
[ON/OFF] (METRONOME) ............................................ 5
[OTS LINK]............................................................................ o
P
[PIANO RESET] ..................................................................... h
[PLAY/PAUSE]....................................................................... ]
[POWER] ............................................................................... 1
R
[REC] ...................................................................................... [
REGIST BANK [+] [–] ........................................................... i
[REPEAT]................................................................................ g
[REW]/[FF] buttons ............................................................... ^
S
[SCORE]................................................................................. d
[SONG SELECT].................................................................... Z
Sostenuto pedal..................................................................... r
[SPLIT (LEFT)] ........................................................................ W
[START/STOP] ............................................................... H
[STOP] ................................................................................... \
STYLE category selection buttons................................... 9
[SYNC START] ...................................................................... G
[SYNC STOP] ........................................................................ F
T
TAB [
][
®
] ........................................................................... P
[TAP TEMPO] (TEMPO) ................................................. 7
[TRACK 1 (R)]........................................................................ c
[TRACK 2 (L)] ........................................................................ b
U
[USB]...................................................................................... T
[USB TO DEVICE] ......................................................... 2
[USER]........................................................................... U
V
VOICE category selection buttons.................................. l
[VOICE EFFECT] ................................................................... m
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
223
The followings are the titles, credits and copyright notices for fifty
seven (57) of the songs pre-installed in this instrument:
Alfie
Theme from the Paramount Picture ALFIE
Words by Hal David
Music by Burt Bacharach
Copyright © 1966 (Renewed 1994) by Famous Music Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
All Shook Up
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Elvis Presley
Copyright © 1957 by Shalimar Music Corporation
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis
Songs
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Beauty And The Beast
from Walt Disney’s BEAUTY AND THE BEAST
Lyrics by Howard Ashman
Music by Alan Menken
© 1991 Walt Disney Music Company and Wonderland Music Com-
pany, Inc.
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Bésame Mucho (Kiss Me Much)
Music and Spanish Words by Consuelo Velazquez
English Words by Sunny Skylar
Copyright © 1941, 1943 by Promotora Hispano Americana de Musica,
S.A.
Copyrights Renewed
All Rights Administered by Peer International Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Blue Hawaii
from the Paramount Picture WAIKIKI WEDDING
Words and Music by Leo Robin and Ralph Rainger
Copyright © 1936, 1937 (Renewed 1963, 1964) by Famous Music
Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Blue Moon
Words by Lorenz Hart
Music by Richard Rodgers
© 1934 (Renewed 1962) METRO-GOLDWYN-MAYER INC.
All Rights Controlled by EMI ROBBINS CATALOG INC. (Publishing)
and WARNER BROS. PUBLICATIONS U.S. INC. (Print)
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Brazil
Words and Music by Ray Barroso
English lyrics by S. K. Russell
Copyright © 1941 by Peer International Corporation
Copyright Renewed
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
California Girls
Words and Music by Brian Wilson and Mike Love
Copyright © 1965 IRVING MUSIC, INC.
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Can You Feel The Love Tonight
from Walt Disney Pictures’ THE LION KING
Music by Elton John
Lyrics by Tim Rice
© 1994 Wonderland Music Company, Inc.
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Can’t Help Falling In Love
from the Paramount Picture BLUE HAWAII
Words and Music by George David Weiss, Hugo Peretti and Luigi Cre-
atore
Copyright © 1961 by Gladys Music, Inc.
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Gladys Music
All Rights Administered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company,
Inc. and Chrysalis Music
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Chim Chim Cher-ee
from Walt Disney’s MARY POPPINS
Words and Music by Richard M. Sherman and Robert B. Sherman
© 1963 Wonderland Music Company, Inc.
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Do-Re-Mi
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II
Music by Richard Rodgers
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II
Copyright Renewed
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-
out the world
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Don’t Be Cruel (To A Heart That’s True)
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Elvis Presley
Copyright © 1956 by Unart Music Corporation and Elvis Presley
Music, Inc.
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis
Songs
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Edelweiss
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II
Music by Richard Rodgers
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II
Copyright Renewed
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-
out the world
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Fly Me To The Moon (In Other Words)
featured in the Motion Picture ONCE AROUND
Words and Music by Bart Howard
TRO - © Copyright 1954 (Renewed) Hampshire House Publishing
Corp., New York, NY
International Copyright Secured
All Rights Reserved Including Public Performance For Profit
Used by Permission
Hey Jude
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney
Copyright © 1968 Sony/ATV Songs LLC
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Hound Dog
Words and Music by Jerry Leiber and Mike Stoller
Copyright © 1956 by Elvis Presley Music, Inc. and Lion Publishing
Co., Inc.
Copyright Renewed, Assigned to Gladys Music and Universal - MCA
Music Publishing, A Division of Universal Studios, Inc.
All Rights Administered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company,
Inc. and Chrysalis Music
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
I Just Called To Say I Love You
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder
© 1984 JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL MUSIC
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
I Left My Heart In San Francisco
Words by Douglass Cross
Music by George Cory
© 1954 (Renewed 1982) COLGEMS-EMI MUSIC INC.
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
224
In The Mood
By Joe Garland
Copyright © 1939, 1960 Shapiro, Bernstein & Co., Inc., New York
Copyright Renewed
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Used by Permission
Isn’t She Lovely
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder
© 1976 JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL MUSIC
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
Let It Be
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney
Copyright © 1970 Sony/ATV Songs LLC
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Let’s Twist Again
Words by Kal Mann
Music by Dave Appell and Kal Mann
Copyright © 1961 Kalmann Music, Inc.
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Controlled and Administered by Spirit Two Music, Inc.
(ASCAP)
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Linus And Lucy
By Vince Guaraldi
Copyright © 1965 LEE MENDELSON FILM PRODUCTIONS, INC.
Copyright Renewed
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Love Story
Theme from the Paramount Picture LOVE STORY
Music by Francis Lai
Copyright © 1970, 1971 (Renewed 1998, 1999) by Famous Music
Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Lullaby Of Birdland
Words by George David Weiss
Music by George Shearing
© 1952, 1954 (Renewed 1980, 1982) EMI LONGITUDE MUSIC
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
Michelle
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney
Copyright © 1965 Sony/ATV Songs LLC
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Mickey Mouse March
from Walt Disney’s THE MICKEY MOUSE CLUB
Words and Music by Jimmie Dodd
© 1955 Walt Disney Music Company
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Mission: Impossible Theme
from the Paramount Television Series MISSION: IMPOSSIBLE
By Lalo Schifrin
Copyright © 1966, 1967 (Renewed 1994, 1995) by Bruin Music Com-
pany
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Mona Lisa
from the Paramount Picture CAPTAIN CAREY, U.S.A.
Words and Music by Jay Livingston and Ray Evans
Copyright © 1949 (Renewed 1976) by Famous Music Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Moon River
from the Paramount Picture BREAKFAST AT TIFFANY’S
Words by Johnny Mercer
Music by Henry Mancini
Copyright © 1961 (Renewed 1989) by Famous Music Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Moonlight Serenade
Words by Mitchell Parish
Music by Glen Miller
Copyright © 1939 (Renewed 1967) by ROBBINS MUSIC CORPORA-
TION
All Rights Controlled and Administered by EMI ROBBINS CATALOG
INC.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
My Favorite Things
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II
Music by Richard Rodgers
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II
Copyright Renewed
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-
out the world
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
My Way
By Paul Anka, Jacques Revaux, Claude Francois and Giles Thibault
© 1997 by Chrysalis Standards, Inc.
Used by Permission. All Rights Reserved.
The Nearness Of You
from the Paramount Picture ROMANCE IN THE DARK
Words by Ned Washington
Music by Hoagy Carmichael
Copyright © 1937, 1940 (Renewed 1964, 1967) by Famous Music
Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Theme From “New York, New York”
Music by John Kander
Words by Fred Ebb
© 1977 UNITED ARTISTS CORPORATION
All Rights Controlled by EMI UNART CATALOG INC. (Publishing) and
WARNER BROS. PUBLICATIONS U.S. INC. (Print)
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Ob-La-Di, Ob-La-Da
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney
Copyright © 1968 Sony/ATV Songs LLC
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Proud Mary
Words and Music by J.C. Fogerty
© 1968 (Renewed) JONDORA MUSIC
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Return To Sender
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Winfield Scott
Copyright © 1962 by Elvis Presley Music, Inc.
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis
Songs
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
The Shoop Shoop Song (It’s In His Kiss)
Words and Music by Rudy Clark
Copyright © 1963, 1964 by Trio Music Company, Inc. and Top Of The
Charts
Copyright Renewed
All Rights for the United States Controlled and Administered by Trio
Music Company, Inc.
All Rights for the World excluding the United States Controlled and
Administered by Trio Music Company, Inc. and Alley Music Corp.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Used by Permission
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
225
(Sittin’ On) The Dock Of The Bay
Words and Music by Steve Cropper and Otis Redding
Copyright © 1968, 1975 IRVING MUSIC, INC.
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Smoke Gets In Your Eyes
from ROBERTA
Words by Otto Harbach
Music by Jerome Kern
© 1933 UNIVERSAL - POLYGRAM INTERNATIONAL PUBLISHING,
INC.
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Reserved
International Rights Secured. Not for broadcast transmission.
DO NOT DUPLICATE. NOT FOR RENTAL.
WARNING: It is a violation of Federal Copyright Law to synchronize
this Multimedia Disc with video tape or film, or to print the Composi-
tion(s) embodied on this Multimedia Disc in the form of standard
music notation, without the express written permission of the copy-
right owner.
Somewhere, My Love
Lara’s Theme from DOCTOR ZHIVAGO
Lyric by Paul Francis Webster
Music by Maurice Jarre
Copyright © 1965, 1966 (Renewed 1993, 1994) Webster Music Co.
and EMI Robbins Catalog Inc.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Spanish Eyes
Words by Charles Singleton and Eddie Snyder
Music by Bert Kaempfert
© 1965, 1966 (Renewed 1993, 1994) EDITION DOMA BERT
KAEMPFERT
All Rights for the world, excluding Germany, Austria and Switzerland,
Controlled and Administered by SCREEN GEMS-EMI MUSIC INC.
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
Speak Softly, Love (Love Theme)
from the Paramount Picture THE GODFATHER
Words by Larry Kusik
Music by Nino Rota
Copyright © 1972 (Renewed 2000) by Famous Music Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Stella By Starlight
from the Paramount Picture THE UNINVITED
Words by Ned Washington
Music by Victor Young
Copyright © 1946 (Renewed 1973, 1974) by Famous Music Corpora-
tion
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Take The “A” Train
Words and Music by Billy Strayhorn
Copyright © 1941; Renewed 1969 DreamWorks Songs (ASCAP) and
Billy Strayhorn Songs, Inc. (ASCAP) for the U.S.A.
Rights for DreamWorks Songs and Billy Strayhorn Songs, Inc. Adminis-
tered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company, Inc.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Tears In Heaven
Words and Music by Eric Clapton and Will Jennings
Copyright © 1992 by E.C. Music Ltd. and Blue Sky Rider Songs
All Rights for E.C. Music Ltd. Administered by Unichappell Music Inc.
All Rights for Blue Sky Rider Songs Administered by Irving Music, Inc.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
That Old Black Magic
from the Paramount Picture STAR SPANGLED RHYTHM
Words by Johnny Mercer
Music by Harold Arlen
Copyright © 1942 (Renewed 1969) by Famous Music Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
That’s Amore (That’s Love)
from the Paramount Picture THE CADDY
Words by Jack Brooks
Music by Harry Warren
Copyright © 1953 (Renewed 1981) by Paramount Music Corporation
and Four Jays Music
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Up Where We Belong
from the Paramount Picture AN OFFICER AND A GENTLEMAN
Words by Will Jennings
Music by Buffy Sainte-Marie and Jack Nitzsche
Copyright © 1982 by Famous Music Corporation and Ensign Music
Corporation
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
Waltz For Debby
Lyric by Gene Lees
Music by Bill Evans
TRO - © Copyright 1964 (Renewed), 1965 (Renewed), 1966
(Renewed) Folkways Music Publishers, Inc., New York, NY
International Copyright Secured
All Rights Reserved Including Public Performance For Profit
Used by Permission
White Christmas
from the Motion Picture Irving Berlin’s HOLIDAY INN
Words and Music by Irving Berlin
© Copyright 1940, 1942 by Irving Berlin
Copyright Renewed
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
A Whole New World
from Walt Disney’s ALADDIN
Music by Alan Menken
Lyrics by Tim Rice
© 1992 Wonderland Music Company, Inc. and Walt Disney Music
Company
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission
Yesterday
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney
Copyright © 1965 Sony/ATV Songs LLC
Copyright Renewed
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
You Are The Sunshine Of My Life
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder
© 1972 (Renewed 2000) JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL
MUSIC
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-
mission
You Sexy Thing
Words and Music by E. Brown
Copyright © 1975 by Finchley Music Corp.
Administered in the USA and Canada by Music & Media International,
Inc.
Administered for the World excluding the USA and Canada by RAK
Music Publishing Ltd.
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved
CVP-409/407 Owner’s Manual
226
MEMO
The above warning is located on the bottom of the unit.
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol
within an equilateral triangle is intended to
alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
“dangerous voltage” within the product’s
enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude
to constitute a risk of electric shock to
persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert the user to the
presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the product.
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1 Read these instructions.
2Keep these instructions.
3 Heed all warnings.
4 Follow all instructions.
5 Do not use this apparatus near water.
6 Clean only with dry cloth.
7 Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
8 Do not install near any heat sources such as
radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus
(including amplifiers) that produce heat.
9 Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or
grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades
with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug
has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide
blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If
the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult
an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
10 Protect the power cord from being walked on or
pinched particularly at plugs, convenience
receptacles, and the point where they exit from the
apparatus.
11 Only use attachments/accessories specified by the
manufacturer.
12 Use only with the cart, stand,
tripod, bracket, or table
specified by the manufacturer,
or sold with the apparatus.
When a cart is used, use
caution when moving the cart/
apparatus combination to
avoid injury from tip-over.
13 Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or
when unused for long periods of time.
14 Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or
plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects
have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has
been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate
normally, or has been dropped.
(UL60065_03)
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPARATUS TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
CVP-409GP (grand piano type)
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK,
AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST.
WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic product,
basic precautions should always be followed. These precautions
include, but are not limited to, the following:
1. Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions, Spe-
cial Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions
found in this manual BEFORE making any connections, includ-
ing connection to the main supply.
2. Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are
manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area
where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt
exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact your
dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable) instruc-
tions. The required supply voltage is printed on the name plate.
For name plate location, please refer to the graphic found in the
Special Message Section of this manual.
3. This product may be equipped with a polarized plug (one
blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the plug
into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the problem
persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete outlet
replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug.
4. Some electronic products utilize external power supplies
or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any power
supply or adapter other than one described in the owners manual,
on the name plate, or specifically recommended by Yamaha.
5. WARNING: Do not place this product or any other
objects on the power cord or place it in a position where anyone
could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or connect-
ing cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is not recom-
mended! If you must use an extension cord, the minimum wire
size for a 25’ cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE: The smaller the
AWG number, the larger the current handling capacity. For
longer extension cords, consult a local electrician.
6. Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically
designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in locations
that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instructions for
enclosed installations are not provided, it must be assumed that
unobstructed ventilation is required.
7. Temperature considerations: Electronic products should
be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to
their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to
heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices
that produce heat should be avoided.
8. This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp loca-
tions and should not be used near water or exposed to rain.
Examples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool,
spa, tub, sink, or wet basement.
9. This product should be used only with the components
supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the
manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all
safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory
product.
10. The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected
from the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for
extended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected
when there is a high probability of lightning and/or electrical
storm activity.
11. Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids
are not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may
exist.
12. Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a
qualified service person when:
a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or
b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been
spilled into the enclosure through openings; or
c. The product has been exposed to rain: or
d. The product dose not operate, exhibits a marked change
in performance; or
e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the
product has been damaged.
13. Do not attempt to service this product beyond that
described in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servic-
ing should be referred to qualified service personnel.
14. This product, either alone or in combination with an
amplifier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of pro-
ducing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss.
DO NOT operate for a long period of time at a high volume level
or at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing
loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.
IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period
before damage occurs.
15. Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or acces-
sory mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the
product or as optional accessories. Some of these items are
designed to be dealer assembled or installed. Please make sure
that benches are stable and any optional fixtures (where applica-
ble) are well secured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by
Yamaha are designed for seating only. No other uses are recom-
mended.
PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL
92-469-2
CVP-409/407
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA. (class B)
(2 wires)
This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha-Kemble Music
(U.K.) Ltd.
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the instruc-
tions contained in this manual, meets FCC require-
ments. Modifications not expressly approved by
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to
use the product.
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to acces-
sories and/or another product use only high quality
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product
MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Fail-
ure to follow instructions could void your FCC authori-
zation to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to com-
ply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations,
Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with
these requirements provides a reasonable level of
assurance that your use of this product in a residential
environment will not result in harmful interference with
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/
uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used
according to the instructions found in the users manual,
may cause interference harmful to the operation of
other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regula-
tions does not guarantee that interference will not occur
in all installations. If this product is found to be the
source of interference, which can be determined by
turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate
the problem by using one of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being
affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon
lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfac-
tory results, please contact the local retailer authorized
to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate
the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corpo-
ration of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600
Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620
The above statements apply ONLY to those products
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
subsidiaries.
IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM
Connecting the Plug and Cord
IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in
accordance with the following code:
BLUE : NEUTRAL
BROWN : LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appa-
ratus may not correspond with the coloured makings iden-
tifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured
BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured
RED.
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth ter-
minal of the three pin plug.
This product contains a high intensity lamp that con-
tains a small amount of mercury. Disposal of this
material may be regulated due to environmental
considerations.
For disposal information in the United States, refer
to the Electronic Industries Alliance web site:
www.eiae.org
(mercury)* This applies only to products distributed by
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
* This applies only to products distributed by
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT
(DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)
Responsible Party : Yamaha Corporation of America
Address : 6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif.
90620
Telephone : 714-522-9011
Type of Equipment : Electronic Piano
Model Name : CVP-409/407
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) this device must accept any interference received including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
See user manual instructions if interference to radio reception is
suspected.
(FCC DoC)
* This applies only to products distributed by
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT
(DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)
Responsible Party : Yamaha Corporation of America
Address : 6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif.
90620
Telephone : 714-522-9011
Type of Equipment : Digital Piano
Model Name : CVP-409GP
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
2) this device must accept any interference received including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
See user manual instructions if interference to radio reception is
suspected.
(FCC DoC)
CVP-409/407
CVP-409GP (grand piano type)
Information for Users on Collection and Disposal of Old Equipment
This symbol on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying documents means that used electrical and
electronic products should not be mixed with general household waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products, please take them to applicable collection points,
in accordance with your national legislation and the Directives 2002/96/EC.
By disposing of these products correctly, you will help to save valuable resources and prevent any potential
negative effects on human health and the environment which could otherwise arise from inappropriate waste
handling.
For more information about collection and recycling of old products, please contact your local municipality,
your waste disposal service or the point of sale where you purchased the items.
[For business users in the European Union]
If you wish to discard electrical and electronic equipment, please contact your dealer or supplier for further
information.
[Information on Disposal in other Countries outside the European Union]
This symbol is only valid in the European Union. If you wish to discard these items, please contact your local
authorities or dealer and ask for the correct method of disposal.
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha
representative or the authorized distributor listed below.
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante.
Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten
Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.
Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.
CANADA
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario,
M1S 3R1, Canada
Tel: 416-298-1311
U.S.A.
Yamaha Corporation of America
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620,
U.S.A.
Tel: 714-522-9011
MEXICO
Yamaha de México S.A. de C.V.
Calz. Javier Rojo Gómez #1149,
Col. Guadalupe del Moral
C.P. 09300, México, D.F., México
Tel: 55-5804-0600
BRAZIL
Yamaha Musical do Brasil Ltda.
Rua Joaquim Floriano, 913 - 4' andar, Itaim Bibi,
CEP 04534-013 Sao Paulo, SP. BRAZIL
Tel: 011-3704-1377
ARGENTINA
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Sucursal de Argentina
Olga Cossettini 1553, Piso 4 Norte
Madero Este-C1107CEK
Buenos Aires, Argentina
Tel: 011-4119-7000
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá
Tel: +507-269-5311
THE UNITED KINGDOM
Yamaha Music U.K. Ltd.
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes,
MK7 8BL, England
Tel: 01908-366700
IRELAND
Danfay Ltd.
61D, Sallynoggin Road, Dun Laoghaire, Co. Dublin
Tel: 01-2859177
GERMANY
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
SWITZERLAND/LIECHTENSTEIN
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Switzerland
Seefeldstrasse 94, 8008 Zürich, Switzerland
Tel: 01-383 3990
AUSTRIA
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Austria
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria
Tel: 01-60203900
CZECH REPUBLIC/SLOVAKIA/
HUNGARY/SLOVENIA
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Austria, CEE Department
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria
Tel: 01-602039025
POLAND
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Sp.z. o.o. Oddzial w Polsce
ul. 17 Stycznia 56, PL-02-146 Warszawa, Poland
Tel: 022-868-07-57
THE NETHERLANDS/
BELGIUM/LUXEMBOURG
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Benelux
Clarissenhof 5-b, 4133 AB Vianen, The Netherlands
Tel: 0347-358 040
FRANCE
Yamaha Musique France
BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France
Tel: 01-64-61-4000
ITALY
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.
Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy
Tel: 02-935-771
SPAIN/PORTUGAL
Yamaha Música Ibérica, S.A.
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230
Las Rozas (Madrid), Spain
Tel: 91-639-8888
GREECE
Philippos Nakas S.A. The Music House
147 Skiathou Street, 112-55 Athens, Greece
Tel: 01-228 2160
SWEDEN
Yamaha Scandinavia AB
J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1, Box 30053
S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden
Tel: 031 89 34 00
DENMARK
YS Copenhagen Liaison Office
Generatorvej 6A, DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark
Tel: 44 92 49 00
FINLAND
F-Musiikki Oy
Kluuvikatu 6, P.O. Box 260,
SF-00101 Helsinki, Finland
Tel: 09 618511
NORWAY
Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB
Grini Næringspark 1, N-1345 Østerås, Norway
Tel: 67 16 77 70
ICELAND
Skifan HF
Skeifan 17 P.O. Box 8120, IS-128 Reykjavik, Ice-
land
Tel: 525 5000
RUSSIA
Yamaha Music (Russia)
Office 4015, entrance 2, 21/5 Kuznetskii
Most street, Moscow, 107996, Russia
Tel: 495 626 0660
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: +49-4101-3030
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2312
TURKEY/CYPRUS
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
OTHER COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE
LOB 16-513, P.O.Box 17328, Jubel Ali,
Dubai, United Arab Emirates
Tel: +971-4-881-5868
THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA
Yamaha Music & Electronics (China) Co.,Ltd.
25/F., United Plaza, 1468 Nanjing Road (West),
Jingan, Shanghai, China
Tel: 021-6247-2211
HONG KONG
Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd.
11/F., Silvercord Tower 1, 30 Canton Road,
Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong
Tel: 2737-7688
INDIA
Yamaha Music India Pvt. Ltd.
5F Ambience Corporate Tower Ambience Mall Complex
Ambience Island, NH-8, Gurgaon-122001, Haryana, India
Tel: 0124-466-5551
INDONESIA
PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor)
PT. Nusantik
Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot
Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia
Tel: 21-520-2577
KOREA
Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.
8F, 9F, Dongsung Bldg. 158-9 Samsung-Dong,
Kangnam-Gu, Seoul, Korea
Tel: 080-004-0022
MALAYSIA
Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd.
Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,
Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia
Tel: 3-78030900
PHILIPPINES
Yupangco Music Corporation
339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue, P.O. Box 885 MCPO,
Makati, Metro Manila, Philippines
Tel: 819-7551
SINGAPORE
Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd.
#03-11 A-Z Building
140 Paya Lebor Road, Singapore 409015
Tel: 747-4374
TAIWAN
Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.
3F, #6, Sec.2, Nan Jing E. Rd. Taipei.
Taiwan 104, R.O.C.
Tel: 02-2511-8688
THAILAND
Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.
4, 6, 15 and 16
th
floor, Siam Motors Building,
891/1 Rama 1 Road, Wangmai,
Pathumwan, Bangkok 10330, Thailand
Tel: 02-215-2626
OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2317
AUSTRALIA
Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.
Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank,
Victoria 3006, Australia
Tel: 3-9693-5111
NEW ZEALAND
Music Works LTD
P.O.BOX 6246 Wellesley, Auckland 4680,
New Zealand
Tel: 9-634-0099
COUNTRIES AND TRUST
TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,
Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2312
NORTH AMERICA
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA
EUROPE
AFRICA
MIDDLE EAST
ASIA
OCEANIA
HEAD OFFICE
Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-3273
EKB46
U.R.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
© 2007 Yamaha Corporation
WH89980 612APZC?.?-01B0
Printed in Indonesia
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138
  • Page 139 139
  • Page 140 140
  • Page 141 141
  • Page 142 142
  • Page 143 143
  • Page 144 144
  • Page 145 145
  • Page 146 146
  • Page 147 147
  • Page 148 148
  • Page 149 149
  • Page 150 150
  • Page 151 151
  • Page 152 152
  • Page 153 153
  • Page 154 154
  • Page 155 155
  • Page 156 156
  • Page 157 157
  • Page 158 158
  • Page 159 159
  • Page 160 160
  • Page 161 161
  • Page 162 162
  • Page 163 163
  • Page 164 164
  • Page 165 165
  • Page 166 166
  • Page 167 167
  • Page 168 168
  • Page 169 169
  • Page 170 170
  • Page 171 171
  • Page 172 172
  • Page 173 173
  • Page 174 174
  • Page 175 175
  • Page 176 176
  • Page 177 177
  • Page 178 178
  • Page 179 179
  • Page 180 180
  • Page 181 181
  • Page 182 182
  • Page 183 183
  • Page 184 184
  • Page 185 185
  • Page 186 186
  • Page 187 187
  • Page 188 188
  • Page 189 189
  • Page 190 190
  • Page 191 191
  • Page 192 192
  • Page 193 193
  • Page 194 194
  • Page 195 195
  • Page 196 196
  • Page 197 197
  • Page 198 198
  • Page 199 199
  • Page 200 200
  • Page 201 201
  • Page 202 202
  • Page 203 203
  • Page 204 204
  • Page 205 205
  • Page 206 206
  • Page 207 207
  • Page 208 208
  • Page 209 209
  • Page 210 210
  • Page 211 211
  • Page 212 212
  • Page 213 213
  • Page 214 214
  • Page 215 215
  • Page 216 216
  • Page 217 217
  • Page 218 218
  • Page 219 219
  • Page 220 220
  • Page 221 221
  • Page 222 222
  • Page 223 223
  • Page 224 224
  • Page 225 225
  • Page 226 226
  • Page 227 227
  • Page 228 228
  • Page 229 229
  • Page 230 230
  • Page 231 231
  • Page 232 232

Yamaha CVP-407 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Pianos digitales
Tipo
El manual del propietario